* elf32-arm.c (elf32_arm_symbian_link_hash_table_create): Use
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89 @sp 2
90 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
91 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105 @page
106 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108 software in general. We will miss him.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Stack:: Examining the stack
137 * Source:: Examining source files
138 * Data:: Examining data
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173 * Index:: Index
174 @end menu
175
176 @end ifnottex
177
178 @contents
179
180 @node Summary
181 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190 @itemize @bullet
191 @item
192 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194 @item
195 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197 @item
198 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200 @item
201 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203 @end itemize
204
205 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209 @cindex Modula-2
210 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213 @cindex Pascal
214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217 syntax.
218
219 @cindex Fortran
220 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222 underscore.
223
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227 @menu
228 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230 @end menu
231
232 @node Free Software
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236 General Public License
237 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246 from anyone else.
247
248 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252 include with the free software. Many of our most important
253 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255 when an important free software package does not come with a free
256 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257 gaps today.
258
259 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263 them from the free software world.
264
265 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269 contract to make it non-free.
270
271 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290 community.
291
292 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300 of the manual.
301
302 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306 manual to replace it.
307
308 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313 the free software community.
314
315 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335 published by other publishers, at
336 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338 @node Contributors
339 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347 blow-by-blow account.
348
349 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351 @quotation
352 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355 @end quotation
356
357 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359 releases:
360 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390 support.
391 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411 libraries.
412
413 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414 about several machine instruction sets.
415
416 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419 and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422 command-line editing and command history.
423
424 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429 symbols.
430
431 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437 processors.
438
439 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446 watchpoints.
447
448 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486 Hat.
487
488 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506 Weigand.
507
508 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513 @node Sample Session
514 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520 @iftex
521 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523 @end iftex
524
525 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538 @smallexample
539 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540 $ @b{./m4}
541 @b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543 @b{foo}
544 0000
545 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547 @b{bar}
548 0000
549 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552 @b{baz}
553 @b{Ctrl-d}
554 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560 @smallexample
561 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
564 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571 (@value{GDBP})
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578 that examples fit in this manual.
579
580 @smallexample
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588 @code{break} command.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603 @b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605 @b{foo}
606 0000
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612 context where it stops.
613
614 @smallexample
615 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620 @end smallexample
621
622 @noindent
623 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624 the next line of the current function.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638 @smallexample
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651 stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671 @smallexample
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
673 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688 (@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704 533 xfree(rquote);
705 534
706 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710 537
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713 540 @}
714 541
715 542 void
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 540 @}
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728 $3 = 9
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730 $4 = 7
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739 assignments.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743 $5 = 7
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745 $6 = 9
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752 example that caused trouble initially:
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756 Continuing.
757
758 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760 baz
761 0000
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769 @smallexample
770 @b{Ctrl-d}
771 Program exited normally.
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779 @smallexample
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @node Invocation
784 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787 The essentials are:
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791 @item
792 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793 @end itemize
794
795 @menu
796 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800 @end menu
801
802 @node Invoking GDB
803 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811 The command-line options described here are designed
812 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813 options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816 specifying an executable program:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824 specified:
825
826 @smallexample
827 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831 to debug a running process:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849 option processing.
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852 @end smallexample
853 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} -silent
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867 @noindent
868 Type
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} -help
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880 @samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883 @menu
884 * File Options:: Choosing files
885 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887 @end menu
888
889 @node File Options
890 @subsection Choosing Files
891
892 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908 argument and ignore it.
909
910 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918 @c it.
919
920 @table @code
921 @item -symbols @var{file}
922 @itemx -s @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--symbols}
924 @cindex @code{-s}
925 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927 @item -exec @var{file}
928 @itemx -e @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--exec}
930 @cindex @code{-e}
931 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934 @item -se @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--se}
936 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937 file.
938
939 @item -core @var{file}
940 @itemx -c @var{file}
941 @cindex @code{--core}
942 @cindex @code{-c}
943 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945 @item -pid @var{number}
946 @itemx -p @var{number}
947 @cindex @code{--pid}
948 @cindex @code{-p}
949 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
950
951 @item -command @var{file}
952 @itemx -x @var{file}
953 @cindex @code{--command}
954 @cindex @code{-x}
955 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
956 Files,, Command files}.
957
958 @item -eval-command @var{command}
959 @itemx -ex @var{command}
960 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
961 @cindex @code{-ex}
962 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
963
964 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
965 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
966
967 @smallexample
968 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
969 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
970 @end smallexample
971
972 @item -directory @var{directory}
973 @itemx -d @var{directory}
974 @cindex @code{--directory}
975 @cindex @code{-d}
976 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
977
978 @item -r
979 @itemx -readnow
980 @cindex @code{--readnow}
981 @cindex @code{-r}
982 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
983 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
984 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
985
986 @end table
987
988 @node Mode Options
989 @subsection Choosing Modes
990
991 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
992 batch mode or quiet mode.
993
994 @table @code
995 @item -nx
996 @itemx -n
997 @cindex @code{--nx}
998 @cindex @code{-n}
999 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1000 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1001 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1002 Files}.
1003
1004 @item -quiet
1005 @itemx -silent
1006 @itemx -q
1007 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1008 @cindex @code{--silent}
1009 @cindex @code{-q}
1010 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1011 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1012
1013 @item -batch
1014 @cindex @code{--batch}
1015 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1016 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1017 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1018 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1019 in the command files.
1020
1021 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1022 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1023 make this more useful, the message
1024
1025 @smallexample
1026 Program exited normally.
1027 @end smallexample
1028
1029 @noindent
1030 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1031 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1032 mode.
1033
1034 @item -batch-silent
1035 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1036 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1037 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1038 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1039 for an interactive session.
1040
1041 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1042 messages, for example.
1043
1044 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1045 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1046
1047 @item -return-child-result
1048 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1049 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1050 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1051
1052 @itemize @bullet
1053 @item
1054 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1055 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1056 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1057 @item
1058 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1059 @item
1060 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1061 the exit code will be -1.
1062 @end itemize
1063
1064 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1065 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1066 interface.
1067
1068 @item -nowindows
1069 @itemx -nw
1070 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1071 @cindex @code{-nw}
1072 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1073 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1074 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1075
1076 @item -windows
1077 @itemx -w
1078 @cindex @code{--windows}
1079 @cindex @code{-w}
1080 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1081 used if possible.
1082
1083 @item -cd @var{directory}
1084 @cindex @code{--cd}
1085 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1086 instead of the current directory.
1087
1088 @item -fullname
1089 @itemx -f
1090 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1091 @cindex @code{-f}
1092 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1093 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1094 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1095 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1096 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1097 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1098 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1099 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1100 frame.
1101
1102 @item -epoch
1103 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1104 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1105 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1106 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1107 separate window.
1108
1109 @item -annotate @var{level}
1110 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1111 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1112 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1113 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1114 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1115 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1116 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1117 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1118 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1119
1120 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1121 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1122
1123 @item --args
1124 @cindex @code{--args}
1125 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1126 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1127 This option stops option processing.
1128
1129 @item -baud @var{bps}
1130 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1131 @cindex @code{--baud}
1132 @cindex @code{-b}
1133 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1134 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -l @var{timeout}
1137 @cindex @code{-l}
1138 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1139 for remote debugging.
1140
1141 @item -tty @var{device}
1142 @itemx -t @var{device}
1143 @cindex @code{--tty}
1144 @cindex @code{-t}
1145 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1146 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1147
1148 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1149 @item -tui
1150 @cindex @code{--tui}
1151 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1152 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1153 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1154 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1155 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1156 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1157 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1158
1159 @c @item -xdb
1160 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1161 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1162 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1163 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1164 @c systems.
1165
1166 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1167 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1168 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1169 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1170 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1171 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1172
1173 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1174 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1175 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1176 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1177 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1178 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1179
1180 @item -write
1181 @cindex @code{--write}
1182 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1183 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1184 (@pxref{Patching}).
1185
1186 @item -statistics
1187 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1189 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1190
1191 @item -version
1192 @cindex @code{--version}
1193 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1194 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1195
1196 @end table
1197
1198 @node Startup
1199 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1200 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1201
1202 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1203
1204 @enumerate
1205 @item
1206 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1207 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1208
1209 @item
1210 @cindex init file
1211 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1212 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1213 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1214 that file.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Processes command line options and operands.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1221 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1222 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1223 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1224 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1225 @value{GDBN}.
1226
1227 @item
1228 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1229 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1230
1231 @item
1232 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1233 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1234 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1235 @end enumerate
1236
1237 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1238 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1239 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1240 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1241 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1242 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1243
1244 @cindex init file name
1245 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1246 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1247 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1248 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1249 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1250 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1251 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1252 the file to the standard name.
1253
1254
1255 @node Quitting GDB
1256 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1257 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1259
1260 @table @code
1261 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1262 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1263 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1264 @itemx q
1265 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1266 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1267 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1268 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1269 error code.
1270 @end table
1271
1272 @cindex interrupt
1273 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1274 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1275 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1276 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1277 until a time when it is safe.
1278
1279 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1280 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1281 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1282
1283 @node Shell Commands
1284 @section Shell Commands
1285
1286 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1287 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1288 just use the @code{shell} command.
1289
1290 @table @code
1291 @kindex shell
1292 @cindex shell escape
1293 @item shell @var{command string}
1294 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1295 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1296 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1297 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1298 @end table
1299
1300 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1301 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1302 @value{GDBN}:
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex make
1306 @cindex calling make
1307 @item make @var{make-args}
1308 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1309 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1310 @end table
1311
1312 @node Logging Output
1313 @section Logging Output
1314 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1315 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1316
1317 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1318 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1319
1320 @table @code
1321 @kindex set logging
1322 @item set logging on
1323 Enable logging.
1324 @item set logging off
1325 Disable logging.
1326 @cindex logging file name
1327 @item set logging file @var{file}
1328 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1329 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1330 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1331 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1332 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1334 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1335 @kindex show logging
1336 @item show logging
1337 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1338 @end table
1339
1340 @node Commands
1341 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1342
1343 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1344 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1345 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1346 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1347 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1348
1349 @menu
1350 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1351 * Completion:: Command completion
1352 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1353 @end menu
1354
1355 @node Command Syntax
1356 @section Command Syntax
1357
1358 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1359 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1360 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1361 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1362 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1363 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1364
1365 @cindex abbreviation
1366 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1367 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1368 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1369 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1370 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1371 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1372 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1373
1374 @cindex repeating commands
1375 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1376 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1377 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1378 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1379 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1380 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1381 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1382
1383 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1384 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1385 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1386
1387 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1388 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1389 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1390 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1391 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1392
1393 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1394 @cindex comment
1395 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1396 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1397 Files,,Command Files}).
1398
1399 @cindex repeating command sequences
1400 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1401 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1402 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1403 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1404 for editing.
1405
1406 @node Completion
1407 @section Command Completion
1408
1409 @cindex completion
1410 @cindex word completion
1411 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1412 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1413 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1414 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1415
1416 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1417 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1418 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1419 enter it). For example, if you type
1420
1421 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1422 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1423 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1424 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1425 @smallexample
1426 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1427 @end smallexample
1428
1429 @noindent
1430 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1431 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1432
1433 @smallexample
1434 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1435 @end smallexample
1436
1437 @noindent
1438 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1439 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1440 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1441 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1442 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1443 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1444
1445 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1446 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1447 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1448 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1449 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1450 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1451 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1452 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1453 example:
1454
1455 @smallexample
1456 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1457 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1458 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1459 make_abs_section make_function_type
1460 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1461 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1462 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1463 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1464 @end smallexample
1465
1466 @noindent
1467 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1468 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1469 command.
1470
1471 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1472 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1473 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1474 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1475 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1476
1477 @cindex quotes in commands
1478 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1479 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1480 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1481 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1482 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1483 @value{GDBN} commands.
1484
1485 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1486 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1487 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1488 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1489 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1490 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1491 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1492 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1493 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1494 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1495 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1496
1497 @smallexample
1498 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1499 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1500 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1501 @end smallexample
1502
1503 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1504 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1505 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1506 place:
1507
1508 @smallexample
1509 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1510 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1511 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1512 @end smallexample
1513
1514 @noindent
1515 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1516 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1517 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1518
1519 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1520 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1521 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1522 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1523
1524
1525 @node Help
1526 @section Getting Help
1527 @cindex online documentation
1528 @kindex help
1529
1530 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1531 using the command @code{help}.
1532
1533 @table @code
1534 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1535 @item help
1536 @itemx h
1537 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1538 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1539
1540 @smallexample
1541 (@value{GDBP}) help
1542 List of classes of commands:
1543
1544 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1545 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1546 data -- Examining data
1547 files -- Specifying and examining files
1548 internals -- Maintenance commands
1549 obscure -- Obscure features
1550 running -- Running the program
1551 stack -- Examining the stack
1552 status -- Status inquiries
1553 support -- Support facilities
1554 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1555 stopping the program
1556 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1557
1558 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1559 commands in that class.
1560 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1561 documentation.
1562 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1563 (@value{GDBP})
1564 @end smallexample
1565 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1566
1567 @item help @var{class}
1568 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1569 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1570 help display for the class @code{status}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1574 Status inquiries.
1575
1576 List of commands:
1577
1578 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1579 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1580 info -- Generic command for showing things
1581 about the program being debugged
1582 show -- Generic command for showing things
1583 about the debugger
1584
1585 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1586 documentation.
1587 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1588 (@value{GDBP})
1589 @end smallexample
1590
1591 @item help @var{command}
1592 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1593 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1594
1595 @kindex apropos
1596 @item apropos @var{args}
1597 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1598 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1599 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1600
1601 @smallexample
1602 apropos reload
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 results in:
1607
1608 @smallexample
1609 @c @group
1610 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1611 multiple times in one run
1612 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1613 multiple times in one run
1614 @c @end group
1615 @end smallexample
1616
1617 @kindex complete
1618 @item complete @var{args}
1619 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1620 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1621 command you want completed. For example:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 complete i
1625 @end smallexample
1626
1627 @noindent results in:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @group
1631 if
1632 ignore
1633 info
1634 inspect
1635 @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1639 @end table
1640
1641 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1642 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1643 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1644 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1645 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1646 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1647
1648 @c @group
1649 @table @code
1650 @kindex info
1651 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1652 @item info
1653 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1654 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1655 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1656 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1657 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1658 @w{@code{help info}}.
1659
1660 @kindex set
1661 @item set
1662 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1663 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1664 @code{set prompt $}.
1665
1666 @kindex show
1667 @item show
1668 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1669 @value{GDBN} itself.
1670 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1671 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1672 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1673 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1674
1675 @kindex info set
1676 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1677 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1678 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1679 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1680 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1681 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1682 @end table
1683 @c @end group
1684
1685 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1686 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1687
1688 @table @code
1689 @kindex show version
1690 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1691 @item show version
1692 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1693 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1694 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1695 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1696 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1697 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1698 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1699 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1700 @value{GDBN}.
1701
1702 @kindex show copying
1703 @kindex info copying
1704 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1705 @item show copying
1706 @itemx info copying
1707 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1708
1709 @kindex show warranty
1710 @kindex info warranty
1711 @item show warranty
1712 @itemx info warranty
1713 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1714 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1715
1716 @end table
1717
1718 @node Running
1719 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1720
1721 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1722 debugging information when you compile it.
1723
1724 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1725 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1726 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1727 kill a child process.
1728
1729 @menu
1730 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1731 * Starting:: Starting your program
1732 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1733 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1734
1735 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1736 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1737 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1738 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1739
1740 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1741 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1742 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1743 @end menu
1744
1745 @node Compilation
1746 @section Compiling for Debugging
1747
1748 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752 and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755 the compiler.
1756
1757 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761 executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767 in pushing your luck.
1768
1769 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1770 @cindex debugging optimized code
1771 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793 provides macro information if you specify the options
1794 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798 @option{-g} alone.
1799
1800 @need 2000
1801 @node Starting
1802 @section Starting your Program
1803 @cindex starting
1804 @cindex running
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @kindex run
1808 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809 @item run
1810 @itemx r
1811 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1816
1817 @end table
1818
1819 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1822 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1823 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1824 message like this one:
1825
1826 @smallexample
1827 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1828 Try "help target" or "continue".
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent
1832 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1833 first (@pxref{load}).
1834
1835 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1836 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1837 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1838 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1839 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1840 divided into four categories:
1841
1842 @table @asis
1843 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1844 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1845 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1846 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1847 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1848 the arguments.
1849 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1850 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1851 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{environment.}
1854 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1855 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1856 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1857 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1858
1859 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1860 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1861 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1862 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1863
1864 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1865 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1866 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1867 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1868 set a different device for your program.
1869 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1870
1871 @cindex pipes
1872 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1873 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1874 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1875 wrong program.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1879 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1880 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1881 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1882 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1883
1884 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1885 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1886 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1887 your current breakpoints.
1888
1889 @table @code
1890 @kindex start
1891 @item start
1892 @cindex run to main procedure
1893 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1894 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1895 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1896 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1897 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1898 procedure, depending on the language used.
1899
1900 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1901 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1902 the @samp{run} command.
1903
1904 @cindex elaboration phase
1905 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1906 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1907 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1908 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1909 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1910 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1911 will remain to halt execution.
1912
1913 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1914 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1915 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1916 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1917 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1918
1919 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1920 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1921 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1922 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1923 elaboration code before running your program.
1924
1925 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1926 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1927 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1928 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1929 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1930 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1931 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1932 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1933 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1934 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1935 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1936
1937 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1938 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1939 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1940 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1941
1942 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1943 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1944 environment:
1945
1946 @smallexample
1947 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1948 (@value{GDBP}) run
1949 @end smallexample
1950
1951 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
1952 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
1953
1954 @end table
1955
1956 @node Arguments
1957 @section Your Program's Arguments
1958
1959 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1960 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1961 @code{run} command.
1962 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1963 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1964 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1965 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1966 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1967
1968 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1969 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1970 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1971 the program, not by the shell.
1972
1973 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1974 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1975
1976 @table @code
1977 @kindex set args
1978 @item set args
1979 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1980 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1981 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1982 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1983 it again without arguments.
1984
1985 @kindex show args
1986 @item show args
1987 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1988 @end table
1989
1990 @node Environment
1991 @section Your Program's Environment
1992
1993 @cindex environment (of your program)
1994 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1995 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1996 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1997 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1998 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1999 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2000 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2001
2002 @table @code
2003 @kindex path
2004 @item path @var{directory}
2005 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2006 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2007 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2008 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2009 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2010 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2011 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2012
2013 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2014 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2015 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2016 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2017 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2018 @var{directory} to the search path.
2019 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2020 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2021
2022 @kindex show paths
2023 @item show paths
2024 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2025 environment variable).
2026
2027 @kindex show environment
2028 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2029 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2030 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2031 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2032 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2033
2034 @kindex set environment
2035 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2036 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2037 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2038 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2039 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2040 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2041 null value.
2042 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2043 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2044
2045 For example, this command:
2046
2047 @smallexample
2048 set env USER = foo
2049 @end smallexample
2050
2051 @noindent
2052 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2053 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2054 are not actually required.)
2055
2056 @kindex unset environment
2057 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2058 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2059 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2060 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2061 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2062 @end table
2063
2064 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2065 the shell indicated
2066 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2067 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2068 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2069 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2070 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2071 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2072 @file{.profile}.
2073
2074 @node Working Directory
2075 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2076
2077 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2078 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2079 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2080 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2081 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2082 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2083
2084 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2085 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2086 Specify Files}.
2087
2088 @table @code
2089 @kindex cd
2090 @cindex change working directory
2091 @item cd @var{directory}
2092 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2093
2094 @kindex pwd
2095 @item pwd
2096 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2097 @end table
2098
2099 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2100 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2101 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2102 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2103 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2104 current working directory of the debuggee.
2105
2106 @node Input/Output
2107 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2108
2109 @cindex redirection
2110 @cindex i/o
2111 @cindex terminal
2112 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2113 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2114 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2115 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2116 running your program.
2117
2118 @table @code
2119 @kindex info terminal
2120 @item info terminal
2121 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2122 program is using.
2123 @end table
2124
2125 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2126 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2127
2128 @smallexample
2129 run > outfile
2130 @end smallexample
2131
2132 @noindent
2133 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2134
2135 @kindex tty
2136 @cindex controlling terminal
2137 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2138 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2139 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2140 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2141 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2142
2143 @smallexample
2144 tty /dev/ttyb
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 @noindent
2148 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2149 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2150 that as their controlling terminal.
2151
2152 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2153 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2154 terminal.
2155
2156 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2157 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2158 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2159 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2160
2161 @cindex inferior tty
2162 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2163 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2164 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2165 program.
2166
2167 @table @code
2168 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2169 @kindex set inferior-tty
2170 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2171
2172 @item show inferior-tty
2173 @kindex show inferior-tty
2174 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2175 @end table
2176
2177 @node Attach
2178 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2179 @kindex attach
2180 @cindex attach
2181
2182 @table @code
2183 @item attach @var{process-id}
2184 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2185 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2186 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2187 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2188 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2189
2190 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2191 executing the command.
2192 @end table
2193
2194 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2195 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2196 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2197 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2198
2199 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2200 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2201 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2202 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2203 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2204 Specify Files}.
2205
2206 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2207 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2208 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2209 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2210 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2211 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2212 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2213
2214 @table @code
2215 @kindex detach
2216 @item detach
2217 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2218 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2219 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2220 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2221 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2222 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2223 executing the command.
2224 @end table
2225
2226 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2227 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2228 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2229 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2230 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2231 Messages}).
2232
2233 @node Kill Process
2234 @section Killing the Child Process
2235
2236 @table @code
2237 @kindex kill
2238 @item kill
2239 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2240 @end table
2241
2242 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2243 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2244 is running.
2245
2246 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2247 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2248 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2249 outside the debugger.
2250
2251 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2252 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2253 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2254 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2255 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2256 breakpoint settings).
2257
2258 @node Threads
2259 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2260
2261 @cindex threads of execution
2262 @cindex multiple threads
2263 @cindex switching threads
2264 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2265 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2266 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2267 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2268 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2269 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2270 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2271
2272 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2273 programs:
2274
2275 @itemize @bullet
2276 @item automatic notification of new threads
2277 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2278 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2279 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2280 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2281 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2282 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2283 messages on thread start and exit.
2284 @end itemize
2285
2286 @quotation
2287 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2288 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2289 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2290 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2291 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2292 like this:
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2296 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2297 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2298 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2299 @end smallexample
2300 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2301 @c doesn't support threads"?
2302 @end quotation
2303
2304 @cindex focus of debugging
2305 @cindex current thread
2306 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2307 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2308 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2309 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2310 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2311
2312 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2313 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2314 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2315 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2316 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2317 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2318 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2319 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2320 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2321 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2322
2323 @smallexample
2324 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2325 @end smallexample
2326
2327 @noindent
2328 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2329 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2330 further qualifier.
2331
2332 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2333 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2334 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2335 @c program?
2336 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2337 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2338 @c threads ab initio?
2339
2340 @cindex thread number
2341 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2342 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2343 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2344
2345 @table @code
2346 @kindex info threads
2347 @item info threads
2348 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2349 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2350
2351 @enumerate
2352 @item
2353 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2354
2355 @item
2356 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2357
2358 @item
2359 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2360 @end enumerate
2361
2362 @noindent
2363 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2364 indicates the current thread.
2365
2366 For example,
2367 @end table
2368 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2369
2370 @smallexample
2371 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2372 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2373 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2374 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2375 at threadtest.c:68
2376 @end smallexample
2377
2378 On HP-UX systems:
2379
2380 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2381 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2382 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2383 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2384 thread in your program.
2385
2386 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2387 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2388 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2389 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2390 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2391 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2392 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2393 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2394 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2395 HP-UX, you see
2396
2397 @smallexample
2398 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2399 @end smallexample
2400
2401 @noindent
2402 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2403
2404 @table @code
2405 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2406 @item info threads
2407 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2408 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2409
2410 @enumerate
2411 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2412
2413 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2414
2415 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2416 @end enumerate
2417
2418 @noindent
2419 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2420 indicates the current thread.
2421
2422 For example,
2423 @end table
2424 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2425
2426 @smallexample
2427 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2428 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2429 at quicksort.c:137
2430 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2431 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2432 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2433 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2434 @end smallexample
2435
2436 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2437 Solaris-specific command:
2438
2439 @table @code
2440 @item maint info sol-threads
2441 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2442 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2443 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2444 @end table
2445
2446 @table @code
2447 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2448 @item thread @var{threadno}
2449 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2450 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2451 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2452 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2453 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2454
2455 @smallexample
2456 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2457 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2458 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2459 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2460 @end smallexample
2461
2462 @noindent
2463 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2464 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2465 threads.
2466
2467 @kindex thread apply
2468 @cindex apply command to several threads
2469 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2470 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2471 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2472 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2473 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2474 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2475 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2476 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2477
2478 @kindex set print thread-events
2479 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2480 @item set print thread-events
2481 @itemx set print thread-events on
2482 @itemx set print thread-events off
2483 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2484 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2485 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2486 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2487 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2488
2489 @kindex show print thread-events
2490 @item show print thread-events
2491 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2492 have started and exited.
2493 @end table
2494
2495 @cindex automatic thread selection
2496 @cindex switching threads automatically
2497 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2498 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2499 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2500 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2501 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2502 thread.
2503
2504 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2505 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2506 programs with multiple threads.
2507
2508 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2509 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2510
2511 @node Processes
2512 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2513
2514 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2515 @cindex multiple processes
2516 @cindex processes, multiple
2517 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2518 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2519 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2520 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2521 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2522 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2523 will cause it to terminate.
2524
2525 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2526 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2527 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2528 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2529 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2530 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2531 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2532 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2533 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2534 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2535
2536 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2537 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2538 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2539 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2540
2541 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2542 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2543
2544 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2545 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2546
2547 @table @code
2548 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2549 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2550 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2551 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2552 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2553
2554 @table @code
2555 @item parent
2556 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2557 unimpeded. This is the default.
2558
2559 @item child
2560 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2561 unimpeded.
2562
2563 @end table
2564
2565 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2566 @item show follow-fork-mode
2567 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2568 @end table
2569
2570 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2571 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2572 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2573
2574 @table @code
2575 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2576 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2577 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2578 retain debugger control over them both.
2579
2580 @table @code
2581 @item on
2582 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2583 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2584 independently. This is the default.
2585
2586 @item off
2587 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2588 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2589 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2590 is held suspended.
2591
2592 @end table
2593
2594 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2595 @item show detach-on-fork
2596 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2597 @end table
2598
2599 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2600 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2601 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2602 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2603 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2604
2605 @table @code
2606 @kindex info forks
2607 @item info forks
2608 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2609 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2610 position (program counter) of the process.
2611
2612 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2613 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2614 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2615 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2616 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2617
2618 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2619 @item process @var{process-id}
2620 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2621 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2622 @samp{info forks}.
2623
2624 @end table
2625
2626 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2627 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2628 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2629 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2630
2631 @table @code
2632 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2633 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2634 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2635 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2636 allowed to run independently.
2637
2638 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2639 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2640 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2641 and remove it from the fork list.
2642
2643 @end table
2644
2645 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2646 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2647 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2648 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2649 the child process's @code{main}.
2650
2651 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2652 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2653
2654 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2655 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2656 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2657 argument.
2658
2659 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2660 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2661 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2662
2663 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2664 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2665
2666 @cindex checkpoint
2667 @cindex restart
2668 @cindex bookmark
2669 @cindex snapshot of a process
2670 @cindex rewind program state
2671
2672 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2673 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2674 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2675 later.
2676
2677 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2678 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2679 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2680 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2681 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2682
2683 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2684 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2685 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2686 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2687 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2688 start again from there.
2689
2690 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2691 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2692
2693 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2694
2695 @table @code
2696 @kindex checkpoint
2697 @item checkpoint
2698 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2699 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2700 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2701
2702 @kindex info checkpoints
2703 @item info checkpoints
2704 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2705 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2706 listed:
2707
2708 @table @code
2709 @item Checkpoint ID
2710 @item Process ID
2711 @item Code Address
2712 @item Source line, or label
2713 @end table
2714
2715 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2716 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2717 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2718 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2719 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2720 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2721 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2722
2723 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2724 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2725 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2726 the debugger.
2727
2728 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2729 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2730 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2731
2732 @end table
2733
2734 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2735 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2736 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2737 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2738 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2739 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2740 previously read data can be read again.
2741
2742 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2743 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2744 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2745 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2746 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2747 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2748
2749 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2750 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2751 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2752 different execution path this time.
2753
2754 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2755 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2756 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2757 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2758 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2759 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2760 potentially pose a problem.
2761
2762 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2763
2764 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2765 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2766 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2767 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2768 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2769 next.
2770
2771 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2772 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2773 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2774 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2775 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2776
2777 @node Stopping
2778 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2779
2780 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2781 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2782 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2783
2784 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2785 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2786 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2787 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2788 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2789 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2790 explicitly request this information at any time.
2791
2792 @table @code
2793 @kindex info program
2794 @item info program
2795 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2796 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2797 @end table
2798
2799 @menu
2800 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2801 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2802 * Signals:: Signals
2803 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2804 @end menu
2805
2806 @node Breakpoints
2807 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2808
2809 @cindex breakpoints
2810 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2811 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2812 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2813 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2814 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2815 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2816 program.
2817
2818 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2819 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2820 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2821 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2822 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2823 call).
2824
2825 @cindex watchpoints
2826 @cindex data breakpoints
2827 @cindex memory tracing
2828 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2829 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2830 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2831 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2832 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2833 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2834 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2835 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2836 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2837 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2838 same commands.
2839
2840 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2841 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2842 Automatic Display}.
2843
2844 @cindex catchpoints
2845 @cindex breakpoint on events
2846 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2847 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2848 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2849 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2850 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2851 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2852 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2853
2854 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2855 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2856 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2857 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2858 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2859 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2860 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2861 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2862 enable it again.
2863
2864 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2865 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2866 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2867 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2868 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2869 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2870 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2871
2872 @menu
2873 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2874 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2875 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2876 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2877 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2878 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2879 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2880 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2881 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2882 @end menu
2883
2884 @node Set Breaks
2885 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2886
2887 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2888 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2889 @c
2890 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2891
2892 @kindex break
2893 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2894 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2895 @cindex latest breakpoint
2896 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2897 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2898 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2899 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2900 convenience variables.
2901
2902 @table @code
2903 @item break @var{location}
2904 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2905 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2906 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2907 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2908 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2909
2910 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2911 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2912 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
2913 that situation.
2914
2915 @item break
2916 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2917 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2918 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2919 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2920 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2921 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2922 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2923 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2924 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2925 inside loops.
2926
2927 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2928 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2929 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2930 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2931 existed when your program stopped.
2932
2933 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2934 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2935 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2936 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2937 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2938 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2939 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2940
2941 @kindex tbreak
2942 @item tbreak @var{args}
2943 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2944 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2945 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2946 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2947
2948 @kindex hbreak
2949 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2950 @item hbreak @var{args}
2951 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2952 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2953 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2954 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2955 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2956 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2957 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2958 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2959 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2960 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2961 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2962 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2963 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2964 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2965 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2966 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2967 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2968 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2969
2970 @kindex thbreak
2971 @item thbreak @var{args}
2972 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2973 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2974 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2975 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2976 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2977 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2978 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2979 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2980
2981 @kindex rbreak
2982 @cindex regular expression
2983 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2984 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2985 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2986 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2987 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2988 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2989 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2990 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2991 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2992
2993 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2994 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2995 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2996 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2997 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2998 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2999
3000 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3001 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3002 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3003 classes.
3004
3005 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3006 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3007 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3008
3009 @smallexample
3010 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3011 @end smallexample
3012
3013 @kindex info breakpoints
3014 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3015 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3016 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3017 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3018 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3019 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3020 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3021 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3022
3023 @table @emph
3024 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3025 @item Type
3026 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3027 @item Disposition
3028 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3029 @item Enabled or Disabled
3030 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3031 that are not enabled.
3032 @item Address
3033 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3034 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3035 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3036 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3037 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3038 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3039 @item What
3040 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3041 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3042 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3043 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3044 @end table
3045
3046 @noindent
3047 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3048 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3049 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3050 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3051 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3052 valid location.
3053
3054 @noindent
3055 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3056 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3057 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3058 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3059 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3060
3061 @noindent
3062 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3063 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3064 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3065 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3066 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3067 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3068 @end table
3069
3070 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3071 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3072 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3073 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3074
3075 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3076 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3077 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3078 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3079
3080 @itemize @bullet
3081 @item
3082 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3083 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3084
3085 @item
3086 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3087 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3088
3089 @item
3090 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3091 several places where that function is inlined.
3092 @end itemize
3093
3094 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3095 the relevant locations@footnote{
3096 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3097 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3098 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3099 info with line numbers for them.}.
3100
3101 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3102 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3103 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3104 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3105 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3106 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3107 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3108
3109 For example:
3110
3111 @smallexample
3112 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3113 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3114 stop only if i==1
3115 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3116 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3117 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3118 @end smallexample
3119
3120 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3121 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3122 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3123 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3124 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3125 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3126 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3127 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3128 that belong to that breakpoint.
3129
3130 @cindex pending breakpoints
3131 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3132 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3133 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3134 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3135 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3136 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3137 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3138 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3139 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3140 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3141 is not yet resolved.
3142
3143 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3144 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3145 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3146 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3147 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3148 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3149
3150 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3151 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3152 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3153 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3154
3155 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3156 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3157 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3158
3159 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3160 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3161 address specification to an address:
3162
3163 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3164 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3165 @table @code
3166 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3167 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3168 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3169
3170 @item set breakpoint pending on
3171 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3172 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3173
3174 @item set breakpoint pending off
3175 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3176 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3177 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3178
3179 @item show breakpoint pending
3180 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3181 @end table
3182
3183 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3184 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3185 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3186
3187 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3188 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3189 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3190 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3191 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3192 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3193 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3194 breakpoints.
3195
3196 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3197
3198 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3199 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3200 @table @code
3201 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3202 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3203 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3204 breakpoint must be used.
3205
3206 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3207 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3208 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3209 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3210 @end table
3211
3212 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3213 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3214 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3215 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3216 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3217 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3218 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3219 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3220 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3221
3222 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3223 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3224 @table @code
3225 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3226 This is the default behaviour. All breakpoints, including newly added
3227 by the user, are inserted in the target only when the target is
3228 resumed. All breakpoints are removed from the target when it stops.
3229
3230 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3231 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3232 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3233 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3234 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3235 @end table
3236
3237 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3238 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3239 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3240 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3241 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3242 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3243 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3244 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3245
3246
3247 @node Set Watchpoints
3248 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3249
3250 @cindex setting watchpoints
3251 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3252 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3253 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3254 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3255 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3256
3257 @itemize @bullet
3258 @item
3259 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3260
3261 @item
3262 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3263 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3264 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3265
3266 @item
3267 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3268 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3269 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3270 @end itemize
3271
3272 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3273 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3274 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3275 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3276 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3277 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3278 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3279 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3280 the expression changes.
3281
3282 @cindex software watchpoints
3283 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3284 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3285 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3286 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3287 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3288 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3289 culprit.)
3290
3291 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3292 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3293 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3294
3295 @table @code
3296 @kindex watch
3297 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3298 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3299 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3300 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3301 to watch the value of a single variable:
3302
3303 @smallexample
3304 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3305 @end smallexample
3306
3307 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3308 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3309 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3310 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3311 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3312 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3313
3314 @kindex rwatch
3315 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3316 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3317 by the program.
3318
3319 @kindex awatch
3320 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3321 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3322 or written into by the program.
3323
3324 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3325 @item info watchpoints
3326 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3327 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3328 @end table
3329
3330 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3331 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3332 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3333 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3334 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3335 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3336
3337 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3338 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3339 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3340 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3341 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3342 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3343 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3344 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3345
3346 @table @code
3347 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3348 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3349 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3350
3351 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3352 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3353 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3354 @end table
3355
3356 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3357 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3358 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3359
3360 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3361
3362 @smallexample
3363 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3364 @end smallexample
3365
3366 @noindent
3367 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3368
3369 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3370 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3371 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3372 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3373 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3374 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3375 will print a message like this:
3376
3377 @smallexample
3378 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3379 @end smallexample
3380
3381 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3382 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3383 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3384 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3385 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3386 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3387 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3388 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3389
3390 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3391 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3392 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3393 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3394 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3395 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3396
3397 @smallexample
3398 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3399 @end smallexample
3400
3401 @noindent
3402 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3403
3404 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3405 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3406 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3407 expression with separately allocated resources.
3408
3409 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3410 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3411 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3412
3413 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3414 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3415 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3416 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3417 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3418 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3419 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3420 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3421 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3422
3423 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3424 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3425 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3426 watched expression from every thread.
3427
3428 @quotation
3429 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3430 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3431 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3432 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3433 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3434 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3435 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3436 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3437 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3438 @end quotation
3439
3440 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3441
3442 @node Set Catchpoints
3443 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3444 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3445 @cindex exception handlers
3446 @cindex event handling
3447
3448 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3449 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3450 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3451
3452 @table @code
3453 @kindex catch
3454 @item catch @var{event}
3455 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3456 @table @code
3457 @item throw
3458 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3459 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3460
3461 @item catch
3462 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3463
3464 @item exception
3465 @cindex Ada exception catching
3466 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3467 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3468 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3469 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3470 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3471
3472 @item exception unhandled
3473 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3474
3475 @item assert
3476 A failed Ada assertion.
3477
3478 @item exec
3479 @cindex break on fork/exec
3480 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3481 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3482
3483 @item fork
3484 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3485 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3486
3487 @item vfork
3488 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3489 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3490
3491 @item load
3492 @itemx load @var{libname}
3493 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3494 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3495 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3496
3497 @item unload
3498 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3499 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3500 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3501 @end table
3502
3503 @item tcatch @var{event}
3504 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3505 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3506
3507 @end table
3508
3509 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3510
3511 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3512 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3513
3514 @itemize @bullet
3515 @item
3516 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3517 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3518 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3519 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3520 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3521 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3522 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3523 disabled within interactive calls.
3524
3525 @item
3526 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3527
3528 @item
3529 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3530 @end itemize
3531
3532 @cindex raise exceptions
3533 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3534 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3535 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3536 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3537 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3538 out where the exception was raised.
3539
3540 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3541 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3542 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3543 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3544
3545 @smallexample
3546 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3547 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3548 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3549 @end smallexample
3550
3551 @noindent
3552 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3553 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3554 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3555
3556 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3557 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3558 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3559 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3560 raised.
3561
3562
3563 @node Delete Breaks
3564 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3565
3566 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3567 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3568 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3569 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3570 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3571 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3572
3573 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3574 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3575 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3576 their breakpoint numbers.
3577
3578 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3579 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3580 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3581
3582 @table @code
3583 @kindex clear
3584 @item clear
3585 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3586 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3587 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3588 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3589
3590 @item clear @var{location}
3591 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3592 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3593 most useful ones are listed below:
3594
3595 @table @code
3596 @item clear @var{function}
3597 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3598 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3599
3600 @item clear @var{linenum}
3601 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3602 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3603 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3604 @end table
3605
3606 @cindex delete breakpoints
3607 @kindex delete
3608 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3609 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3610 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3611 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3612 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3613 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3614 @end table
3615
3616 @node Disabling
3617 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3618
3619 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3620 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3621 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3622 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3623 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3624
3625 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3626 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3627 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3628 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3629 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3630
3631 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3632 affects all of its locations.
3633
3634 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3635 states of enablement:
3636
3637 @itemize @bullet
3638 @item
3639 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3640 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3641 @item
3642 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3643 @item
3644 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3645 disabled.
3646 @item
3647 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3648 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3649 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3650 @end itemize
3651
3652 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3653 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3654
3655 @table @code
3656 @kindex disable
3657 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3658 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3659 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3660 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3661 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3662 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3663 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3664
3665 @kindex enable
3666 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3667 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3668 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3669
3670 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3671 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3672 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3673
3674 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3675 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3676 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3677 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3678 @end table
3679
3680 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3681 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3682 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3683 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3684 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3685 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3686 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3687 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3688 Stepping}.)
3689
3690 @node Conditions
3691 @subsection Break Conditions
3692 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3693 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3694
3695 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3696 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3697 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3698 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3699 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3700 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3701 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3702 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3703
3704 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3705 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3706 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3707 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3708 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3709
3710 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3711 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3712 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3713 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3714 one.
3715
3716 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3717 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3718 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3719 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3720 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3721 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3722 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3723 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3724 conditions for the
3725 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3726 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3727
3728 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3729 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3730 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3731 with the @code{condition} command.
3732
3733 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3734 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3735 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3736 catchpoint.
3737
3738 @table @code
3739 @kindex condition
3740 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3741 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3742 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3743 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3744 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3745 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3746 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3747 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3748 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3749 prints an error message:
3750
3751 @smallexample
3752 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3753 @end smallexample
3754
3755 @noindent
3756 @value{GDBN} does
3757 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3758 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3759 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3760
3761 @item condition @var{bnum}
3762 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3763 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3764 @end table
3765
3766 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3767 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3768 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3769 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3770 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3771 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3772 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3773 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3774 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3775 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3776 your program reaches it.
3777
3778 @table @code
3779 @kindex ignore
3780 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3781 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3782 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3783 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3784 takes no action.
3785
3786 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3787 a count of zero.
3788
3789 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3790 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3791 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3792 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3793
3794 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3795 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3796 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3797
3798 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3799 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3800 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3801 Variables}.
3802 @end table
3803
3804 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3805
3806
3807 @node Break Commands
3808 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3809
3810 @cindex breakpoint commands
3811 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3812 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3813 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3814 enable other breakpoints.
3815
3816 @table @code
3817 @kindex commands
3818 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3819 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3820 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3821 @itemx end
3822 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3823 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3824 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3825
3826 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3827 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3828
3829 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3830 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3831 recently encountered).
3832 @end table
3833
3834 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3835 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3836
3837 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3838 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3839 that resumes execution.
3840
3841 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3842 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3843 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3844 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3845 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3846
3847 @kindex silent
3848 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3849 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3850 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3851 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3852 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3853 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3854
3855 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3856 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3857 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3858
3859 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3860 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3861
3862 @smallexample
3863 break foo if x>0
3864 commands
3865 silent
3866 printf "x is %d\n",x
3867 cont
3868 end
3869 @end smallexample
3870
3871 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3872 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3873 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3874 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3875 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3876 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3877 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3878
3879 @smallexample
3880 break 403
3881 commands
3882 silent
3883 set x = y + 4
3884 cont
3885 end
3886 @end smallexample
3887
3888 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3889 @node Error in Breakpoints
3890 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3891 @c
3892 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3893 @c
3894 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3895 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3896 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3897 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3898
3899 @smallexample
3900 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3901 The same program may be running in another process.
3902 @end smallexample
3903
3904 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3905
3906 @enumerate
3907 @item
3908 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3909
3910 @item
3911 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3912 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3913 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3914 Then start your program again.
3915
3916 @item
3917 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3918 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3919 to nonsharable executables.
3920 @end enumerate
3921 @c @end ifclear
3922
3923 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3924 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3925
3926 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3927 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3928 @smallexample
3929 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3930 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3931 @end smallexample
3932
3933 @noindent
3934 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3935 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3936 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3937
3938 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3939 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3940
3941 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3942 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3943 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3944
3945 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3946 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3947 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3948 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3949
3950 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3951 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3952 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3953 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3954 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3955 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3956 first in the bundle.
3957
3958 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3959 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3960 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3961 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3962 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3963 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3964 is hit.
3965
3966 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3967 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3968
3969 @smallexample
3970 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3971 @end smallexample
3972
3973 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3974 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3975 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3976 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3977 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3978 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3979 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3980 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3981
3982 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3983 adjusted breakpoints:
3984
3985 @smallexample
3986 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3987 to 0x00010410.
3988 @end smallexample
3989
3990 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3991 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3992 frequently than expected.
3993
3994 @node Continuing and Stepping
3995 @section Continuing and Stepping
3996
3997 @cindex stepping
3998 @cindex continuing
3999 @cindex resuming execution
4000 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4001 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4002 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4003 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4004 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4005 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4006 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4007 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4008
4009 @table @code
4010 @kindex continue
4011 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4012 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4013 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4014 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4015 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4016 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4017 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4018 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4019 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4020 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4021
4022 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4023 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4024 @code{continue} is ignored.
4025
4026 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4027 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4028 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4029 @code{continue}.
4030 @end table
4031
4032 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4033 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4034 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4035 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4036
4037 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4038 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4039 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4040 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4041 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4042 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4043
4044 @table @code
4045 @kindex step
4046 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4047 @item step
4048 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4049 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4050 abbreviated @code{s}.
4051
4052 @quotation
4053 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4054 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4055 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4056 @c distinction here.
4057 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4058 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4059 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4060 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4061 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4062 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4063 below.
4064 @end quotation
4065
4066 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4067 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4068 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4069 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4070 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4071 called within the line.
4072
4073 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4074 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4075 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4076 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4077 was any debugging information about the routine.
4078
4079 @item step @var{count}
4080 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4081 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4082 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4083
4084 @kindex next
4085 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4086 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4087 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4088 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4089 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4090 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4091 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4092 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4093
4094 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4095
4096
4097 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4098 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4099 @c
4100 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4101 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4102 @c function are executed without stopping.
4103
4104 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4105 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4106 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4107
4108 @kindex set step-mode
4109 @item set step-mode
4110 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4111 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4112 @itemx set step-mode on
4113 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4114 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4115 information rather than stepping over it.
4116
4117 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4118 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4119 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4120
4121 @item set step-mode off
4122 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4123 debug information. This is the default.
4124
4125 @item show step-mode
4126 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4127 source line debug information.
4128
4129 @kindex finish
4130 @item finish
4131 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4132 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4133
4134 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4135 ,Returning from a Function}).
4136
4137 @kindex until
4138 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4139 @cindex run until specified location
4140 @item until
4141 @itemx u
4142 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4143 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4144 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4145 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4146 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4147 than the address of the jump.
4148
4149 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4150 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4151 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4152 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4153 through the next iteration.
4154
4155 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4156 stack frame.
4157
4158 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4159 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4160 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4161 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4162 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4163
4164 @smallexample
4165 (@value{GDBP}) f
4166 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4167 206 expand_input();
4168 (@value{GDBP}) until
4169 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4170 @end smallexample
4171
4172 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4173 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4174 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4175 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4176 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4177 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4178 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4179
4180 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4181 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4182 argument.
4183
4184 @item until @var{location}
4185 @itemx u @var{location}
4186 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4187 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4188 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4189 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4190 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4191 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4192 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4193 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4194 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4195 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4196 invocations have returned.
4197
4198 @smallexample
4199 94 int factorial (int value)
4200 95 @{
4201 96 if (value > 1) @{
4202 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4203 98 @}
4204 99 return (value);
4205 100 @}
4206 @end smallexample
4207
4208
4209 @kindex advance @var{location}
4210 @itemx advance @var{location}
4211 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4212 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4213 @ref{Specify Location}.
4214 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4215 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4216 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4217 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4218
4219
4220 @kindex stepi
4221 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4222 @item stepi
4223 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4224 @itemx si
4225 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4226
4227 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4228 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4229 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4230 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4231
4232 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4233
4234 @need 750
4235 @kindex nexti
4236 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4237 @item nexti
4238 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4239 @itemx ni
4240 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4241 proceed until the function returns.
4242
4243 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4244 @end table
4245
4246 @node Signals
4247 @section Signals
4248 @cindex signals
4249
4250 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4251 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4252 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4253 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4254 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4255 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4256 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4257 requested an alarm).
4258
4259 @cindex fatal signals
4260 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4261 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4262 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4263 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4264 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4265 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4266
4267 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4268 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4269 signal.
4270
4271 @cindex handling signals
4272 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4273 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4274 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4275 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4276 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4277
4278 @table @code
4279 @kindex info signals
4280 @kindex info handle
4281 @item info signals
4282 @itemx info handle
4283 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4284 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4285 the defined types of signals.
4286
4287 @item info signals @var{sig}
4288 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4289
4290 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4291
4292 @kindex handle
4293 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4294 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4295 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4296 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4297 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4298 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4299 say what change to make.
4300 @end table
4301
4302 @c @group
4303 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4304 Their full names are:
4305
4306 @table @code
4307 @item nostop
4308 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4309 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4310
4311 @item stop
4312 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4313 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4314
4315 @item print
4316 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4317
4318 @item noprint
4319 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4320 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4321
4322 @item pass
4323 @itemx noignore
4324 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4325 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4326 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4327
4328 @item nopass
4329 @itemx ignore
4330 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4331 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4332 @end table
4333 @c @end group
4334
4335 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4336 program until you
4337 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4338 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4339 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4340 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4341 program sees that signal when you continue.
4342
4343 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4344 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4345 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4346 erroneous signals.
4347
4348 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4349 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4350 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4351 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4352 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4353 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4354 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4355 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4356 Program a Signal}.
4357
4358 @node Thread Stops
4359 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4360
4361 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4362 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4363 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4364
4365 @table @code
4366 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4367 @cindex thread breakpoints
4368 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4369 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4370 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4371 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4372 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4373 specify some source line.
4374
4375 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4376 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4377 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4378 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4379 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4380
4381 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4382 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4383 program.
4384
4385 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4386 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4387 breakpoint condition, like this:
4388
4389 @smallexample
4390 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4391 @end smallexample
4392
4393 @end table
4394
4395 @cindex stopped threads
4396 @cindex threads, stopped
4397 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4398 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4399 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4400 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4401 underfoot.
4402
4403 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4404 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4405 @cindex premature return from system calls
4406 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4407 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4408 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4409 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4410 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4411 stop execution.
4412
4413 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4414 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4415 style anyways.
4416
4417 For example, do not write code like this:
4418
4419 @smallexample
4420 sleep (10);
4421 @end smallexample
4422
4423 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4424 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4425
4426 Instead, write this:
4427
4428 @smallexample
4429 int unslept = 10;
4430 while (unslept > 0)
4431 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4432 @end smallexample
4433
4434 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4435 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4436 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4437 @value{GDBN}.
4438
4439 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4440 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4441 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4442 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4443
4444 @cindex continuing threads
4445 @cindex threads, continuing
4446 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4447 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4448 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4449
4450 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4451 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4452 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4453 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4454 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4455 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4456 stops.
4457
4458 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4459 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4460 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4461 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4462
4463 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4464 thread to run.
4465
4466 @table @code
4467 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4468 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4469 @cindex lock scheduler
4470 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4471 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4472 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4473 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4474 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4475 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4476 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4477 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4478 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4479 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4480 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4481
4482 @item show scheduler-locking
4483 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4484 @end table
4485
4486
4487 @node Stack
4488 @chapter Examining the Stack
4489
4490 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4491 stopped and how it got there.
4492
4493 @cindex call stack
4494 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4495 is generated.
4496 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4497 the arguments of the call,
4498 and the local variables of the function being called.
4499 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4500 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4501 stack}.
4502
4503 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4504 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4505
4506 @cindex selected frame
4507 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4508 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4509 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4510 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4511 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4512 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4513
4514 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4515 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4516 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4517
4518 @menu
4519 * Frames:: Stack frames
4520 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4521 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4522 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4523
4524 @end menu
4525
4526 @node Frames
4527 @section Stack Frames
4528
4529 @cindex frame, definition
4530 @cindex stack frame
4531 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4532 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4533 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4534 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4535 which the function is executing.
4536
4537 @cindex initial frame
4538 @cindex outermost frame
4539 @cindex innermost frame
4540 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4541 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4542 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4543 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4544 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4545 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4546 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4547 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4548
4549 @cindex frame pointer
4550 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4551 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4552 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4553 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4554 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4555 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4556
4557 @cindex frame number
4558 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4559 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4560 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4561 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4562 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4563
4564 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4565 @c underflow problems.
4566 @cindex frameless execution
4567 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4568 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4569 @smallexample
4570 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4571 @end smallexample
4572 generates functions without a frame.)
4573 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4574 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4575 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4576 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4577 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4578 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4579 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4580
4581 @table @code
4582 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4583 @cindex current stack frame
4584 @item frame @var{args}
4585 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4586 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4587 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4588 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4589
4590 @kindex select-frame
4591 @cindex selecting frame silently
4592 @item select-frame
4593 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4594 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4595 @code{frame}.
4596 @end table
4597
4598 @node Backtrace
4599 @section Backtraces
4600
4601 @cindex traceback
4602 @cindex call stack traces
4603 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4604 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4605 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4606 stack.
4607
4608 @table @code
4609 @kindex backtrace
4610 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4611 @item backtrace
4612 @itemx bt
4613 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4614 frames in the stack.
4615
4616 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4617 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4618
4619 @item backtrace @var{n}
4620 @itemx bt @var{n}
4621 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4622
4623 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4624 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4625 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4626
4627 @item backtrace full
4628 @itemx bt full
4629 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4630 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4631 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4632 number of frames to print, as described above.
4633 @end table
4634
4635 @kindex where
4636 @kindex info stack
4637 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4638 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4639
4640 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4641 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4642 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4643 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4644 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4645 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4646 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4647 multi-threaded program.
4648
4649 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4650 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4651 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4652 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4653 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4654 line number.
4655
4656 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4657 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4658
4659 @smallexample
4660 @group
4661 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4662 at builtin.c:993
4663 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4664 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4665 at macro.c:71
4666 (More stack frames follow...)
4667 @end group
4668 @end smallexample
4669
4670 @noindent
4671 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4672 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4673 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4674
4675 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4676 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4677 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4678 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4679 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4680 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4681 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4682 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4683 such a backtrace might look like:
4684
4685 @smallexample
4686 @group
4687 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4688 at builtin.c:993
4689 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4690 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4691 at macro.c:71
4692 (More stack frames follow...)
4693 @end group
4694 @end smallexample
4695
4696 @noindent
4697 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4698 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4699
4700 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4701 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4702 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4703
4704 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4705 @cindex program entry point
4706 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4707 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4708 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4709 @code{main}@footnote{
4710 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4711 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4712 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4713 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4714 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4715 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4716
4717 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4718 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4719
4720 @table @code
4721 @item set backtrace past-main
4722 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4723 @kindex set backtrace
4724 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4725
4726 @item set backtrace past-main off
4727 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4728 default.
4729
4730 @item show backtrace past-main
4731 @kindex show backtrace
4732 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4733
4734 @item set backtrace past-entry
4735 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4736 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4737 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4738 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4739
4740 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4741 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4742 application. This is the default.
4743
4744 @item show backtrace past-entry
4745 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4746
4747 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4748 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4749 @cindex backtrace limit
4750 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4751 unlimited.
4752
4753 @item show backtrace limit
4754 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4755 @end table
4756
4757 @node Selection
4758 @section Selecting a Frame
4759
4760 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4761 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4762 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4763 of the stack frame just selected.
4764
4765 @table @code
4766 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4767 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4768 @item frame @var{n}
4769 @itemx f @var{n}
4770 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4771 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4772 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4773 @code{main}.
4774
4775 @item frame @var{addr}
4776 @itemx f @var{addr}
4777 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4778 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4779 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4780 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4781 switches between them.
4782
4783 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4784 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4785
4786 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4787 pointer and a program counter.
4788
4789 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4790 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4791
4792 @kindex up
4793 @item up @var{n}
4794 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4795 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4796 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4797
4798 @kindex down
4799 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4800 @item down @var{n}
4801 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4802 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4803 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4804 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4805 @end table
4806
4807 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4808 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4809 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4810 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4811
4812 @need 1000
4813 For example:
4814
4815 @smallexample
4816 @group
4817 (@value{GDBP}) up
4818 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4819 at env.c:10
4820 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4821 @end group
4822 @end smallexample
4823
4824 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4825 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4826 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4827 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4828 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4829 for details.
4830
4831 @table @code
4832 @kindex down-silently
4833 @kindex up-silently
4834 @item up-silently @var{n}
4835 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4836 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4837 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4838 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4839 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4840 distracting.
4841 @end table
4842
4843 @node Frame Info
4844 @section Information About a Frame
4845
4846 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4847 stack frame.
4848
4849 @table @code
4850 @item frame
4851 @itemx f
4852 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4853 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4854 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4855 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4856 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4857
4858 @kindex info frame
4859 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4860 @item info frame
4861 @itemx info f
4862 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4863 including:
4864
4865 @itemize @bullet
4866 @item
4867 the address of the frame
4868 @item
4869 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4870 @item
4871 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4872 @item
4873 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4874 @item
4875 the address of the frame's arguments
4876 @item
4877 the address of the frame's local variables
4878 @item
4879 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4880 @item
4881 which registers were saved in the frame
4882 @end itemize
4883
4884 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4885 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4886 the usual conventions.
4887
4888 @item info frame @var{addr}
4889 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4890 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4891 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4892 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4893 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4894 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4895
4896 @kindex info args
4897 @item info args
4898 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4899
4900 @item info locals
4901 @kindex info locals
4902 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4903 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4904 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4905
4906 @kindex info catch
4907 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4908 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4909 @item info catch
4910 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4911 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4912 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4913 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4914 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4915
4916 @end table
4917
4918
4919 @node Source
4920 @chapter Examining Source Files
4921
4922 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4923 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4924 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4925 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4926 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4927 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4928 source files by explicit command.
4929
4930 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4931 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4932 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4933
4934 @menu
4935 * List:: Printing source lines
4936 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
4937 * Edit:: Editing source files
4938 * Search:: Searching source files
4939 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4940 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4941 @end menu
4942
4943 @node List
4944 @section Printing Source Lines
4945
4946 @kindex list
4947 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4948 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4949 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4950 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
4951 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
4952
4953 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4954
4955 @table @code
4956 @item list @var{linenum}
4957 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4958 current source file.
4959
4960 @item list @var{function}
4961 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4962 @var{function}.
4963
4964 @item list
4965 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4966 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4967 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4968 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4969 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4970
4971 @item list -
4972 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4973 @end table
4974
4975 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4976 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4977 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4978
4979 @table @code
4980 @kindex set listsize
4981 @item set listsize @var{count}
4982 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4983 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4984
4985 @kindex show listsize
4986 @item show listsize
4987 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4988 @end table
4989
4990 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4991 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4992 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4993 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4994 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4995
4996 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4997 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4998 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
4999 to specify some source line.
5000
5001 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5002
5003 @table @code
5004 @item list @var{linespec}
5005 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5006
5007 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5008 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5009 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5010 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5011 the same source file as the first linespec.
5012
5013 @item list ,@var{last}
5014 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5015
5016 @item list @var{first},
5017 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5018
5019 @item list +
5020 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5021
5022 @item list -
5023 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5024
5025 @item list
5026 As described in the preceding table.
5027 @end table
5028
5029 @node Specify Location
5030 @section Specifying a Location
5031 @cindex specifying location
5032 @cindex linespec
5033
5034 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5035 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5036 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5037 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5038
5039 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5040 @value{GDBN} understands:
5041
5042 @table @code
5043 @item @var{linenum}
5044 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5045
5046 @item -@var{offset}
5047 @itemx +@var{offset}
5048 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5049 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5050 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5051 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5052 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5053 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5054 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5055 linespec.
5056
5057 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5058 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5059
5060 @item @var{function}
5061 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5062 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5063
5064 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5065 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5066 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5067 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5068 functions in different source files.
5069
5070 @item *@var{address}
5071 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5072 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5073 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5074 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5075 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5076 source files.
5077
5078 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5079 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5080 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5081 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5082 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5083 of @var{address}:
5084
5085 @table @code
5086 @item @var{expression}
5087 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5088
5089 @item @var{funcaddr}
5090 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5091 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5092 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5093 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5094 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5095 (although the Pascal form also works).
5096
5097 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5098 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5099
5100 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5101 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5102 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5103 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5104 functions with identical names in different source files.
5105 @end table
5106
5107 @end table
5108
5109
5110 @node Edit
5111 @section Editing Source Files
5112 @cindex editing source files
5113
5114 @kindex edit
5115 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5116 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5117 The editing program of your choice
5118 is invoked with the current line set to
5119 the active line in the program.
5120 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5121 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5122
5123 @table @code
5124 @item edit @var{location}
5125 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5126 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5127 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5128 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5129 command most commonly used:
5130
5131 @table @code
5132 @item edit @var{number}
5133 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5134
5135 @item edit @var{function}
5136 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5137 @end table
5138
5139 @end table
5140
5141 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5142 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5143 @footnote{
5144 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5145 following command-line syntax:
5146 @smallexample
5147 ex +@var{number} file
5148 @end smallexample
5149 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5150 the file where to start editing.}.
5151 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5152 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5153 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5154 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5155 @smallexample
5156 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5157 export EDITOR
5158 gdb @dots{}
5159 @end smallexample
5160 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5161 @smallexample
5162 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5163 gdb @dots{}
5164 @end smallexample
5165
5166 @node Search
5167 @section Searching Source Files
5168 @cindex searching source files
5169
5170 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5171 regular expression.
5172
5173 @table @code
5174 @kindex search
5175 @kindex forward-search
5176 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5177 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5178 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5179 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5180 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5181 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5182 @code{fo}.
5183
5184 @kindex reverse-search
5185 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5186 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5187 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5188 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5189 this command as @code{rev}.
5190 @end table
5191
5192 @node Source Path
5193 @section Specifying Source Directories
5194
5195 @cindex source path
5196 @cindex directories for source files
5197 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5198 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5199 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5200 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5201 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5202 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5203 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5204
5205 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5206 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5207 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5208 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5209 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5210 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5211 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5212 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5213 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5214 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5215 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5216
5217 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5218 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5219 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5220 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5221 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5222 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5223
5224 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5225 source files.
5226
5227 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5228 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5229 each line is in the file.
5230
5231 @kindex directory
5232 @kindex dir
5233 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5234 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5235 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5236
5237 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5238 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5239
5240 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5241 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5242 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5243 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5244 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5245 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5246 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5247 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5248 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5249 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5250 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5251 name to look up the sources.
5252
5253 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5254 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5255 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5256 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5257 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5258 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5259 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5260 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5261
5262 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5263 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5264 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5265 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5266 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5267 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5268 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5269
5270 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5271 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5272 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5273 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5274 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5275 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5276 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5277 command.
5278
5279 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5280 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5281 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5282 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5283 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5284 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5285 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5286
5287 @table @code
5288 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5289 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5290 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5291 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5292 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5293 part of absolute file names) or
5294 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5295 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5296
5297 @kindex cdir
5298 @kindex cwd
5299 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5300 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5301 @cindex compilation directory
5302 @cindex current directory
5303 @cindex working directory
5304 @cindex directory, current
5305 @cindex directory, compilation
5306 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5307 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5308 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5309 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5310 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5311 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5312
5313 @item directory
5314 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5315
5316 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5317 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5318
5319 @item show directories
5320 @kindex show directories
5321 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5322
5323 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5324 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5325 @kindex set substitute-path
5326 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5327 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5328 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5329
5330 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5331 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5332
5333 @smallexample
5334 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5335 @end smallexample
5336
5337 @noindent
5338 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5339 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5340 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5341
5342 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5343 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5344 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5345 the substitution.
5346
5347 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5348
5349 @smallexample
5350 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5351 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5352 @end smallexample
5353
5354 @noindent
5355 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5356 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5357 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5358 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5359
5360
5361 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5362 @kindex unset substitute-path
5363 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5364 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5365 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5366
5367 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5368
5369 @item show substitute-path [path]
5370 @kindex show substitute-path
5371 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5372 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5373
5374 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5375 rules.
5376
5377 @end table
5378
5379 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5380 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5381 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5382
5383 @enumerate
5384 @item
5385 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5386
5387 @item
5388 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5389 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5390 directories in one command.
5391 @end enumerate
5392
5393 @node Machine Code
5394 @section Source and Machine Code
5395 @cindex source line and its code address
5396
5397 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5398 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5399 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5400 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5401 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5402 well as hex.
5403
5404 @table @code
5405 @kindex info line
5406 @item info line @var{linespec}
5407 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5408 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5409 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5410 @end table
5411
5412 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5413 the object code for the first line of function
5414 @code{m4_changequote}:
5415
5416 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5417 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5418 @smallexample
5419 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5420 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5421 @end smallexample
5422
5423 @noindent
5424 @cindex code address and its source line
5425 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5426 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5427 @smallexample
5428 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5429 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5430 @end smallexample
5431
5432 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5433 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5434 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5435 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5436 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5437 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5438 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5439 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5440 Variables}).
5441
5442 @table @code
5443 @kindex disassemble
5444 @cindex assembly instructions
5445 @cindex instructions, assembly
5446 @cindex machine instructions
5447 @cindex listing machine instructions
5448 @item disassemble
5449 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5450 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5451 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5452 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5453 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5454 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5455 @end table
5456
5457 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5458 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5459
5460 @smallexample
5461 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5462 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5463 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5464 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5465 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5466 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5467 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5468 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5469 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5470 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5471 End of assembler dump.
5472 @end smallexample
5473
5474 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5475 mnemonics or other syntax.
5476
5477 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5478 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5479 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5480 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5481 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5482
5483 @table @code
5484 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5485 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5486 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5487 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5488 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5489 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5490
5491 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5492 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5493 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5494 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5495
5496 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5497 @item show disassembly-flavor
5498 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5499 @end table
5500
5501
5502 @node Data
5503 @chapter Examining Data
5504
5505 @cindex printing data
5506 @cindex examining data
5507 @kindex print
5508 @kindex inspect
5509 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5510 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5511 @c different window or something like that.
5512 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5513 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5514 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5515 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5516 Different Languages}).
5517
5518 @table @code
5519 @item print @var{expr}
5520 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5521 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5522 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5523 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5524 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5525 Formats}.
5526
5527 @item print
5528 @itemx print /@var{f}
5529 @cindex reprint the last value
5530 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5531 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5532 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5533 @end table
5534
5535 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5536 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5537 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5538
5539 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5540 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5541 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5542 Table}.
5543
5544 @menu
5545 * Expressions:: Expressions
5546 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
5547 * Variables:: Program variables
5548 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5549 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5550 * Memory:: Examining memory
5551 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5552 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5553 * Value History:: Value history
5554 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5555 * Registers:: Registers
5556 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5557 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5558 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5559 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5560 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5561 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5562 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5563 character set than GDB does
5564 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5565 @end menu
5566
5567 @node Expressions
5568 @section Expressions
5569
5570 @cindex expressions
5571 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5572 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5573 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5574 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5575 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5576 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5577 @ref{Compilation}.
5578
5579 @cindex arrays in expressions
5580 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5581 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5582 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
5583 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
5584 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
5585 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5586
5587 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5588 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5589 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5590 languages.
5591
5592 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5593 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5594
5595 @cindex casts, in expressions
5596 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5597 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5598 at that address in memory.
5599 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5600
5601 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5602 to programming languages:
5603
5604 @table @code
5605 @item @@
5606 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5607 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5608
5609 @item ::
5610 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5611 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5612
5613 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5614 @cindex type casting memory
5615 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5616 @cindex casts, to view memory
5617 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5618 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5619 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5620 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5621 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5622 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5623 @end table
5624
5625 @node Ambiguous Expressions
5626 @section Ambiguous Expressions
5627 @cindex ambiguous expressions
5628
5629 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
5630 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
5631 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
5632 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
5633 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
5634 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
5635 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
5636
5637 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
5638 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
5639 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
5640 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
5641 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
5642 as well.
5643
5644 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
5645 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
5646 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
5647 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
5648 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
5649 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
5650 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
5651 choices.
5652
5653 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
5654 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
5655 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
5656
5657 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
5658 @smallexample
5659 @group
5660 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
5661 [0] cancel
5662 [1] all
5663 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
5664 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
5665 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
5666 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
5667 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
5668 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
5669 > 2 4 6
5670 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
5671 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
5672 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
5673 Multiple breakpoints were set.
5674 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
5675 breakpoints.
5676 (@value{GDBP})
5677 @end group
5678 @end smallexample
5679
5680 @table @code
5681 @kindex set multiple-symbols
5682 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
5683 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
5684
5685 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
5686 is ambiguous.
5687
5688 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
5689 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
5690 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
5691 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
5692 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
5693 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
5694 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
5695 in the use of the menu.
5696
5697 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
5698 when an ambiguity is detected.
5699
5700 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
5701 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
5702
5703 @kindex show multiple-symbols
5704 @item show multiple-symbols
5705 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
5706 @end table
5707
5708 @node Variables
5709 @section Program Variables
5710
5711 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5712 in your program.
5713
5714 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5715 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5716
5717 @itemize @bullet
5718 @item
5719 global (or file-static)
5720 @end itemize
5721
5722 @noindent or
5723
5724 @itemize @bullet
5725 @item
5726 visible according to the scope rules of the
5727 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5728 @end itemize
5729
5730 @noindent This means that in the function
5731
5732 @smallexample
5733 foo (a)
5734 int a;
5735 @{
5736 bar (a);
5737 @{
5738 int b = test ();
5739 bar (b);
5740 @}
5741 @}
5742 @end smallexample
5743
5744 @noindent
5745 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5746 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5747 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5748 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5749
5750 @cindex variable name conflict
5751 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5752 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5753 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5754 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5755 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5756 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5757 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5758
5759 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5760 @ifnotinfo
5761 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5762 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5763 @end ifnotinfo
5764 @smallexample
5765 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5766 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5767 @end smallexample
5768
5769 @noindent
5770 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5771 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5772 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5773 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5774
5775 @smallexample
5776 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5777 @end smallexample
5778
5779 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5780 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5781 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5782 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5783 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5784 @c conflict?? --mew
5785
5786 @cindex wrong values
5787 @cindex variable values, wrong
5788 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5789 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5790 @quotation
5791 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5792 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5793 scope, and just before exit.
5794 @end quotation
5795 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5796 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5797 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5798 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5799 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5800 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5801 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5802 variable definitions may be gone.
5803
5804 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5805 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5806 when compiling.
5807
5808 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5809 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5810 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5811 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5812 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5813 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5814 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5815
5816 @smallexample
5817 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5818 @end smallexample
5819
5820 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5821 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5822 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5823 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5824 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5825 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5826 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5827 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5828 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5829 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5830 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5831
5832 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5833 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5834 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5835 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5836
5837 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5838 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5839 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5840 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5841 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5842 For program code
5843
5844 @smallexample
5845 char var0[] = "A";
5846 signed char var1[] = "A";
5847 @end smallexample
5848
5849 You get during debugging
5850 @smallexample
5851 (gdb) print var0
5852 $1 = "A"
5853 (gdb) print var1
5854 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5855 @end smallexample
5856
5857 @node Arrays
5858 @section Artificial Arrays
5859
5860 @cindex artificial array
5861 @cindex arrays
5862 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5863 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5864 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5865 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5866 program.
5867
5868 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5869 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5870 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5871 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5872 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5873 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5874 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5875 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5876 example. If a program says
5877
5878 @smallexample
5879 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5880 @end smallexample
5881
5882 @noindent
5883 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5884
5885 @smallexample
5886 p *array@@len
5887 @end smallexample
5888
5889 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5890 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5891 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5892 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5893 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5894
5895 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5896 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5897 The value need not be in memory:
5898 @smallexample
5899 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5900 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5901 @end smallexample
5902
5903 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5904 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5905 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5906 @smallexample
5907 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5908 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5909 @end smallexample
5910
5911 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5912 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5913 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5914 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5915 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5916 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5917 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5918 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5919 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5920 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5921
5922 @smallexample
5923 set $i = 0
5924 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5925 @key{RET}
5926 @key{RET}
5927 @dots{}
5928 @end smallexample
5929
5930 @node Output Formats
5931 @section Output Formats
5932
5933 @cindex formatted output
5934 @cindex output formats
5935 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5936 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5937 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5938 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5939 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5940
5941 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5942 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5943 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5944 letters supported are:
5945
5946 @table @code
5947 @item x
5948 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5949 hexadecimal.
5950
5951 @item d
5952 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5953
5954 @item u
5955 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5956
5957 @item o
5958 Print as integer in octal.
5959
5960 @item t
5961 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5962 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5963 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5964 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5965
5966 @item a
5967 @cindex unknown address, locating
5968 @cindex locate address
5969 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5970 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5971 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5972
5973 @smallexample
5974 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5975 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5976 @end smallexample
5977
5978 @noindent
5979 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5980 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5981
5982 @item c
5983 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5984 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5985 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5986 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5987
5988 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
5989 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
5990 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
5991 data.
5992
5993 @item f
5994 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5995 using typical floating point syntax.
5996
5997 @item s
5998 @cindex printing strings
5999 @cindex printing byte arrays
6000 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6001 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6002 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6003 natural types.
6004
6005 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6006 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6007 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6008 array.
6009 @end table
6010
6011 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6012
6013 @smallexample
6014 p/x $pc
6015 @end smallexample
6016
6017 @noindent
6018 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6019 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6020
6021 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6022 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6023 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6024
6025 @node Memory
6026 @section Examining Memory
6027
6028 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6029 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6030
6031 @cindex examining memory
6032 @table @code
6033 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6034 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6035 @itemx x @var{addr}
6036 @itemx x
6037 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6038 @end table
6039
6040 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6041 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6042 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6043 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6044 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6045
6046 @table @r
6047 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6048 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6049 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6050 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6051 @c 4.1.2.
6052
6053 @item @var{f}, the display format
6054 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6055 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6056 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6057 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6058 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6059
6060 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6061 The unit size is any of
6062
6063 @table @code
6064 @item b
6065 Bytes.
6066 @item h
6067 Halfwords (two bytes).
6068 @item w
6069 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6070 @item g
6071 Giant words (eight bytes).
6072 @end table
6073
6074 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6075 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6076 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6077
6078 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6079 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6080 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6081 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6082 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6083 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6084 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6085 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6086 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6087 a value from memory).
6088 @end table
6089
6090 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6091 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6092 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6093 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6094 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6095
6096 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6097 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6098 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6099 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6100 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6101
6102 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6103 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6104 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6105 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6106 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6107 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6108 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6109 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6110 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6111
6112 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6113 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6114 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6115 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6116 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6117 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6118 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6119
6120 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6121 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6122 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6123 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6124 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6125 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6126 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6127 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6128 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6129
6130 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6131 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6132 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6133
6134 @cindex remote memory comparison
6135 @cindex verify remote memory image
6136 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6137 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6138 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6139 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6140 situations.
6141
6142 @table @code
6143 @kindex compare-sections
6144 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6145 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6146 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6147 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6148 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6149 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6150 remote request.
6151 @end table
6152
6153 @node Auto Display
6154 @section Automatic Display
6155 @cindex automatic display
6156 @cindex display of expressions
6157
6158 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6159 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6160 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6161 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6162 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6163 The automatic display looks like this:
6164
6165 @smallexample
6166 2: foo = 38
6167 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6168 @end smallexample
6169
6170 @noindent
6171 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6172 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6173 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6174 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6175 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6176 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6177
6178 @table @code
6179 @kindex display
6180 @item display @var{expr}
6181 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6182 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6183
6184 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6185
6186 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6187 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6188 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6189 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6190 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6191
6192 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6193 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6194 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6195 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6196 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6197 @end table
6198
6199 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6200 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6201 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6202
6203 @table @code
6204 @kindex delete display
6205 @kindex undisplay
6206 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6207 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6208 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6209
6210 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6211 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6212
6213 @kindex disable display
6214 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6215 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6216 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6217 enabled again later.
6218
6219 @kindex enable display
6220 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6221 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6222 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6223
6224 @item display
6225 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6226 done when your program stops.
6227
6228 @kindex info display
6229 @item info display
6230 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6231 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6232 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6233 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6234 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6235 @end table
6236
6237 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6238 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6239 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6240 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6241 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6242 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6243 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6244 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6245 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6246 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6247 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6248
6249 @node Print Settings
6250 @section Print Settings
6251
6252 @cindex format options
6253 @cindex print settings
6254 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6255 and symbols are printed.
6256
6257 @noindent
6258 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6259
6260 @table @code
6261 @kindex set print
6262 @item set print address
6263 @itemx set print address on
6264 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6265 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6266 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6267 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6268 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6269 @code{set print address on}:
6270
6271 @smallexample
6272 @group
6273 (@value{GDBP}) f
6274 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6275 at input.c:530
6276 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6277 @end group
6278 @end smallexample
6279
6280 @item set print address off
6281 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6282 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6283
6284 @smallexample
6285 @group
6286 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6287 (@value{GDBP}) f
6288 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6289 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6290 @end group
6291 @end smallexample
6292
6293 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6294 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6295 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6296 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6297
6298 @kindex show print
6299 @item show print address
6300 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6301 @end table
6302
6303 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6304 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6305 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6306 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6307 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6308 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6309 it prints a symbolic address:
6310
6311 @table @code
6312 @item set print symbol-filename on
6313 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6314 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6315 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6316 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6317
6318 @item set print symbol-filename off
6319 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6320 default.
6321
6322 @item show print symbol-filename
6323 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6324 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6325 @end table
6326
6327 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6328 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6329 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6330
6331 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6332 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6333
6334 @table @code
6335 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6336 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6337 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6338 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6339 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6340 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6341
6342 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6343 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6344 symbolic address.
6345 @end table
6346
6347 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6348 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6349 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6350 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6351 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6352 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6353 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6354 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6355
6356 @smallexample
6357 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6358 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6359 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6360 @end smallexample
6361
6362 @quotation
6363 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6364 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6365 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6366 @end quotation
6367
6368 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6369
6370 @table @code
6371 @item set print array
6372 @itemx set print array on
6373 @cindex pretty print arrays
6374 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6375 but uses more space. The default is off.
6376
6377 @item set print array off
6378 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6379
6380 @item show print array
6381 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6382 arrays.
6383
6384 @cindex print array indexes
6385 @item set print array-indexes
6386 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6387 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6388 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6389 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6390
6391 @item set print array-indexes off
6392 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6393
6394 @item show print array-indexes
6395 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6396 arrays.
6397
6398 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6399 @cindex number of array elements to print
6400 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6401 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6402 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6403 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6404 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6405 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6406 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6407
6408 @item show print elements
6409 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6410 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6411
6412 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6413 @cindex printing frame argument values
6414 @cindex print all frame argument values
6415 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6416 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6417 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6418 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6419 values are:
6420
6421 @table @code
6422 @item all
6423 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6424
6425 @item scalars
6426 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6427 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6428 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6429
6430 @smallexample
6431 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6432 at frame-args.c:23
6433 @end smallexample
6434
6435 @item none
6436 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6437 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6438
6439 @smallexample
6440 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6441 at frame-args.c:23
6442 @end smallexample
6443 @end table
6444
6445 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6446 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6447 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6448 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6449 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6450 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6451 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6452 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6453
6454 @item show print frame-arguments
6455 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6456
6457 @item set print repeats
6458 @cindex repeated array elements
6459 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6460 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6461 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6462 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6463 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6464 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6465 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6466
6467 @item show print repeats
6468 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6469 elements.
6470
6471 @item set print null-stop
6472 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6473 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6474 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6475 contain only short strings.
6476 The default is off.
6477
6478 @item show print null-stop
6479 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6480 @sc{null} character.
6481
6482 @item set print pretty on
6483 @cindex print structures in indented form
6484 @cindex indentation in structure display
6485 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6486 per line, like this:
6487
6488 @smallexample
6489 @group
6490 $1 = @{
6491 next = 0x0,
6492 flags = @{
6493 sweet = 1,
6494 sour = 1
6495 @},
6496 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6497 @}
6498 @end group
6499 @end smallexample
6500
6501 @item set print pretty off
6502 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6503
6504 @smallexample
6505 @group
6506 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6507 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6508 @end group
6509 @end smallexample
6510
6511 @noindent
6512 This is the default format.
6513
6514 @item show print pretty
6515 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6516
6517 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6518 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6519 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6520 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6521 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6522 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6523 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6524 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6525
6526 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6527 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6528 international character sets, and is the default.
6529
6530 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6531 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6532
6533 @item set print union on
6534 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6535 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6536 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6537
6538 @item set print union off
6539 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6540 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6541 instead.
6542
6543 @item show print union
6544 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6545 structures and other unions.
6546
6547 For example, given the declarations
6548
6549 @smallexample
6550 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6551 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6552 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6553 Bug_forms;
6554
6555 struct thing @{
6556 Species it;
6557 union @{
6558 Tree_forms tree;
6559 Bug_forms bug;
6560 @} form;
6561 @};
6562
6563 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6564 @end smallexample
6565
6566 @noindent
6567 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6568
6569 @smallexample
6570 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6571 @end smallexample
6572
6573 @noindent
6574 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6575
6576 @smallexample
6577 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6578 @end smallexample
6579
6580 @noindent
6581 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6582 and in Pascal.
6583 @end table
6584
6585 @need 1000
6586 @noindent
6587 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6588
6589 @table @code
6590 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6591 @item set print demangle
6592 @itemx set print demangle on
6593 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6594 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6595 linkage. The default is on.
6596
6597 @item show print demangle
6598 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6599
6600 @item set print asm-demangle
6601 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6602 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6603 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6604 The default is off.
6605
6606 @item show print asm-demangle
6607 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6608 or demangled form.
6609
6610 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6611 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6612 @kindex set demangle-style
6613 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6614 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6615 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6616
6617 @table @code
6618 @item auto
6619 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6620
6621 @item gnu
6622 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6623 This is the default.
6624
6625 @item hp
6626 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6627
6628 @item lucid
6629 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6630
6631 @item arm
6632 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6633 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6634 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6635 require further enhancement to permit that.
6636
6637 @end table
6638 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6639
6640 @item show demangle-style
6641 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6642
6643 @item set print object
6644 @itemx set print object on
6645 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6646 @cindex display derived types
6647 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6648 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6649 the virtual function table.
6650
6651 @item set print object off
6652 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6653 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6654
6655 @item show print object
6656 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6657
6658 @item set print static-members
6659 @itemx set print static-members on
6660 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6661 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6662
6663 @item set print static-members off
6664 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6665
6666 @item show print static-members
6667 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6668
6669 @item set print pascal_static-members
6670 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6671 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6672 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6673 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6674
6675 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6676 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6677
6678 @item show print pascal_static-members
6679 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6680
6681 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6682 @item set print vtbl
6683 @itemx set print vtbl on
6684 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6685 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6686 @cindex VTBL display
6687 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6688 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6689 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6690
6691 @item set print vtbl off
6692 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6693
6694 @item show print vtbl
6695 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6696 @end table
6697
6698 @node Value History
6699 @section Value History
6700
6701 @cindex value history
6702 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6703 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6704 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6705 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6706 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6707 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6708 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6709 symbol table.
6710
6711 @cindex @code{$}
6712 @cindex @code{$$}
6713 @cindex history number
6714 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6715 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6716 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6717 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6718 history number.
6719
6720 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6721 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6722 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6723 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6724 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6725 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6726 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6727
6728 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6729 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6730
6731 @smallexample
6732 p *$
6733 @end smallexample
6734
6735 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6736 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6737
6738 @smallexample
6739 p *$.next
6740 @end smallexample
6741
6742 @noindent
6743 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6744 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6745
6746 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6747 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6748
6749 @smallexample
6750 print x
6751 set x=5
6752 @end smallexample
6753
6754 @noindent
6755 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6756 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6757
6758 @table @code
6759 @kindex show values
6760 @item show values
6761 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6762 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6763 values} does not change the history.
6764
6765 @item show values @var{n}
6766 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6767
6768 @item show values +
6769 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6770 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6771 @end table
6772
6773 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6774 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6775
6776 @node Convenience Vars
6777 @section Convenience Variables
6778
6779 @cindex convenience variables
6780 @cindex user-defined variables
6781 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6782 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6783 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6784 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6785 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6786
6787 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6788 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6789 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6790 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6791 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6792
6793 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6794 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6795 For example:
6796
6797 @smallexample
6798 set $foo = *object_ptr
6799 @end smallexample
6800
6801 @noindent
6802 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6803 @code{object_ptr}.
6804
6805 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6806 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6807 value with another assignment at any time.
6808
6809 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6810 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6811 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6812 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6813
6814 @table @code
6815 @kindex show convenience
6816 @cindex show all user variables
6817 @item show convenience
6818 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6819 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6820
6821 @kindex init-if-undefined
6822 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6823 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6824 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6825 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6826 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6827 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6828 override default values used in a command script.
6829
6830 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6831 any side-effects do not occur.
6832 @end table
6833
6834 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6835 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6836 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6837
6838 @smallexample
6839 set $i = 0
6840 print bar[$i++]->contents
6841 @end smallexample
6842
6843 @noindent
6844 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6845
6846 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6847 values likely to be useful.
6848
6849 @table @code
6850 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6851 @item $_
6852 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6853 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6854 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6855 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6856 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6857 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6858 to the type of @code{$__}.
6859
6860 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6861 @item $__
6862 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6863 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6864 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6865
6866 @item $_exitcode
6867 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6868 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6869 the program being debugged terminates.
6870 @end table
6871
6872 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6873 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6874 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6875
6876 @node Registers
6877 @section Registers
6878
6879 @cindex registers
6880 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6881 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6882 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6883 your machine.
6884
6885 @table @code
6886 @kindex info registers
6887 @item info registers
6888 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6889 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6890
6891 @kindex info all-registers
6892 @cindex floating point registers
6893 @item info all-registers
6894 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6895 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6896
6897 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6898 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6899 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6900 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6901 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6902 @end table
6903
6904 @cindex stack pointer register
6905 @cindex program counter register
6906 @cindex process status register
6907 @cindex frame pointer register
6908 @cindex standard registers
6909 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6910 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6911 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6912 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6913 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6914 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6915 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6916 you could print the program counter in hex with
6917
6918 @smallexample
6919 p/x $pc
6920 @end smallexample
6921
6922 @noindent
6923 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6924
6925 @smallexample
6926 x/i $pc
6927 @end smallexample
6928
6929 @noindent
6930 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6931 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6932 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6933 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6934 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6935 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6936 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6937
6938 @smallexample
6939 set $sp += 4
6940 @end smallexample
6941
6942 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6943 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6944 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6945 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6946 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6947 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6948 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6949
6950 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6951 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6952 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6953 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6954 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6955 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6956 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6957
6958 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6959 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6960 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6961 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6962 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6963 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6964 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6965 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6966 prints the data in both formats.
6967
6968 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6969 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6970 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6971 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6972 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6973 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6974 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6975
6976 @smallexample
6977 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6978 $1 = @{
6979 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6980 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6981 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6982 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6983 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6984 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6985 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6986 @}
6987 @end smallexample
6988
6989 @noindent
6990 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6991 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6992 value to a @code{struct} member:
6993
6994 @smallexample
6995 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6996 @end smallexample
6997
6998 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6999 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7000 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7001 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7002 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7003 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7004
7005 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7006 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7007 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7008 frame makes no difference.
7009
7010 @node Floating Point Hardware
7011 @section Floating Point Hardware
7012 @cindex floating point
7013
7014 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7015 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7016
7017 @table @code
7018 @kindex info float
7019 @item info float
7020 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7021 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7022 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7023 the ARM and x86 machines.
7024 @end table
7025
7026 @node Vector Unit
7027 @section Vector Unit
7028 @cindex vector unit
7029
7030 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7031 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7032
7033 @table @code
7034 @kindex info vector
7035 @item info vector
7036 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7037 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7038 @end table
7039
7040 @node OS Information
7041 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7042 @cindex OS information
7043
7044 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7045 you debug your program.
7046
7047 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7048 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7049 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7050 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7051 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7052 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7053 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7054 structure.
7055
7056 @table @code
7057 @item info udot
7058 @kindex info udot
7059 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7060 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7061 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7062 the @code{examine} command.
7063 @end table
7064
7065 @cindex auxiliary vector
7066 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7067 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7068 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7069 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7070 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7071 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7072 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7073 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7074 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7075 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7076 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7077 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7078
7079 @table @code
7080 @kindex info auxv
7081 @item info auxv
7082 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7083 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7084 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7085 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7086 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7087 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7088 an unrecognized tag.
7089 @end table
7090
7091
7092 @node Memory Region Attributes
7093 @section Memory Region Attributes
7094 @cindex memory region attributes
7095
7096 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7097 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7098 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7099 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7100 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7101 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7102 user can override the fetched regions.
7103
7104 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7105 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7106 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7107 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7108 all memory.
7109
7110 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7111 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7112
7113 @table @code
7114 @kindex mem
7115 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7116 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7117 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7118 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7119 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7120 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7121
7122 @item mem auto
7123 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7124 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7125
7126 @kindex delete mem
7127 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7128 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7129 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7130
7131 @kindex disable mem
7132 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7133 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7134 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7135 It may be enabled again later.
7136
7137 @kindex enable mem
7138 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7139 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7140
7141 @kindex info mem
7142 @item info mem
7143 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7144 for each region:
7145
7146 @table @emph
7147 @item Memory Region Number
7148 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7149 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7150 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7151
7152 @item Lo Address
7153 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7154
7155 @item Hi Address
7156 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7157
7158 @item Attributes
7159 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7160 @end table
7161 @end table
7162
7163
7164 @subsection Attributes
7165
7166 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7167 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7168 write accesses to a memory region.
7169
7170 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7171 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7172 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7173
7174 @table @code
7175 @item ro
7176 Memory is read only.
7177 @item wo
7178 Memory is write only.
7179 @item rw
7180 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7181 @end table
7182
7183 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7184 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7185 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7186 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7187 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7188
7189 @table @code
7190 @item 8
7191 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7192 @item 16
7193 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7194 @item 32
7195 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7196 @item 64
7197 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7198 @end table
7199
7200 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7201 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7202 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7203 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7204 @c
7205 @c @table @code
7206 @c @item hwbreak
7207 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7208 @c @item swbreak (default)
7209 @c @end table
7210
7211 @subsubsection Data Cache
7212 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7213 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7214 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7215 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7216 registers.
7217
7218 @table @code
7219 @item cache
7220 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7221 @item nocache
7222 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7223 @end table
7224
7225 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7226 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7227 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7228 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7229 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7230
7231 @table @code
7232 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7233 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7234 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7235 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7236 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7237 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7238 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7239 The default value is @code{on}.
7240 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7241 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7242 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7243 @end table
7244
7245
7246 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7247 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7248 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7249 @c
7250 @c @table @code
7251 @c @item verify
7252 @c @item noverify (default)
7253 @c @end table
7254
7255 @node Dump/Restore Files
7256 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7257 @cindex dump/restore files
7258 @cindex append data to a file
7259 @cindex dump data to a file
7260 @cindex restore data from a file
7261
7262 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7263 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7264 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7265 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7266 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7267 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7268 files.
7269
7270 @table @code
7271
7272 @kindex dump
7273 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7274 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7275 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7276 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7277
7278 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7279 @table @code
7280 @item binary
7281 Raw binary form.
7282 @item ihex
7283 Intel hex format.
7284 @item srec
7285 Motorola S-record format.
7286 @item tekhex
7287 Tektronix Hex format.
7288 @end table
7289
7290 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7291 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7292 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7293 form.
7294
7295 @kindex append
7296 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7297 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7298 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7299 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7300 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7301
7302 @kindex restore
7303 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7304 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7305 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7306 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7307 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7308
7309 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7310 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7311 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7312 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7313 from that location.
7314
7315 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7316 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7317 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7318 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7319
7320 @end table
7321
7322 @node Core File Generation
7323 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7324 @cindex dump core from inferior
7325
7326 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7327 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7328 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7329 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7330 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7331 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7332 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7333
7334 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7335 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7336 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7337
7338 @table @code
7339 @kindex gcore
7340 @kindex generate-core-file
7341 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7342 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7343 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7344 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7345 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7346 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7347
7348 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7349 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7350 @end table
7351
7352 @node Character Sets
7353 @section Character Sets
7354 @cindex character sets
7355 @cindex charset
7356 @cindex translating between character sets
7357 @cindex host character set
7358 @cindex target character set
7359
7360 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7361 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7362 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7363 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7364 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7365 @dfn{target character set}.
7366
7367 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7368 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7369 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7370 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7371 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7372 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7373 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7374 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7375 character and string literals in expressions.
7376
7377 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7378 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7379 target-charset} command, described below.
7380
7381 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7382 support:
7383
7384 @table @code
7385 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7386 @kindex set target-charset
7387 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7388 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7389 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7390 list the target character sets it supports.
7391 @end table
7392
7393 @table @code
7394 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7395 @kindex set host-charset
7396 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7397
7398 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7399 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7400 @code{set host-charset} command.
7401
7402 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7403 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7404 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7405 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7406 list the host character sets it supports.
7407
7408 @item set charset @var{charset}
7409 @kindex set charset
7410 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7411 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7412 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7413 for both host and target.
7414
7415
7416 @item show charset
7417 @kindex show charset
7418 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7419
7420 @itemx show host-charset
7421 @kindex show host-charset
7422 Show the name of the current host charset.
7423
7424 @itemx show target-charset
7425 @kindex show target-charset
7426 Show the name of the current target charset.
7427
7428 @end table
7429
7430 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7431 sets:
7432
7433 @table @code
7434
7435 @item ASCII
7436 @cindex ASCII character set
7437 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7438 character set.
7439
7440 @item ISO-8859-1
7441 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7442 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7443 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7444 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7445 this as its host character set.
7446
7447 @item EBCDIC-US
7448 @itemx IBM1047
7449 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7450 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7451 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7452 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7453 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7454
7455 @end table
7456
7457 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7458 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7459 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7460
7461 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7462 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7463 @file{charset-test.c}:
7464
7465 @smallexample
7466 #include <stdio.h>
7467
7468 char ascii_hello[]
7469 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7470 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7471 char ibm1047_hello[]
7472 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7473 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7474
7475 main ()
7476 @{
7477 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7478 @}
7479 @end smallexample
7480
7481 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7482 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7483 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7484
7485 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7486
7487 @smallexample
7488 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7489 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7490 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7491 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7492 @dots{}
7493 (@value{GDBP})
7494 @end smallexample
7495
7496 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7497 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7498 strings:
7499
7500 @smallexample
7501 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7502 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7503 (@value{GDBP})
7504 @end smallexample
7505
7506 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7507 initial character set:
7508 @smallexample
7509 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7510 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7511 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7512 (@value{GDBP})
7513 @end smallexample
7514
7515 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7516 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7517 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7518 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7519 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7520
7521 @smallexample
7522 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7523 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7524 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7525 $2 = 72 'H'
7526 (@value{GDBP})
7527 @end smallexample
7528
7529 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7530 literals you use in expressions:
7531
7532 @smallexample
7533 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7534 $3 = 43 '+'
7535 (@value{GDBP})
7536 @end smallexample
7537
7538 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7539 character.
7540
7541 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7542 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7543 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7544
7545 @smallexample
7546 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7547 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7548 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7549 $5 = 200 '\310'
7550 (@value{GDBP})
7551 @end smallexample
7552
7553 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7554 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7555
7556 @smallexample
7557 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7558 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7559 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7560 @end smallexample
7561
7562 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7563 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7564 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7565 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7566 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7567
7568 @smallexample
7569 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7570 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7571 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7572 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7573 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7574 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7575 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7576 $7 = 72 '\110'
7577 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7578 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7579 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7580 $9 = 200 'H'
7581 (@value{GDBP})
7582 @end smallexample
7583
7584 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7585 string literals you use in expressions:
7586
7587 @smallexample
7588 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7589 $10 = 78 '+'
7590 (@value{GDBP})
7591 @end smallexample
7592
7593 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7594 character.
7595
7596 @node Caching Remote Data
7597 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7598 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7599
7600 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7601 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7602 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7603 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7604 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7605 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7606 volatile registers are in use.
7607
7608 @table @code
7609 @kindex set remotecache
7610 @item set remotecache on
7611 @itemx set remotecache off
7612 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7613 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7614
7615 @kindex show remotecache
7616 @item show remotecache
7617 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7618
7619 @kindex info dcache
7620 @item info dcache
7621 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7622 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7623 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7624 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7625 the data cache operation.
7626 @end table
7627
7628
7629 @node Macros
7630 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7631
7632 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7633 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7634 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7635 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7636 where it was defined.
7637
7638 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7639 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7640 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7641 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7642
7643 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7644 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7645 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7646 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7647 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7648 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7649 see @ref{List}.
7650
7651 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7652 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7653 variable-arity macros.
7654
7655 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7656 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7657 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7658
7659 @table @code
7660
7661 @kindex macro expand
7662 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7663 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7664 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7665 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7666 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7667 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7668 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7669 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7670 it can be any string of tokens.
7671
7672 @kindex macro exp1
7673 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7674 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7675 @cindex expand macro once
7676 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7677 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7678 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7679 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7680 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7681 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7682 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7683 can be any string of tokens.
7684
7685 @kindex info macro
7686 @cindex macro definition, showing
7687 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7688 @item info macro @var{macro}
7689 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7690 source location where that definition was established.
7691
7692 @kindex macro define
7693 @cindex user-defined macros
7694 @cindex defining macros interactively
7695 @cindex macros, user-defined
7696 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7697 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7698 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7699 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7700 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7701 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7702 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7703 given in @var{arglist}.
7704
7705 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7706 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7707 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7708 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7709 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7710
7711 @kindex macro undef
7712 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7713 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7714 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7715 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7716 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7717 debugged.
7718
7719 @kindex macro list
7720 @item macro list
7721 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7722 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7723 @end table
7724
7725 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7726 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7727 show our source files:
7728
7729 @smallexample
7730 $ cat sample.c
7731 #include <stdio.h>
7732 #include "sample.h"
7733
7734 #define M 42
7735 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7736
7737 main ()
7738 @{
7739 #define N 28
7740 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7741 #undef N
7742 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7743 #define N 1729
7744 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7745 @}
7746 $ cat sample.h
7747 #define Q <
7748 $
7749 @end smallexample
7750
7751 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7752 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7753 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7754 information.
7755
7756 @smallexample
7757 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7758 $
7759 @end smallexample
7760
7761 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7762
7763 @smallexample
7764 $ gdb -nw sample
7765 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7766 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7767 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7768 (@value{GDBP})
7769 @end smallexample
7770
7771 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7772 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7773 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7774
7775 @smallexample
7776 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7777 3
7778 4 #define M 42
7779 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7780 6
7781 7 main ()
7782 8 @{
7783 9 #define N 28
7784 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7785 11 #undef N
7786 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7787 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7788 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7789 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7790 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7791 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7792 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7793 #define Q <
7794 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7795 expands to: (42 + 1)
7796 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7797 expands to: once (M + 1)
7798 (@value{GDBP})
7799 @end smallexample
7800
7801 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7802 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7803 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7804 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7805
7806 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7807 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7808
7809 @smallexample
7810 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7811 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7812 (@value{GDBP}) run
7813 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7814
7815 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7816 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7817 (@value{GDBP})
7818 @end smallexample
7819
7820 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7821
7822 @smallexample
7823 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7824 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7825 #define N 28
7826 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7827 expands to: 28 < 42
7828 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7829 $1 = 1
7830 (@value{GDBP})
7831 @end smallexample
7832
7833 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7834 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7835 thereof) in force at each point:
7836
7837 @smallexample
7838 (@value{GDBP}) next
7839 Hello, world!
7840 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7841 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7842 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7843 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7844 (@value{GDBP}) next
7845 We're so creative.
7846 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7847 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7848 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7849 #define N 1729
7850 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7851 expands to: 1729 < 42
7852 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7853 $2 = 0
7854 (@value{GDBP})
7855 @end smallexample
7856
7857
7858 @node Tracepoints
7859 @chapter Tracepoints
7860 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7861 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7862
7863 @cindex tracepoints
7864 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7865 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7866 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7867 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7868 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7869 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7870 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7871
7872 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7873 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7874 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7875 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7876 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7877 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7878 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7879 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7880 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7881 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7882 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7883
7884 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7885 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7886 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7887 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7888 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7889 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7890 Packets}.
7891
7892 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7893
7894 @menu
7895 * Set Tracepoints::
7896 * Analyze Collected Data::
7897 * Tracepoint Variables::
7898 @end menu
7899
7900 @node Set Tracepoints
7901 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7902
7903 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7904 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7905 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7906 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7907 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7908 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7909 work on.
7910
7911 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7912 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7913 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7914 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7915 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7916 tracepoint was hit.
7917
7918 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7919 conditions and actions.
7920
7921 @menu
7922 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7923 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7924 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7925 * Tracepoint Actions::
7926 * Listing Tracepoints::
7927 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7928 @end menu
7929
7930 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7931 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7932
7933 @table @code
7934 @cindex set tracepoint
7935 @kindex trace
7936 @item trace
7937 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7938 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7939 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7940 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7941 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7942 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7943 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7944 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7945 running.
7946
7947 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7948
7949 @smallexample
7950 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7951
7952 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7953
7954 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7955
7956 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7957
7958 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7959 @end smallexample
7960
7961 @noindent
7962 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7963
7964 @vindex $tpnum
7965 @cindex last tracepoint number
7966 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7967 @cindex tracepoint number
7968 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7969 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7970
7971 @kindex delete tracepoint
7972 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7973 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7974 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7975 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7976
7977 Examples:
7978
7979 @smallexample
7980 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7981
7982 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7983 @end smallexample
7984
7985 @noindent
7986 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7987 @end table
7988
7989 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7990 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7991
7992 @table @code
7993 @kindex disable tracepoint
7994 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7995 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7996 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7997 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7998 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7999
8000 @kindex enable tracepoint
8001 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8002 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8003 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8004 run.
8005 @end table
8006
8007 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8008 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8009
8010 @table @code
8011 @kindex passcount
8012 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8013 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8014 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8015 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8016 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8017 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8018 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8019 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8020 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8021 user.
8022
8023 Examples:
8024
8025 @smallexample
8026 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8027 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8028
8029 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8030 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8031 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8032 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8033 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8034 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8035 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8036 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8037 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8038 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8039 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8040 @end smallexample
8041 @end table
8042
8043 @node Tracepoint Actions
8044 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8045
8046 @table @code
8047 @kindex actions
8048 @cindex tracepoint actions
8049 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8050 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8051 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8052 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8053 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8054 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8055 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8056 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8057 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8058 @code{while-stepping}.
8059
8060 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8061 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8062 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8063
8064 @smallexample
8065 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8066
8067 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8068
8069 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8070 @end smallexample
8071
8072 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8073 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8074 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8075 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8076 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8077 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8078 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8079 @code{end} command.
8080
8081 @smallexample
8082 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8083 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8084 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8085 > collect bar,baz
8086 > collect $regs
8087 > while-stepping 12
8088 > collect $fp, $sp
8089 > end
8090 end
8091 @end smallexample
8092
8093 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8094 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8095 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8096 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8097 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8098 special arguments are supported:
8099
8100 @table @code
8101 @item $regs
8102 collect all registers
8103
8104 @item $args
8105 collect all function arguments
8106
8107 @item $locals
8108 collect all local variables.
8109 @end table
8110
8111 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8112 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8113 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8114
8115 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8116 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8117
8118 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8119 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8120 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8121 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8122 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8123 its own @code{end} command):
8124
8125 @smallexample
8126 > while-stepping 12
8127 > collect $regs, myglobal
8128 > end
8129 >
8130 @end smallexample
8131
8132 @noindent
8133 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8134 @code{stepping}.
8135 @end table
8136
8137 @node Listing Tracepoints
8138 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8139
8140 @table @code
8141 @kindex info tracepoints
8142 @kindex info tp
8143 @cindex information about tracepoints
8144 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8145 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8146 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8147 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8148 shown:
8149
8150 @itemize @bullet
8151 @item
8152 its number
8153 @item
8154 whether it is enabled or disabled
8155 @item
8156 its address
8157 @item
8158 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8159 @item
8160 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8161 @item
8162 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8163 @item
8164 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8165 @end itemize
8166
8167 @smallexample
8168 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8169 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8170 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8171 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8172 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8173 (@value{GDBP})
8174 @end smallexample
8175
8176 @noindent
8177 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8178 @end table
8179
8180 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8181 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8182
8183 @table @code
8184 @kindex tstart
8185 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8186 @cindex collected data discarded
8187 @item tstart
8188 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8189 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8190 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8191 experiment.
8192
8193 @kindex tstop
8194 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8195 @item tstop
8196 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8197 stops collecting data.
8198
8199 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8200 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8201 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8202
8203 @kindex tstatus
8204 @cindex status of trace data collection
8205 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8206 @item tstatus
8207 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8208 collection.
8209 @end table
8210
8211 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8212
8213 @smallexample
8214 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8215 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8216 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8217 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8218 > while-stepping 11
8219 > collect $regs
8220 > end
8221 > end
8222 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8223 [time passes @dots{}]
8224 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8225 @end smallexample
8226
8227
8228 @node Analyze Collected Data
8229 @section Using the Collected Data
8230
8231 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8232 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8233 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8234 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8235 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8236 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8237 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8238 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8239 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8240 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8241 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8242 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8243 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8244 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8245 the buffer will fail.
8246
8247 @menu
8248 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8249 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8250 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8251 @end menu
8252
8253 @node tfind
8254 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8255
8256 @kindex tfind
8257 @cindex select trace snapshot
8258 @cindex find trace snapshot
8259 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8260 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8261 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8262 snapshot is selected.
8263
8264 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8265
8266 @table @code
8267 @item tfind start
8268 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8269 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8270
8271 @item tfind none
8272 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8273
8274 @item tfind end
8275 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8276
8277 @item tfind
8278 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8279
8280 @item tfind -
8281 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8282 retracing earlier steps.
8283
8284 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8285 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8286 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8287 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8288 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8289
8290 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8291 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8292 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8293 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8294 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8295
8296 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8297 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8298 addresses.
8299
8300 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8301 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8302 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8303
8304 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8305 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8306 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8307 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8308 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8309 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8310 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8311 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8312 @end table
8313
8314 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8315 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8316 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8317 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8318 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8319 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8320 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8321 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8322 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8323 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8324 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8325 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8326 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8327 tracepoint as the current one.
8328
8329 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8330 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8331 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8332 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8333 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8334
8335 @smallexample
8336 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8337 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8338 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8339 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8340 > tfind
8341 > end
8342
8343 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8344 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8345 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8346 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8347 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8348 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8349 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8350 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8351 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8352 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8353 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8354 @end smallexample
8355
8356 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8357 the buffer:
8358
8359 @smallexample
8360 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8361 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8362 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8363 > tfind line
8364 > end
8365
8366 Frame 0, X = 1
8367 Frame 7, X = 2
8368 Frame 13, X = 255
8369 @end smallexample
8370
8371 @node tdump
8372 @subsection @code{tdump}
8373 @kindex tdump
8374 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8375 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8376
8377 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8378 the current trace snapshot.
8379
8380 @smallexample
8381 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8382 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8383 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8384 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8385 > end
8386
8387 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8388
8389 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8390 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8391 at gdb_test.c:444
8392 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8393
8394 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8395 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8396 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8397 d1 0x18 24
8398 d2 0x80 128
8399 d3 0x33 51
8400 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8401 d5 0x22 34
8402 d6 0xe0 224
8403 d7 0x380035 3670069
8404 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8405 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8406 a2 0x100 256
8407 a3 0x322000 3284992
8408 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8409 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8410 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8411 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8412 ps 0x0 0
8413 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8414 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8415 fpstatus 0x0 0
8416 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8417 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8418 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8419 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8420 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8421 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8422 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8423 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8424 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8425
8426 (@value{GDBP})
8427 @end smallexample
8428
8429 @node save-tracepoints
8430 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8431 @kindex save-tracepoints
8432 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8433
8434 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8435 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8436 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8437 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8438 Files}).
8439
8440 @node Tracepoint Variables
8441 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8442 @cindex tracepoint variables
8443 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8444
8445 @table @code
8446 @vindex $trace_frame
8447 @item (int) $trace_frame
8448 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8449 snapshot is selected.
8450
8451 @vindex $tracepoint
8452 @item (int) $tracepoint
8453 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8454
8455 @vindex $trace_line
8456 @item (int) $trace_line
8457 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8458
8459 @vindex $trace_file
8460 @item (char []) $trace_file
8461 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8462
8463 @vindex $trace_func
8464 @item (char []) $trace_func
8465 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8466 @end table
8467
8468 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8469 use @code{output} instead.
8470
8471 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8472 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8473 data.
8474
8475 @smallexample
8476 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8477
8478 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8479 > output $trace_file
8480 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8481 > tfind
8482 > end
8483 @end smallexample
8484
8485 @node Overlays
8486 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8487 @cindex overlays
8488
8489 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8490 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8491 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8492 use overlays.
8493
8494 @menu
8495 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8496 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8497 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8498 mapped by asking the inferior.
8499 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8500 @end menu
8501
8502 @node How Overlays Work
8503 @section How Overlays Work
8504 @cindex mapped overlays
8505 @cindex unmapped overlays
8506 @cindex load address, overlay's
8507 @cindex mapped address
8508 @cindex overlay area
8509
8510 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8511 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8512 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8513 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8514 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8515
8516 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8517 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8518 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8519 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8520 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8521 largest overlay as well.
8522
8523 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8524 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8525 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8526 there.
8527
8528 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8529 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8530 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8531
8532 @smallexample
8533 @group
8534 Data Instruction Larger
8535 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8536 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8537 | | | | | |
8538 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8539 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8540 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8541 | and heap | | | | | |
8542 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8543 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8544 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8545 | | | | | |
8546 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8547 address | | | | | |
8548 | overlay | <-' | | |
8549 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8550 | | <---. | | load address
8551 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8552 | | | |
8553 +-----------+ | |
8554 +-----------+
8555 | |
8556 +-----------+
8557
8558 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8559 @end group
8560 @end smallexample
8561
8562 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8563 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8564 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8565 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8566 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8567 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8568 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8569 program and the overlay area.
8570
8571 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8572 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8573 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8574 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8575 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8576 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8577 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8578
8579 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8580 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8581 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8582
8583 @itemize @bullet
8584
8585 @item
8586 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8587 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8588 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8589 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8590
8591 @item
8592 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8593 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8594 your program's performance.
8595
8596 @item
8597 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8598 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8599 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8600 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8601 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8602 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8603 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8604
8605 @item
8606 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8607 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8608 instruction and data spaces.
8609
8610 @end itemize
8611
8612 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8613 improved in many ways:
8614
8615 @itemize @bullet
8616
8617 @item
8618 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8619 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8620 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8621 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8622 area in the usual way.
8623
8624 @item
8625 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8626 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8627
8628 @item
8629 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8630 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8631 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8632 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8633 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8634 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8635 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8636
8637 @end itemize
8638
8639
8640 @node Overlay Commands
8641 @section Overlay Commands
8642
8643 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8644 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8645 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8646 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8647 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8648 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8649
8650 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8651 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8652
8653 @table @code
8654 @item overlay off
8655 @kindex overlay
8656 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8657 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8658 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8659 overlay support is disabled.
8660
8661 @item overlay manual
8662 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8663 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8664 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8665 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8666 commands described below.
8667
8668 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8669 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8670 @cindex map an overlay
8671 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8672 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8673 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8674 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8675 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8676 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8677
8678 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8679 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8680 @cindex unmap an overlay
8681 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8682 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8683 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8684 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8685
8686 @item overlay auto
8687 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8688 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8689 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8690 Overlay Debugging}.
8691
8692 @item overlay load-target
8693 @itemx overlay load
8694 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8695 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8696 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8697 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8698 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8699 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8700
8701 @item overlay list-overlays
8702 @itemx overlay list
8703 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8704 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8705 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8706
8707 @end table
8708
8709 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8710 of the function the address falls in:
8711
8712 @smallexample
8713 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8714 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8715 @end smallexample
8716 @noindent
8717 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8718 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8719 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8720 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8721
8722 @smallexample
8723 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8724 No sections are mapped.
8725 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8726 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8727 @end smallexample
8728 @noindent
8729 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8730 name normally:
8731
8732 @smallexample
8733 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8734 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8735 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8736 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8737 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8738 @end smallexample
8739
8740 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8741 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8742 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8743 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8744 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8745
8746 @itemize @bullet
8747 @item
8748 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8749 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8750 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8751 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8752 @item
8753 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8754 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8755 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8756 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8757 breakpoints properly.
8758 @end itemize
8759
8760
8761 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8762 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8763 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8764
8765 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8766 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8767 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8768 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8769 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8770 current state of the overlays.
8771
8772 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8773 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8774
8775 @table @asis
8776
8777 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8778 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8779
8780 @smallexample
8781 struct
8782 @{
8783 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8784 unsigned long vma;
8785
8786 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8787 unsigned long size;
8788
8789 /* The overlay's load address. */
8790 unsigned long lma;
8791
8792 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8793 zero otherwise. */
8794 unsigned long mapped;
8795 @}
8796 @end smallexample
8797
8798 @item @code{_novlys}:
8799 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8800 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8801
8802 @end table
8803
8804 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8805 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8806 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8807 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8808 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8809 currently mapped.
8810
8811 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8812 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8813 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8814 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8815 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8816 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8817 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8818 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8819 are not being executed.
8820
8821 @node Overlay Sample Program
8822 @section Overlay Sample Program
8823 @cindex overlay example program
8824
8825 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8826 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8827 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8828 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8829 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8830 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8831 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8832
8833 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8834 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8835 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8836 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8837
8838 @table @file
8839 @item overlays.c
8840 The main program file.
8841 @item ovlymgr.c
8842 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8843 @item foo.c
8844 @itemx bar.c
8845 @itemx baz.c
8846 @itemx grbx.c
8847 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8848 @item d10v.ld
8849 @itemx m32r.ld
8850 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8851 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8852 @end table
8853
8854 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8855 cross-compiler like this:
8856
8857 @smallexample
8858 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8859 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8860 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8861 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8862 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8863 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8864 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8865 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8866 @end smallexample
8867
8868 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8869 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8870 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8871
8872
8873 @node Languages
8874 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8875 @cindex languages
8876
8877 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8878 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8879 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8880 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8881 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8882 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8883
8884 @cindex working language
8885 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8886 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8887 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8888 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8889 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8890 language}.
8891
8892 @menu
8893 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8894 * Show:: Displaying the language
8895 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8896 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8897 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8898 @end menu
8899
8900 @node Setting
8901 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8902
8903 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8904 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8905 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8906 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8907 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8908 are printed, etc.
8909
8910 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8911 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8912 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8913 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8914 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8915 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8916 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8917 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8918 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8919 Displaying the Language}.
8920
8921 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8922 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8923 another language. In that case, make the
8924 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8925 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8926 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8927
8928 @menu
8929 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8930 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8931 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8932 @end menu
8933
8934 @node Filenames
8935 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8936
8937 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8938 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8939
8940 @table @file
8941 @item .ada
8942 @itemx .ads
8943 @itemx .adb
8944 @itemx .a
8945 Ada source file.
8946
8947 @item .c
8948 C source file
8949
8950 @item .C
8951 @itemx .cc
8952 @itemx .cp
8953 @itemx .cpp
8954 @itemx .cxx
8955 @itemx .c++
8956 C@t{++} source file
8957
8958 @item .m
8959 Objective-C source file
8960
8961 @item .f
8962 @itemx .F
8963 Fortran source file
8964
8965 @item .mod
8966 Modula-2 source file
8967
8968 @item .s
8969 @itemx .S
8970 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8971 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8972 @end table
8973
8974 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8975 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8976
8977 @node Manually
8978 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8979
8980 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8981 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8982 your program.
8983
8984 @kindex set language
8985 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8986 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8987 a language, such as
8988 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8989 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8990
8991 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8992 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8993 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8994 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8995 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8996 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8997 command such as:
8998
8999 @smallexample
9000 print a = b + c
9001 @end smallexample
9002
9003 @noindent
9004 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9005 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9006 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9007 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9008
9009 @node Automatically
9010 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9011
9012 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9013 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9014 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9015 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9016 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9017 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9018 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9019 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9020 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9021
9022 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9023 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9024 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9025 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9026 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9027
9028 @node Show
9029 @section Displaying the Language
9030
9031 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9032 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9033
9034 @table @code
9035 @item show language
9036 @kindex show language
9037 Display the current working language. This is the
9038 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9039 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9040
9041 @item info frame
9042 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9043 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9044 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9045 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9046 information listed here.
9047
9048 @item info source
9049 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9050 Display the source language of this source file.
9051 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9052 information listed here.
9053 @end table
9054
9055 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9056 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9057 with a language explicitly:
9058
9059 @table @code
9060 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9061 @kindex set extension-language
9062 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9063 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9064
9065 @item info extensions
9066 @kindex info extensions
9067 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9068 @end table
9069
9070 @node Checks
9071 @section Type and Range Checking
9072
9073 @quotation
9074 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9075 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9076 section documents the intended facilities.
9077 @end quotation
9078 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9079
9080 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9081 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9082 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9083 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9084 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9085 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9086 errors when your program is running.
9087
9088 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9089 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9090 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9091 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9092 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9093 automatically based on your program's source language.
9094 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9095 settings of supported languages.
9096
9097 @menu
9098 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9099 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9100 @end menu
9101
9102 @cindex type checking
9103 @cindex checks, type
9104 @node Type Checking
9105 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9106
9107 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9108 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9109 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9110 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9111
9112 @smallexample
9113 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9114 @exdent but
9115 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9116 @end smallexample
9117
9118 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9119 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9120
9121 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9122 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9123 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9124 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9125 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9126 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9127 also issues a warning.
9128
9129 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9130 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9131 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9132 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9133 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9134 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9135
9136 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9137 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9138 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9139 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9140 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9141 details on specific languages.
9142
9143 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9144
9145 @kindex set check type
9146 @kindex show check type
9147 @table @code
9148 @item set check type auto
9149 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9150 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9151 each language.
9152
9153 @item set check type on
9154 @itemx set check type off
9155 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9156 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9157 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9158 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9159 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9160
9161 @item set check type warn
9162 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9163 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9164 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9165 numbers and structures.
9166
9167 @item show type
9168 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9169 is setting it automatically.
9170 @end table
9171
9172 @cindex range checking
9173 @cindex checks, range
9174 @node Range Checking
9175 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9176
9177 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9178 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9179 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9180 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9181 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9182
9183 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9184 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9185 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9186 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9187
9188 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9189 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9190 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9191 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9192 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9193 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9194
9195 @smallexample
9196 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9197 @end smallexample
9198
9199 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9200 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9201 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9202
9203 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9204
9205 @kindex set check range
9206 @kindex show check range
9207 @table @code
9208 @item set check range auto
9209 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9210 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9211 each language.
9212
9213 @item set check range on
9214 @itemx set check range off
9215 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9216 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9217 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9218 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9219
9220 @item set check range warn
9221 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9222 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9223 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9224 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9225 systems).
9226
9227 @item show range
9228 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9229 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9230 @end table
9231
9232 @node Supported Languages
9233 @section Supported Languages
9234
9235 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9236 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9237 @c This is false ...
9238 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9239 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9240 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9241 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9242 language.
9243
9244 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9245 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9246 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9247 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9248 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9249 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9250 language reference or tutorial.
9251
9252 @menu
9253 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9254 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9255 * Fortran:: Fortran
9256 * Pascal:: Pascal
9257 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9258 * Ada:: Ada
9259 @end menu
9260
9261 @node C
9262 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9263
9264 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9265 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9266
9267 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9268 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9269 together.
9270
9271 @cindex C@t{++}
9272 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9273 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9274 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9275 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9276 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9277 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9278 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9279
9280 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9281 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9282 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9283 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9284 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9285 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9286
9287 @menu
9288 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9289 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9290 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9291 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9292 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9293 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9294 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9295 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9296 @end menu
9297
9298 @node C Operators
9299 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9300
9301 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9302
9303 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9304 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9305 often defined on groups of types.
9306
9307 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9308
9309 @itemize @bullet
9310
9311 @item
9312 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9313 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9314
9315 @item
9316 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9317 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9318
9319 @item
9320 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9321
9322 @item
9323 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9324
9325 @end itemize
9326
9327 @noindent
9328 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9329 in order of increasing precedence:
9330
9331 @table @code
9332 @item ,
9333 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9334 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9335 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9336
9337 @item =
9338 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9339 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9340
9341 @item @var{op}=
9342 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9343 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9344 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9345 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9346 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9347
9348 @item ?:
9349 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9350 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9351 integral type.
9352
9353 @item ||
9354 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9355
9356 @item &&
9357 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9358
9359 @item |
9360 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9361
9362 @item ^
9363 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9364
9365 @item &
9366 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9367
9368 @item ==@r{, }!=
9369 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9370 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9371
9372 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9373 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9374 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9375 and non-zero for true.
9376
9377 @item <<@r{, }>>
9378 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9379
9380 @item @@
9381 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9382
9383 @item +@r{, }-
9384 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9385 pointer types.
9386
9387 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9388 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9389 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9390 integral types.
9391
9392 @item ++@r{, }--
9393 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9394 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9395 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9396 operation takes place.
9397
9398 @item *
9399 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9400 @code{++}.
9401
9402 @item &
9403 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9404
9405 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9406 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9407 to examine the address
9408 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9409 stored.
9410
9411 @item -
9412 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9413 precedence as @code{++}.
9414
9415 @item !
9416 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9417 @code{++}.
9418
9419 @item ~
9420 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9421 @code{++}.
9422
9423
9424 @item .@r{, }->
9425 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9426 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9427 pointer based on the stored type information.
9428 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9429
9430 @item .*@r{, }->*
9431 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9432
9433 @item []
9434 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9435 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9436
9437 @item ()
9438 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9439
9440 @item ::
9441 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9442 and @code{class} types.
9443
9444 @item ::
9445 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9446 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9447 above.
9448 @end table
9449
9450 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9451 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9452 predefined meaning.
9453
9454 @node C Constants
9455 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9456
9457 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9458
9459 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9460 following ways:
9461
9462 @itemize @bullet
9463 @item
9464 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9465 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9466 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9467 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9468 @code{long} value.
9469
9470 @item
9471 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9472 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9473 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9474 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9475 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9476 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9477 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9478 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9479 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9480 constant.
9481
9482 @item
9483 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9484 integral equivalents.
9485
9486 @item
9487 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9488 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9489 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9490 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9491 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9492 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9493 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9494 @samp{\n} for newline.
9495
9496 @item
9497 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9498 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9499 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9500 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9501 characters.
9502
9503 @item
9504 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9505 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9506
9507 @item
9508 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9509 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9510 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9511 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9512 @end itemize
9513
9514 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9515 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9516
9517 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9518 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9519
9520 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9521 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9522 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9523 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9524 @quotation
9525 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9526 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9527 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9528 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9529 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9530 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9531 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9532 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9533 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9534 C@t{++} code.
9535 @end quotation
9536
9537 @enumerate
9538
9539 @cindex member functions
9540 @item
9541 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9542
9543 @smallexample
9544 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9545 @end smallexample
9546
9547 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9548 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9549 @item
9550 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9551 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9552 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9553 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9554
9555 @cindex call overloaded functions
9556 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9557 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9558 @item
9559 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9560 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9561 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9562 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9563 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9564 default arguments.
9565
9566 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9567 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9568 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9569 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9570 number of function arguments.
9571
9572 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9573 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9574 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9575
9576 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9577 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9578 @smallexample
9579 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9580 @end smallexample
9581
9582 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9583 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9584
9585 @cindex reference declarations
9586 @item
9587 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9588 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9589 dereferenced.
9590
9591 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9592 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9593 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9594 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9595 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9596
9597 @item
9598 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9599 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9600 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9601 necessary, for example in an expression like
9602 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9603 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9604 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9605 @end enumerate
9606
9607 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9608 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9609 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9610 invoking user-defined operators.
9611
9612 @node C Defaults
9613 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9614
9615 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9616
9617 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9618 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9619 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9620 selects the working language.
9621
9622 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9623 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9624 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9625 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9626 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9627 for further details.
9628
9629 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9630 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9631 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9632
9633 @node C Checks
9634 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9635
9636 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9637
9638 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9639 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9640 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9641
9642 @itemize @bullet
9643 @item
9644 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9645 enumerated tag.
9646
9647 @item
9648 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9649 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9650
9651 @ignore
9652 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9653 @c FIXME--beers?
9654 @item
9655 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9656 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9657 compilers.)
9658 @end ignore
9659 @end itemize
9660
9661 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9662 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9663 that is not itself an array.
9664
9665 @node Debugging C
9666 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9667
9668 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9669 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9670 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9671 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9672
9673 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9674 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9675 ,Expressions}.
9676
9677 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9678 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9679
9680 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9681
9682 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9683 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9684
9685 @table @code
9686 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9687 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9688 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9689 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
9690 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
9691 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
9692
9693 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9694 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9695 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9696 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9697 classes.
9698 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9699
9700 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9701 @item catch throw
9702 @itemx catch catch
9703 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9704 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9705
9706 @cindex inheritance
9707 @item ptype @var{typename}
9708 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9709 @var{typename}.
9710 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9711
9712 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9713 @item set print demangle
9714 @itemx show print demangle
9715 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9716 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9717 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9718 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9719 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9720
9721 @item set print object
9722 @itemx show print object
9723 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9724 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9725
9726 @item set print vtbl
9727 @itemx show print vtbl
9728 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9729 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9730 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9731 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9732
9733 @kindex set overload-resolution
9734 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9735 @item set overload-resolution on
9736 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9737 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9738 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9739 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9740 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9741 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9742
9743 @item set overload-resolution off
9744 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9745 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9746 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9747 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9748 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9749 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9750 argument types.
9751
9752 @kindex show overload-resolution
9753 @item show overload-resolution
9754 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9755
9756 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9757 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9758 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9759 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9760 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9761 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9762 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9763 @end table
9764
9765 @node Decimal Floating Point
9766 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9767 @cindex decimal floating point format
9768
9769 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9770 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9771 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
9772 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
9773
9774 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
9775 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
9776 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
9777 target.
9778
9779 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
9780 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
9781 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
9782
9783 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
9784 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
9785 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
9786
9787 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
9788 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
9789 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
9790
9791 @node Objective-C
9792 @subsection Objective-C
9793
9794 @cindex Objective-C
9795 This section provides information about some commands and command
9796 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9797 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9798 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9799
9800 @menu
9801 * Method Names in Commands::
9802 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9803 @end menu
9804
9805 @node Method Names in Commands
9806 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9807
9808 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9809 names as line specifications:
9810
9811 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9812 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9813 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9814 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9815 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9816 @itemize
9817 @item @code{clear}
9818 @item @code{break}
9819 @item @code{info line}
9820 @item @code{jump}
9821 @item @code{list}
9822 @end itemize
9823
9824 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9825
9826 @smallexample
9827 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9828 @end smallexample
9829
9830 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9831 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9832 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9833 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9834 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9835 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9836 debugged, enter:
9837
9838 @smallexample
9839 break -[Fruit create]
9840 @end smallexample
9841
9842 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9843 enter:
9844
9845 @smallexample
9846 list +[NSText initialize]
9847 @end smallexample
9848
9849 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9850 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9851 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9852 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9853
9854 @smallexample
9855 break create
9856 @end smallexample
9857
9858 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9859 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9860 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9861 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9862 none apply.
9863
9864 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9865 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9866
9867 @smallexample
9868 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9869 @end smallexample
9870
9871 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9872 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9873 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9874 @kindex print-object
9875 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9876
9877 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9878
9879 @smallexample
9880 print -[@var{object} hash]
9881 @end smallexample
9882
9883 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9884 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9885 @noindent
9886 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9887 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9888 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9889 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9890 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9891 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9892
9893 @node Fortran
9894 @subsection Fortran
9895 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9896
9897 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9898 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9899
9900 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9901 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9902 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9903 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9904 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9905 underscore.
9906
9907 @menu
9908 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9909 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9910 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9911 @end menu
9912
9913 @node Fortran Operators
9914 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9915
9916 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9917
9918 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9919 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9920 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9921
9922 @table @code
9923 @item **
9924 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9925 of the second one.
9926
9927 @item :
9928 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9929 represent a section of array.
9930
9931 @item %
9932 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
9933 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
9934 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
9935 union type.
9936 @end table
9937
9938 @node Fortran Defaults
9939 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9940
9941 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9942
9943 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9944 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9945 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9946 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9947
9948 @node Special Fortran Commands
9949 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9950
9951 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9952
9953 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9954 such as displaying common blocks.
9955
9956 @table @code
9957 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9958 @kindex info common
9959 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9960 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9961 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9962 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9963 printed.
9964 @end table
9965
9966 @node Pascal
9967 @subsection Pascal
9968
9969 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9970 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9971 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9972 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9973 syntax.
9974
9975 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9976 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9977 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9978
9979 @node Modula-2
9980 @subsection Modula-2
9981
9982 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9983
9984 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9985 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9986 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9987 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9988 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9989 table.
9990
9991 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9992 @menu
9993 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9994 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9995 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9996 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9997 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9998 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9999 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10000 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10001 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10002 @end menu
10003
10004 @node M2 Operators
10005 @subsubsection Operators
10006 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10007
10008 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10009 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10010 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10011 following definitions hold:
10012
10013 @itemize @bullet
10014
10015 @item
10016 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10017 their subranges.
10018
10019 @item
10020 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10021
10022 @item
10023 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10024
10025 @item
10026 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10027 @var{type}}.
10028
10029 @item
10030 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10031
10032 @item
10033 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10034
10035 @item
10036 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10037 @end itemize
10038
10039 @noindent
10040 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10041 increasing precedence:
10042
10043 @table @code
10044 @item ,
10045 Function argument or array index separator.
10046
10047 @item :=
10048 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10049 @var{value}.
10050
10051 @item <@r{, }>
10052 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10053 types.
10054
10055 @item <=@r{, }>=
10056 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10057 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10058 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10059
10060 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10061 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10062 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10063 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10064 comment character.
10065
10066 @item IN
10067 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10068 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10069
10070 @item OR
10071 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10072
10073 @item AND@r{, }&
10074 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10075
10076 @item @@
10077 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10078
10079 @item +@r{, }-
10080 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10081 and difference on set types.
10082
10083 @item *
10084 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10085 on set types.
10086
10087 @item /
10088 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10089 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10090
10091 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10092 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10093 precedence as @code{*}.
10094
10095 @item -
10096 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10097
10098 @item ^
10099 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10100
10101 @item NOT
10102 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10103 @code{^}.
10104
10105 @item .
10106 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10107 precedence as @code{^}.
10108
10109 @item []
10110 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10111
10112 @item ()
10113 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10114 as @code{^}.
10115
10116 @item ::@r{, }.
10117 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10118 @end table
10119
10120 @quotation
10121 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10122 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10123 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10124 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10125 @end quotation
10126
10127
10128 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10129 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10130 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10131
10132 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10133 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10134
10135 @table @var
10136
10137 @item a
10138 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10139
10140 @item c
10141 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10142
10143 @item i
10144 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10145
10146 @item m
10147 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10148 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10149 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10150
10151 @item n
10152 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10153
10154 @item r
10155 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10156
10157 @item t
10158 represents a type.
10159
10160 @item v
10161 represents a variable.
10162
10163 @item x
10164 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10165 explanation of the function for details.
10166 @end table
10167
10168 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10169
10170 @table @code
10171 @item ABS(@var{n})
10172 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10173
10174 @item CAP(@var{c})
10175 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10176 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10177
10178 @item CHR(@var{i})
10179 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10180
10181 @item DEC(@var{v})
10182 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10183
10184 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10185 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10186 new value.
10187
10188 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10189 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10190 set.
10191
10192 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10193 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10194
10195 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10196 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10197
10198 @item INC(@var{v})
10199 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10200
10201 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10202 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10203 new value.
10204
10205 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10206 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10207 there. Returns the new set.
10208
10209 @item MAX(@var{t})
10210 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10211
10212 @item MIN(@var{t})
10213 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10214
10215 @item ODD(@var{i})
10216 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10217
10218 @item ORD(@var{x})
10219 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10220 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10221 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10222 integral, character and enumerated types.
10223
10224 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10225 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10226
10227 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10228 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10229
10230 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10231 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10232
10233 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10234 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10235 @end table
10236
10237 @quotation
10238 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10239 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10240 an error.
10241 @end quotation
10242
10243 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10244 @node M2 Constants
10245 @subsubsection Constants
10246
10247 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10248 ways:
10249
10250 @itemize @bullet
10251
10252 @item
10253 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10254 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10255 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10256 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10257
10258 @item
10259 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10260 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10261 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10262 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10263 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10264 digits.
10265
10266 @item
10267 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10268 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10269 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10270 followed by a @samp{C}.
10271
10272 @item
10273 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10274 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10275 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10276 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10277 sequences.
10278
10279 @item
10280 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10281
10282 @item
10283 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10284 @code{FALSE}.
10285
10286 @item
10287 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10288
10289 @item
10290 Set constants are not yet supported.
10291 @end itemize
10292
10293 @node M2 Types
10294 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10295 @cindex Modula-2 types
10296
10297 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10298 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10299 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10300 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10301 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10302 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10303
10304 The first example contains the following section of code:
10305
10306 @smallexample
10307 VAR
10308 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10309 r: [20..40] ;
10310 @end smallexample
10311
10312 @noindent
10313 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10314 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10315
10316 @smallexample
10317 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10318 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10319 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10320 SET OF CHAR
10321 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10322 21
10323 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10324 [20..40]
10325 @end smallexample
10326
10327 @noindent
10328 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10329
10330 @smallexample
10331 VAR
10332 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10333 @end smallexample
10334
10335 @noindent
10336 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10337
10338 @smallexample
10339 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10340 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10341 @end smallexample
10342
10343 @noindent
10344 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10345 expressions using the debugger.
10346
10347 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10348 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10349
10350 @smallexample
10351 VAR
10352 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10353 @end smallexample
10354
10355 @smallexample
10356 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10357 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10358 @end smallexample
10359
10360 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10361 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10362 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10363 above.
10364
10365 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10366
10367 @smallexample
10368 TYPE
10369 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10370 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10371 VAR
10372 s: t ;
10373 BEGIN
10374 s := blue ;
10375 @end smallexample
10376
10377 @noindent
10378 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10379 and value of a variable.
10380
10381 @smallexample
10382 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10383 $1 = blue
10384 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10385 type = [blue..yellow]
10386 @end smallexample
10387
10388 @noindent
10389 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10390 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10391 their @code{C} counterparts.
10392
10393 @smallexample
10394 VAR
10395 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10396 BEGIN
10397 s[1] := 1 ;
10398 @end smallexample
10399
10400 @smallexample
10401 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10402 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10403 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10404 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10405 @end smallexample
10406
10407 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10408 pointer types as shown in this example:
10409
10410 @smallexample
10411 VAR
10412 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10413 BEGIN
10414 NEW(s) ;
10415 s^[1] := 1 ;
10416 @end smallexample
10417
10418 @noindent
10419 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10420
10421 @smallexample
10422 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10423 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10424 @end smallexample
10425
10426 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10427 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10428 types:
10429
10430 @smallexample
10431 TYPE
10432 foo = RECORD
10433 f1: CARDINAL ;
10434 f2: CHAR ;
10435 f3: myarray ;
10436 END ;
10437
10438 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10439 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10440 VAR
10441 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10442 @end smallexample
10443
10444 @noindent
10445 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10446 below.
10447
10448 @smallexample
10449 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10450 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10451 f1 : CARDINAL;
10452 f2 : CHAR;
10453 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10454 END
10455 @end smallexample
10456
10457 @node M2 Defaults
10458 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10459 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10460
10461 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10462 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10463 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10464 selected the working language.
10465
10466 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10467 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10468 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10469 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10470
10471 @node Deviations
10472 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10473 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10474
10475 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10476 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10477
10478 @itemize @bullet
10479 @item
10480 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10481 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10482 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10483 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10484 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10485 returned a pointer.)
10486
10487 @item
10488 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10489 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10490 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10491 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10492
10493 @item
10494 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10495 argument.
10496
10497 @item
10498 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10499 @end itemize
10500
10501 @node M2 Checks
10502 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10503 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10504
10505 @quotation
10506 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10507 range checking.
10508 @end quotation
10509 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10510
10511 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10512
10513 @itemize @bullet
10514 @item
10515 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10516 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10517
10518 @item
10519 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10520 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10521 @end itemize
10522
10523 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10524 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10525
10526 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10527 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10528
10529 @node M2 Scope
10530 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10531 @cindex scope
10532 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10533 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10534 @ifinfo
10535 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10536 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10537 @end ifinfo
10538 @iftex
10539 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10540 @end iftex
10541
10542 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10543 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10544 similar syntax:
10545
10546 @smallexample
10547
10548 @var{module} . @var{id}
10549 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10550 @end smallexample
10551
10552 @noindent
10553 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10554 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10555 identifier within your program, except another module.
10556
10557 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10558 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10559 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10560 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10561
10562 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10563 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10564 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10565 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10566 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10567 @var{module}.
10568
10569 @node GDB/M2
10570 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10571
10572 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10573 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10574 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10575 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10576 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10577 analogue in Modula-2.
10578
10579 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10580 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10581 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10582 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10583 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10584 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10585
10586 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10587 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10588 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10589
10590 @node Ada
10591 @subsection Ada
10592 @cindex Ada
10593
10594 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10595 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10596 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10597 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10598 to be difficult.
10599
10600
10601 @cindex expressions in Ada
10602 @menu
10603 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10604 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10605 in @value{GDBN}.
10606 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10607 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10608 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10609 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10610 @end menu
10611
10612 @node Ada Mode Intro
10613 @subsubsection Introduction
10614 @cindex Ada mode, general
10615
10616 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10617 syntax, with some extensions.
10618 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10619
10620 @itemize @bullet
10621 @item
10622 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10623 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10624 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10625 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10626
10627 @item
10628 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10629 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10630
10631 @item
10632 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10633 @end itemize
10634
10635 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10636 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10637 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10638 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10639 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10640
10641 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10642 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10643 was translated from an Ada source file.
10644
10645 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10646 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10647 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10648 middle (to allow based literals).
10649
10650 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10651 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10652 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10653 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10654 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10655 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10656
10657 @node Omissions from Ada
10658 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10659 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10660
10661 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10662
10663 @itemize @bullet
10664 @item
10665 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10666
10667 @itemize @minus
10668 @item
10669 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10670 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10671
10672 @item
10673 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10674
10675 @item
10676 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10677
10678 @item
10679 @t{'Tag}.
10680
10681 @item
10682 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10683 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10684
10685 @item
10686 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10687 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10688
10689 @item
10690 @t{'Address}.
10691 @end itemize
10692
10693 @item
10694 The names in
10695 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10696 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10697 not currently available.
10698
10699 @item
10700 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10701 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10702 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10703 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10704 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10705 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10706 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10707 indeterminate values.
10708
10709 @item
10710 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10711 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10712 are not implemented.
10713
10714 @item
10715 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10716 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10717 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10718 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10719 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10720
10721 @smallexample
10722 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10723 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10724 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10725 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10726 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10727 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10728 @end smallexample
10729
10730 Changing a
10731 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10732 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10733 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10734 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10735 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10736 declared to have a type such as:
10737
10738 @smallexample
10739 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10740 Id : Integer;
10741 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10742 end record;
10743 @end smallexample
10744
10745 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10746 assignments:
10747
10748 @smallexample
10749 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10750 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10751 @end smallexample
10752
10753 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10754 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10755 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10756 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10757 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10758 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10759 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10760 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10761
10762 @item
10763 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10764
10765 @item
10766 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10767 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10768 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10769 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10770 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10771 the proper resolution.
10772
10773 @item
10774 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10775
10776 @item
10777 Entry calls are not implemented.
10778
10779 @item
10780 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10781 formats are not supported.
10782
10783 @item
10784 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10785 @end itemize
10786
10787 @node Additions to Ada
10788 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10789 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10790
10791 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10792 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10793
10794 @itemize @bullet
10795 @item
10796 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10797 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10798 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10799 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10800 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10801 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10802 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10803 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10804
10805 @item
10806 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10807 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10808 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10809
10810 @item
10811 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10812 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10813
10814 @item
10815 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10816 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10817 @end itemize
10818
10819 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10820 additions specific to Ada:
10821
10822 @itemize @bullet
10823 @item
10824 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10825 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10826
10827 @smallexample
10828 set x := y + 3
10829 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10830 @end smallexample
10831
10832 @item
10833 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10834 the value of its right-hand operand.
10835 This allows, for example,
10836 complex conditional breaks:
10837
10838 @smallexample
10839 break f
10840 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10841 @end smallexample
10842
10843 @item
10844 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10845 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10846 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10847 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10848 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10849 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10850 in strings. For example,
10851 @smallexample
10852 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10853 @end smallexample
10854 @noindent
10855 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10856 after each period.
10857
10858 @item
10859 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10860 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10861 to write
10862
10863 @smallexample
10864 print 'max(x, y)
10865 @end smallexample
10866
10867 @item
10868 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10869 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10870 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10871 of 3 might print as
10872
10873 @smallexample
10874 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10875 @end smallexample
10876
10877 @noindent
10878 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10879 clause.
10880
10881 @item
10882 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10883 multi-character subsequence of
10884 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10885 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10886 in place of @t{a'length}.
10887
10888 @item
10889 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10890 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10891 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10892 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10893 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10894 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10895 For example,
10896 @smallexample
10897 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10898 @end smallexample
10899
10900 @item
10901 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10902 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10903 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10904 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10905 object.
10906
10907 @end itemize
10908
10909 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10910 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10911
10912 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10913 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10914 before reaching the main procedure.
10915 As defined in the Ada Reference
10916 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10917 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10918 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10919 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10920
10921 @node Ada Glitches
10922 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10923 @cindex Ada, problems
10924
10925 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10926 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10927 @value{GDBN},
10928 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10929 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10930
10931 @itemize @bullet
10932 @item
10933 Currently, the debugger
10934 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10935 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10936 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10937 to get it printed properly.
10938
10939 @item
10940 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10941 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10942
10943 @item
10944 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10945 argument lists are treated as positional).
10946
10947 @item
10948 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10949
10950 @item
10951 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10952 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10953 the host machine.
10954
10955 @item
10956 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10957
10958 @item
10959 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10960 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10961 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10962 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10963 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10964 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10965 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10966 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10967 you can usually resolve the confusion
10968 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10969 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10970 @end itemize
10971
10972 @node Unsupported Languages
10973 @section Unsupported Languages
10974
10975 @cindex unsupported languages
10976 @cindex minimal language
10977 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10978 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10979 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10980 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10981 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10982 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10983
10984 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10985 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10986 language.
10987
10988 @node Symbols
10989 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10990
10991 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10992 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10993 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10994 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10995 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10996 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10997 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10998
10999 @cindex symbol names
11000 @cindex names of symbols
11001 @cindex quoting names
11002 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11003 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11004 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11005 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11006 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11007 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11008 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11009 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11010
11011 @smallexample
11012 p 'foo.c'::x
11013 @end smallexample
11014
11015 @noindent
11016 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11017
11018 @table @code
11019 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11020 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11021 @kindex set case-sensitive
11022 @item set case-sensitive on
11023 @itemx set case-sensitive off
11024 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
11025 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11026 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11027 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11028 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11029 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11030 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11031 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11032 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11033 case-insensitive matches.
11034
11035 @kindex show case-sensitive
11036 @item show case-sensitive
11037 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11038 lookups.
11039
11040 @kindex info address
11041 @cindex address of a symbol
11042 @item info address @var{symbol}
11043 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11044 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11045 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11046 is always stored.
11047
11048 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11049 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11050 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11051
11052 @kindex info symbol
11053 @cindex symbol from address
11054 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11055 @item info symbol @var{addr}
11056 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11057 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11058 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11059
11060 @smallexample
11061 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11062 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11063 @end smallexample
11064
11065 @noindent
11066 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11067 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11068
11069 @kindex whatis
11070 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
11071 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11072 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11073 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11074 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11075 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11076 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11077 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11078 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11079 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11080 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11081
11082 @kindex ptype
11083 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
11084 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11085 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11086 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11087
11088 For example, for this variable declaration:
11089
11090 @smallexample
11091 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11092 @end smallexample
11093
11094 @noindent
11095 the two commands give this output:
11096
11097 @smallexample
11098 @group
11099 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11100 type = struct complex
11101 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11102 type = struct complex @{
11103 double real;
11104 double imag;
11105 @}
11106 @end group
11107 @end smallexample
11108
11109 @noindent
11110 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11111 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11112
11113 @cindex incomplete type
11114 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11115 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11116 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11117 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11118 given these declarations:
11119
11120 @smallexample
11121 struct foo;
11122 struct foo *fooptr;
11123 @end smallexample
11124
11125 @noindent
11126 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11127
11128 @smallexample
11129 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11130 $1 = <incomplete type>
11131 @end smallexample
11132
11133 @noindent
11134 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11135 completely specified.
11136
11137 @kindex info types
11138 @item info types @var{regexp}
11139 @itemx info types
11140 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11141 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11142 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11143 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11144 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11145 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11146 name is @code{value}.
11147
11148 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11149 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11150 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11151
11152 @kindex info scope
11153 @cindex local variables
11154 @item info scope @var{location}
11155 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11156 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11157 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11158 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11159 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11160
11161 @smallexample
11162 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11163 Scope for command_line_handler:
11164 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11165 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11166 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11167 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11168 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11169 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11170 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11171 @end smallexample
11172
11173 @noindent
11174 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11175 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11176 collect}.
11177
11178 @kindex info source
11179 @item info source
11180 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11181 the function containing the current point of execution:
11182 @itemize @bullet
11183 @item
11184 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11185 @item
11186 the directory it was compiled in,
11187 @item
11188 its length, in lines,
11189 @item
11190 which programming language it is written in,
11191 @item
11192 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11193 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11194 @item
11195 whether the debugging information includes information about
11196 preprocessor macros.
11197 @end itemize
11198
11199
11200 @kindex info sources
11201 @item info sources
11202 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11203 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11204 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11205
11206 @kindex info functions
11207 @item info functions
11208 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11209
11210 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11211 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11212 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11213 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11214 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11215 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11216 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11217 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11218
11219 @kindex info variables
11220 @item info variables
11221 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11222 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11223
11224 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11225 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11226 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11227 @var{regexp}.
11228
11229 @kindex info classes
11230 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11231 @item info classes
11232 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11233 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11234 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11235 expression.
11236
11237 @kindex info selectors
11238 @item info selectors
11239 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11240 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11241 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11242 expression.
11243
11244 @ignore
11245 This was never implemented.
11246 @kindex info methods
11247 @item info methods
11248 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11249 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11250 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11251 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11252 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11253 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11254 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11255 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11256 @end ignore
11257
11258 @cindex reloading symbols
11259 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11260 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11261 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11262 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11263 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11264
11265 @table @code
11266 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11267 @item set symbol-reloading on
11268 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11269 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11270
11271 @item set symbol-reloading off
11272 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11273 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11274 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11275 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11276 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11277 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11278 name.
11279
11280 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11281 @item show symbol-reloading
11282 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11283 @end table
11284
11285 @cindex opaque data types
11286 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11287 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11288 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11289 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11290 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11291 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11292 another source file. The default is on.
11293
11294 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11295 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11296
11297 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11298 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11299 is printed as follows:
11300 @smallexample
11301 @{<no data fields>@}
11302 @end smallexample
11303
11304 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11305 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11306 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11307
11308 @kindex maint print symbols
11309 @cindex symbol dump
11310 @kindex maint print psymbols
11311 @cindex partial symbol dump
11312 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11313 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11314 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11315 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11316 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11317 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11318 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11319 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11320 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11321 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11322 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11323 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11324 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11325 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11326 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11327 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11328 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11329
11330 @kindex maint info symtabs
11331 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11332 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11333 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11334 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11335 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11336 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11337 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11338
11339 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11340 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11341 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11342 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11343 structure in more detail. For example:
11344
11345 @smallexample
11346 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11347 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11348 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11349 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11350 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11351 readin no
11352 fullname (null)
11353 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11354 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11355 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11356 dependencies (none)
11357 @}
11358 @}
11359 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11360 (@value{GDBP})
11361 @end smallexample
11362 @noindent
11363 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11364 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11365 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11366 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11367 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11368
11369 @smallexample
11370 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11371 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11372 line 1574.
11373 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11374 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11375 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11376 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11377 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11378 dirname (null)
11379 fullname (null)
11380 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11381 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11382 debugformat DWARF 2
11383 @}
11384 @}
11385 (@value{GDBP})
11386 @end smallexample
11387 @end table
11388
11389
11390 @node Altering
11391 @chapter Altering Execution
11392
11393 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11394 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11395 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11396 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11397 program.
11398
11399 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11400 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11401 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11402
11403 @menu
11404 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11405 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11406 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11407 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11408 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11409 * Patching:: Patching your program
11410 @end menu
11411
11412 @node Assignment
11413 @section Assignment to Variables
11414
11415 @cindex assignment
11416 @cindex setting variables
11417 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11418 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11419
11420 @smallexample
11421 print x=4
11422 @end smallexample
11423
11424 @noindent
11425 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11426 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11427 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11428 information on operators in supported languages.
11429
11430 @kindex set variable
11431 @cindex variables, setting
11432 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11433 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11434 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11435 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11436 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11437
11438 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11439 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11440 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11441 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11442 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11443 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11444 command @code{set width}:
11445
11446 @smallexample
11447 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11448 type = double
11449 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11450 $4 = 13
11451 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11452 Invalid syntax in expression.
11453 @end smallexample
11454
11455 @noindent
11456 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11457 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11458
11459 @smallexample
11460 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11461 @end smallexample
11462
11463 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11464 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11465 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11466 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11467 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11468 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11469
11470 @smallexample
11471 @group
11472 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11473 type = double
11474 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11475 $1 = 1
11476 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11477 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11478 $2 = 1
11479 (@value{GDBP}) r
11480 The program being debugged has been started already.
11481 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11482 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11483 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11484 Invalid bfd target.
11485 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11486 The current BFD target is "=4".
11487 @end group
11488 @end smallexample
11489
11490 @noindent
11491 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11492 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11493 @code{g}, use
11494
11495 @smallexample
11496 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11497 @end smallexample
11498
11499 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11500 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11501 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11502 same length or shorter.
11503 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11504 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11505
11506 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11507 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11508 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11509 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11510 and representation in memory), and
11511
11512 @smallexample
11513 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11514 @end smallexample
11515
11516 @noindent
11517 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11518
11519 @node Jumping
11520 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11521
11522 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11523 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11524 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11525
11526 @table @code
11527 @kindex jump
11528 @item jump @var{linespec}
11529 @itemx jump @var{location}
11530 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11531 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11532 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11533 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11534 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11535 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11536
11537 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11538 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11539 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11540 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11541 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11542 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11543 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11544 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11545 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11546 @end table
11547
11548 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11549 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11550 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11551 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11552 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11553 example,
11554
11555 @smallexample
11556 set $pc = 0x485
11557 @end smallexample
11558
11559 @noindent
11560 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11561 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11562 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11563
11564 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11565 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11566 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11567 detail.
11568
11569 @c @group
11570 @node Signaling
11571 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11572 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11573
11574 @table @code
11575 @kindex signal
11576 @item signal @var{signal}
11577 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11578 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11579 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11580 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11581
11582 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11583 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11584 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11585 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11586 signal.
11587
11588 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11589 after executing the command.
11590 @end table
11591 @c @end group
11592
11593 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11594 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11595 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11596 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11597 passes the signal directly to your program.
11598
11599
11600 @node Returning
11601 @section Returning from a Function
11602
11603 @table @code
11604 @cindex returning from a function
11605 @kindex return
11606 @item return
11607 @itemx return @var{expression}
11608 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11609 command. If you give an
11610 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11611 value.
11612 @end table
11613
11614 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11615 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11616 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11617 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11618
11619 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11620 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11621 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11622 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11623 of functions.
11624
11625 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11626 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11627 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11628 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11629 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11630
11631 @node Calling
11632 @section Calling Program Functions
11633
11634 @table @code
11635 @cindex calling functions
11636 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11637 @item print @var{expr}
11638 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11639 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11640 debugged.
11641
11642 @kindex call
11643 @item call @var{expr}
11644 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11645 returned values.
11646
11647 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11648 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11649 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11650 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11651 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11652 value history.
11653 @end table
11654
11655 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11656 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11657 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11658 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11659
11660 @table @code
11661 @item set unwindonsignal
11662 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11663 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11664 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11665 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11666 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11667 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11668 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11669 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11670 received.
11671
11672 @item show unwindonsignal
11673 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11674 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11675 @value{GDBN}.
11676 @end table
11677
11678 @cindex weak alias functions
11679 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11680 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11681 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11682 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11683 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11684 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11685 function instead.
11686
11687 @node Patching
11688 @section Patching Programs
11689
11690 @cindex patching binaries
11691 @cindex writing into executables
11692 @cindex writing into corefiles
11693
11694 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11695 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11696 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11697 patching your program's binary.
11698
11699 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11700 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11701 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11702 repairs.
11703
11704 @table @code
11705 @kindex set write
11706 @item set write on
11707 @itemx set write off
11708 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11709 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11710 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11711
11712 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11713 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11714 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11715
11716 @item show write
11717 @kindex show write
11718 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11719 as well as reading.
11720 @end table
11721
11722 @node GDB Files
11723 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11724
11725 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11726 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11727 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11728 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11729
11730 @menu
11731 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11732 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11733 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11734 @end menu
11735
11736 @node Files
11737 @section Commands to Specify Files
11738
11739 @cindex symbol table
11740 @cindex core dump file
11741
11742 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11743 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11744 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11745 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11746
11747 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11748 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11749 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11750 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11751 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11752 new files are useful.
11753
11754 @table @code
11755 @cindex executable file
11756 @kindex file
11757 @item file @var{filename}
11758 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11759 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11760 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11761 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11762 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11763 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11764 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11765 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11766
11767 @cindex unlinked object files
11768 @cindex patching object files
11769 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11770 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11771 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11772 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11773 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11774 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11775 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11776 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11777
11778 @item file
11779 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11780 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11781
11782 @kindex exec-file
11783 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11784 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11785 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11786 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11787 discard information on the executable file.
11788
11789 @kindex symbol-file
11790 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11791 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11792 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11793 table and program to run from the same file.
11794
11795 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11796 program's symbol table.
11797
11798 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11799 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11800 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11801 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11802 @value{GDBN}.
11803
11804 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11805 executing it once.
11806
11807 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11808 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11809 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11810 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11811 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11812 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11813 optimized code.
11814
11815 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11816 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11817 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11818 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11819 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11820
11821 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11822 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11823 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11824 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11825 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11826 Warnings and Messages}.)
11827
11828 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11829 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11830 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11831 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11832 in stabs format.
11833
11834 @kindex readnow
11835 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11836 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11837 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11838 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11839 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11840 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11841 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11842 entire symbol table available.
11843
11844 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11845 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11846 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11847 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11848 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11849 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11850 @c files.
11851
11852 @kindex core-file
11853 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11854 @itemx core
11855 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11856 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11857 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11858 executable file itself for other parts.
11859
11860 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11861 to be used.
11862
11863 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11864 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11865 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11866 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11867 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11868
11869 @kindex add-symbol-file
11870 @cindex dynamic linking
11871 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11872 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11873 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11874 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11875 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11876 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11877 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11878 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11879 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11880 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11881 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11882 @var{address} as an expression.
11883
11884 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11885 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11886 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11887 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11888 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11889
11890 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11891 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11892 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11893 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11894 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11895 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11896 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11897 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11898 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11899
11900 @itemize @bullet
11901 @item
11902 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11903 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11904 @item
11905 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11906 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11907 @item
11908 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11909 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11910 @end itemize
11911
11912 @noindent
11913 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11914 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11915 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11916 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11917 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11918 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11919 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11920 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11921 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11922 way.
11923
11924 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11925
11926 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11927 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11928 @cindex load symbols from memory
11929 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11930 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11931 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11932 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11933 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11934 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11935 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11936 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11937 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11938
11939 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11940 @kindex assf
11941 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11942 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11943 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11944 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11945 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11946 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11947 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11948 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11949 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11950 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11951
11952 @kindex section
11953 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11954 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11955 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11956 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11957 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11958 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11959 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11960 their addresses.
11961
11962 @kindex info files
11963 @kindex info target
11964 @item info files
11965 @itemx info target
11966 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11967 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11968 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11969 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11970 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11971 current ones.
11972
11973 @kindex maint info sections
11974 @item maint info sections
11975 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11976 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11977 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11978 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11979 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11980 may be arbitrarily combined):
11981
11982 @table @code
11983 @item ALLOBJ
11984 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11985 @item @var{sections}
11986 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11987 @item @var{section-flags}
11988 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11989 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11990 @table @code
11991 @item ALLOC
11992 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11993 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11994 @item LOAD
11995 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11996 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11997 @item RELOC
11998 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11999 @item READONLY
12000 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
12001 @item CODE
12002 Section contains executable code only.
12003 @item DATA
12004 Section contains data only (no executable code).
12005 @item ROM
12006 Section will reside in ROM.
12007 @item CONSTRUCTOR
12008 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
12009 @item HAS_CONTENTS
12010 Section is not empty.
12011 @item NEVER_LOAD
12012 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
12013 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
12014 A notification to the linker that the section contains
12015 COFF shared library information.
12016 @item IS_COMMON
12017 Section contains common symbols.
12018 @end table
12019 @end table
12020 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
12021 @cindex read-only sections
12022 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
12023 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12024 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12025 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12026 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12027 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12028 enhancement to debugging performance.
12029
12030 The default is off.
12031
12032 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
12033 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12034 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12035 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12036
12037 @item show trust-readonly-sections
12038 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12039 @end table
12040
12041 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12042 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12043 name and remembers it that way.
12044
12045 @cindex shared libraries
12046 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
12047 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12048 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12049
12050 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12051 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12052
12053 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12054 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12055 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12056 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12057 debugging a core file).
12058
12059 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12060 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12061
12062 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12063 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12064 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12065
12066 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12067 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12068 particularly large or there are many of them.
12069
12070 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12071 commands:
12072
12073 @table @code
12074 @kindex set auto-solib-add
12075 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12076 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12077 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12078 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12079 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12080 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12081 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12082
12083 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
12084 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12085 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12086 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12087 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12088 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12089 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12090 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12091 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12092
12093 @kindex show auto-solib-add
12094 @item show auto-solib-add
12095 Display the current autoloading mode.
12096 @end table
12097
12098 @cindex load shared library
12099 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12100 command:
12101
12102 @table @code
12103 @kindex info sharedlibrary
12104 @kindex info share
12105 @item info share
12106 @itemx info sharedlibrary
12107 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12108
12109 @kindex sharedlibrary
12110 @kindex share
12111 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12112 @itemx share @var{regex}
12113 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12114 Unix regular expression.
12115 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12116 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12117 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12118 loaded.
12119
12120 @item nosharedlibrary
12121 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12122 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12123 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12124 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12125 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12126 discarded.
12127 @end table
12128
12129 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12130 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12131 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12132
12133 @table @code
12134 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12135 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12136 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12137 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12138 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12139 shared library.
12140
12141 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12142 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12143 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12144 library events happen.
12145 @end table
12146
12147 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12148 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12149 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12150 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12151 not.
12152
12153 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12154 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12155 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12156 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12157 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12158
12159 @table @code
12160 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12161 @cindex system root, alternate
12162 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12163 @kindex set sysroot
12164 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12165 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12166 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12167 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12168 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12169 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12170 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12171 under @var{path}.
12172
12173 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12174 sysroot}.
12175
12176 @cindex default system root
12177 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12178 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12179 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12180 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12181 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12182 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12183 location.
12184
12185 @kindex show sysroot
12186 @item show sysroot
12187 Display the current shared library prefix.
12188
12189 @kindex set solib-search-path
12190 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12191 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12192 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12193 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12194 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12195 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12196 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12197 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12198 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12199 of shared library symbols.
12200
12201 @kindex show solib-search-path
12202 @item show solib-search-path
12203 Display the current shared library search path.
12204 @end table
12205
12206
12207 @node Separate Debug Files
12208 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12209 @cindex separate debugging information files
12210 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12211 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12212 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12213 @cindex global debugging information directory
12214 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12215 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12216
12217 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12218 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12219 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12220 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12221 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12222 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12223 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12224
12225 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12226 file:
12227
12228 @itemize @bullet
12229 @item
12230 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12231 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12232 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12233 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12234 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12235 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12236 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12237 came from the same build.
12238
12239 @item
12240 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12241 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12242 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12243 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12244 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12245 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12246 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12247 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12248 below.
12249 @end itemize
12250
12251 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12252 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12253
12254 @itemize @bullet
12255 @item
12256 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12257 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12258 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12259 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12260 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12261
12262 @item
12263 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12264 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12265 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12266 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12267 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12268 hex characters, not 10.)
12269 @end itemize
12270
12271 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12272 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12273 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12274 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12275 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12276 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12277
12278 @itemize @minus
12279 @item
12280 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12281 @item
12282 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12283 @item
12284 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12285 @item
12286 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12287 @end itemize
12288
12289 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12290 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12291
12292 @table @code
12293
12294 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12295 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12296 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12297 information files to @var{directory}.
12298
12299 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12300 @item show debug-file-directory
12301 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12302 information files.
12303
12304 @end table
12305
12306 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12307 @cindex debug link sections
12308 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12309 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12310
12311 @itemize
12312 @item
12313 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12314 a zero byte,
12315 @item
12316 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12317 boundary within the section, and
12318 @item
12319 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12320 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12321 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12322 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12323 @end itemize
12324
12325 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12326 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12327 described above.
12328
12329 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12330 @cindex build ID sections
12331 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12332 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12333 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12334 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12335 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12336 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12337 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12338 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12339 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12340
12341 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12342 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12343 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12344 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12345 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12346 in an ordinary executable.
12347
12348 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12349 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12350 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12351 following commands:
12352
12353 @smallexample
12354 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12355 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12356 @end smallexample
12357
12358 @noindent
12359 These commands remove the debugging
12360 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12361 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12362 two files:
12363
12364 @itemize @bullet
12365 @item
12366 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12367 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12368
12369 @smallexample
12370 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12371 @end smallexample
12372
12373 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12374 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12375 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12376 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12377
12378 @item
12379 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12380 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12381 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12382 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12383 @end itemize
12384
12385 @noindent
12386
12387 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12388 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12389 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12390 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12391
12392 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12393 @smallexample
12394 unsigned long
12395 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12396 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12397 @{
12398 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12399 @{
12400 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12401 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12402 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12403 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12404 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12405 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12406 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12407 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12408 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12409 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12410 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12411 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12412 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12413 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12414 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12415 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12416 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12417 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12418 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12419 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12420 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12421 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12422 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12423 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12424 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12425 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12426 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12427 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12428 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12429 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12430 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12431 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12432 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12433 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12434 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12435 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12436 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12437 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12438 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12439 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12440 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12441 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12442 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12443 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12444 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12445 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12446 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12447 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12448 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12449 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12450 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12451 0x2d02ef8d
12452 @};
12453 unsigned char *end;
12454
12455 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12456 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12457 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12458 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12459 @}
12460 @end smallexample
12461
12462 @noindent
12463 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12464
12465
12466 @node Symbol Errors
12467 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12468
12469 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12470 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12471 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12472 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12473 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12474 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12475 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12476 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12477 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12478 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12479 Messages}).
12480
12481 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12482
12483 @table @code
12484 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12485
12486 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12487 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12488 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12489 in its outer scope blocks.
12490
12491 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12492 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12493 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12494 function.
12495
12496 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12497
12498 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12499 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12500 do so.
12501
12502 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12503 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12504 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12505 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12506 Messages}.)
12507
12508 @item bad block start address patched
12509
12510 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12511 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12512 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12513
12514 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12515 starting on the previous source line.
12516
12517 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12518
12519 @cindex foo
12520 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12521 larger than the size of the string table.
12522
12523 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12524 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12525 with this name.
12526
12527 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12528
12529 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12530 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12531 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12532
12533 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12534 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12535 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12536 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12537 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12538 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12539
12540 @item stub type has NULL name
12541
12542 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12543
12544 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12545 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12546 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12547 it.
12548
12549 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12550
12551 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12552
12553 @end table
12554
12555 @node Targets
12556 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12557
12558 @cindex debugging target
12559 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12560
12561 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12562 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12563 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12564 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12565 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12566 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12567 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12568 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12569
12570 @cindex target architecture
12571 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12572 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12573 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12574 command.
12575
12576 @table @code
12577 @kindex set architecture
12578 @kindex show architecture
12579 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12580 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12581 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12582 supported architectures.
12583
12584 @item show architecture
12585 Show the current target architecture.
12586
12587 @item set processor
12588 @itemx processor
12589 @kindex set processor
12590 @kindex show processor
12591 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12592 and @code{show architecture}.
12593 @end table
12594
12595 @menu
12596 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12597 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12598 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12599 @end menu
12600
12601 @node Active Targets
12602 @section Active Targets
12603
12604 @cindex stacking targets
12605 @cindex active targets
12606 @cindex multiple targets
12607
12608 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12609 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12610 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12611 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12612 a core file.
12613
12614 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12615 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12616 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12617 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12618 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12619 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12620 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12621 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12622 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12623
12624 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12625 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12626 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12627 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12628 process target is active.
12629
12630 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12631 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12632 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12633 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12634 Process}).
12635
12636 @node Target Commands
12637 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12638
12639 @table @code
12640 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12641 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12642 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12643 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12644 protocol of the target machine.
12645
12646 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12647 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12648 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12649
12650 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12651 after executing the command.
12652
12653 @kindex help target
12654 @item help target
12655 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12656 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12657 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12658
12659 @item help target @var{name}
12660 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12661 select it.
12662
12663 @kindex set gnutarget
12664 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12665 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12666 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12667 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12668 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12669 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12670
12671 @quotation
12672 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12673 you must know the actual BFD name.
12674 @end quotation
12675
12676 @noindent
12677 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12678
12679 @kindex show gnutarget
12680 @item show gnutarget
12681 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12682 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12683 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12684 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12685 @end table
12686
12687 @cindex common targets
12688 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12689 configuration):
12690
12691 @table @code
12692 @kindex target
12693 @item target exec @var{program}
12694 @cindex executable file target
12695 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12696 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12697
12698 @item target core @var{filename}
12699 @cindex core dump file target
12700 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12701 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12702
12703 @item target remote @var{medium}
12704 @cindex remote target
12705 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12706 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12707 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12708
12709 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12710 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12711
12712 @smallexample
12713 target remote /dev/ttya
12714 @end smallexample
12715
12716 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12717 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12718 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12719 clobbered by the download.
12720
12721 @item target sim
12722 @cindex built-in simulator target
12723 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12724 In general,
12725 @smallexample
12726 target sim
12727 load
12728 run
12729 @end smallexample
12730 @noindent
12731 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12732 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12733 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12734 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12735 Processors}.
12736
12737 @end table
12738
12739 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12740
12741 @table @code
12742
12743 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12744 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12745 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12746
12747 @end table
12748
12749 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12750 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12751
12752 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12753 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12754 various aspects of this process.
12755
12756 @table @code
12757
12758 @item set hash
12759 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12760 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12761 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12762 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12763 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12764 monitor.
12765
12766 @item show hash
12767 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12768 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12769
12770 @item set debug monitor
12771 @kindex set debug monitor
12772 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12773 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12774 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12775
12776 @item show debug monitor
12777 @kindex show debug monitor
12778 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12779 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12780 @end table
12781
12782 @table @code
12783
12784 @kindex load @var{filename}
12785 @item load @var{filename}
12786 @anchor{load}
12787 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12788 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12789 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12790 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12791 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12792 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12793
12794 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12795 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12796 target is @dots{}}''
12797
12798 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12799 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12800 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12801 specifies a fixed address.
12802 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12803
12804 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12805 load programs into flash memory.
12806
12807 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12808 @end table
12809
12810 @node Byte Order
12811 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12812
12813 @cindex choosing target byte order
12814 @cindex target byte order
12815
12816 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12817 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12818 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12819 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12820 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12821 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12822
12823 @table @code
12824 @kindex set endian
12825 @item set endian big
12826 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12827
12828 @item set endian little
12829 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12830
12831 @item set endian auto
12832 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12833 executable.
12834
12835 @item show endian
12836 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12837
12838 @end table
12839
12840 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12841 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12842 target system.
12843
12844
12845 @node Remote Debugging
12846 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12847 @cindex remote debugging
12848
12849 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12850 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12851 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12852 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12853 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12854
12855 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12856 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12857 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12858 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12859 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12860 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12861
12862 Other remote targets may be available in your
12863 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12864
12865 @menu
12866 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12867 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
12868 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12869 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12870 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12871 @end menu
12872
12873 @node Connecting
12874 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12875
12876 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12877 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12878 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12879 program as the first argument.
12880
12881 @cindex @code{target remote}
12882 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12883 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12884 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12885 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12886 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12887 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12888
12889 @table @code
12890
12891 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12892 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12893 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12894 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12895
12896 @smallexample
12897 target remote /dev/ttyb
12898 @end smallexample
12899
12900 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12901 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12902 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12903 @code{target} command.
12904
12905 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12906 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12907 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12908 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12909 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12910 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12911 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12912 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12913 target.
12914
12915 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12916 @code{manyfarms}:
12917
12918 @smallexample
12919 target remote manyfarms:2828
12920 @end smallexample
12921
12922 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12923 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12924 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12925 port 1234 on your local machine:
12926
12927 @smallexample
12928 target remote :1234
12929 @end smallexample
12930 @noindent
12931
12932 Note that the colon is still required here.
12933
12934 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12935 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12936 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12937 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12938
12939 @smallexample
12940 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12941 @end smallexample
12942
12943 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12944 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12945 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12946 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12947
12948 @item target remote | @var{command}
12949 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12950 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12951 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12952 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12953 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12954 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12955 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12956 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12957
12958 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12959 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12960 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12961
12962 @end table
12963
12964 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12965 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
12966 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
12967 need to use @kbd{run}.
12968
12969 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12970 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12971 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12972 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12973 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12974 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12975 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12976
12977 @smallexample
12978 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12979 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12980 @end smallexample
12981
12982 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12983 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12984 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12985 goes back to waiting.
12986
12987 @table @code
12988 @kindex detach (remote)
12989 @item detach
12990 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12991 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12992 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12993 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12994 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12995
12996 @kindex disconnect
12997 @item disconnect
12998 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12999 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
13000 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
13001 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
13002 another target.
13003
13004 @cindex send command to remote monitor
13005 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
13006 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
13007 @kindex monitor
13008 @item monitor @var{cmd}
13009 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
13010 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
13011 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
13012 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
13013 and implement.
13014 @end table
13015
13016 @node File Transfer
13017 @section Sending files to a remote system
13018 @cindex remote target, file transfer
13019 @cindex file transfer
13020 @cindex sending files to remote systems
13021
13022 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
13023 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13024 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13025 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13026 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13027 the only way to upload or download files.
13028
13029 Not all remote targets support these commands.
13030
13031 @table @code
13032 @kindex remote put
13033 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13034 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13035 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13036
13037 @kindex remote get
13038 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13039 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13040 on the host system.
13041
13042 @kindex remote delete
13043 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13044 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13045
13046 @end table
13047
13048 @node Server
13049 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13050
13051 @kindex gdbserver
13052 @cindex remote connection without stubs
13053 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13054 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13055 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13056
13057 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13058 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
13059 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
13060 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
13061 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
13062 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
13063 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
13064 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
13065 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
13066 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
13067 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
13068 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
13069 choice for debugging.
13070
13071 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13072 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13073 protocol.
13074
13075 @quotation
13076 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13077 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13078 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13079 target system with the same privileges as the user running
13080 @code{gdbserver}.
13081 @end quotation
13082
13083 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13084 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13085
13086 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13087 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13088 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13089 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13090 system does all the symbol handling.
13091
13092 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13093 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13094 syntax is:
13095
13096 @smallexample
13097 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13098 @end smallexample
13099
13100 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13101 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13102 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13103 @file{/dev/com1}:
13104
13105 @smallexample
13106 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13107 @end smallexample
13108
13109 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13110 with it.
13111
13112 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13113
13114 @smallexample
13115 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13116 @end smallexample
13117
13118 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13119 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13120 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13121 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13122 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13123 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13124 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13125 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13126 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13127 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13128 @code{target remote} command.
13129
13130 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13131
13132 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13133 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13134
13135 @smallexample
13136 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13137 @end smallexample
13138
13139 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13140 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13141
13142 @pindex pidof
13143 @cindex attach to a program by name
13144 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13145 @code{pidof} utility:
13146
13147 @smallexample
13148 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13149 @end smallexample
13150
13151 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13152 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13153 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13154
13155 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13156 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13157 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13158
13159 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13160 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13161 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13162 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13163
13164 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13165 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13166 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13167 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13168 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13169 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13170 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13171 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13172 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13173
13174 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13175 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13176 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13177 the program you want to debug.
13178
13179 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13180 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13181 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13182
13183 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13184
13185 You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13186 @code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13187 process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13188 for bug reports to the developers.
13189
13190 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
13191 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
13192 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
13193 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
13194
13195 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
13196 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
13197 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
13198 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
13199
13200 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
13201 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
13202 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
13203 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
13204
13205 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
13206 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
13207 environment:
13208
13209 @smallexample
13210 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
13211 @end smallexample
13212
13213 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13214
13215 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13216
13217 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13218 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13219 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13220 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13221
13222 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13223 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13224 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13225 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13226 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13227 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13228 programs.
13229
13230 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13231 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13232 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13233 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13234 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13235 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13236 already on the target.
13237
13238 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13239 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13240 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13241
13242 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13243 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13244 Here are the available commands.
13245
13246 @table @code
13247 @item monitor help
13248 List the available monitor commands.
13249
13250 @item monitor set debug 0
13251 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13252 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13253
13254 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13255 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13256 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13257 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13258
13259 @item monitor exit
13260 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13261 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13262 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13263 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13264 of a multi-process mode debug session.
13265
13266 @end table
13267
13268 @node Remote Configuration
13269 @section Remote Configuration
13270
13271 @kindex set remote
13272 @kindex show remote
13273 This section documents the configuration options available when
13274 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13275 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13276 system-call-allowed}.
13277
13278 @table @code
13279 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13280 @cindex address size for remote targets
13281 @cindex bits in remote address
13282 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13283 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13284 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13285 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13286
13287 @item show remoteaddresssize
13288 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13289
13290 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13291 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13292 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13293 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13294 remote targets.
13295
13296 @item show remotebaud
13297 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13298
13299 @item set remotebreak
13300 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13301 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13302 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13303 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13304 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13305 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13306 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13307 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13308
13309 @item show remotebreak
13310 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13311 interrupt the remote program.
13312
13313 @item set remoteflow on
13314 @itemx set remoteflow off
13315 @kindex set remoteflow
13316 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13317 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13318
13319 @item show remoteflow
13320 @kindex show remoteflow
13321 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13322
13323 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13324 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13325 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13326 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13327 @code{ascii}.
13328
13329 @item show remotelogbase
13330 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13331 protocol.
13332
13333 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13334 @cindex record serial communications on file
13335 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13336 default is not to record at all.
13337
13338 @item show remotelogfile.
13339 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13340 serial communications.
13341
13342 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13343 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13344 @cindex remote timeout
13345 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13346 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13347
13348 @item show remotetimeout
13349 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13350 responses.
13351
13352 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13353 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13354 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13355 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13356 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13357 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13358 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13359 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13360
13361 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13362 @itemx show remote exec-file
13363 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
13364 @cindex executable file, for remote target
13365 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13366 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13367 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13368 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13369 @end table
13370
13371 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13372 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13373 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13374 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13375 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13376 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13377 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13378 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13379 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13380
13381 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13382 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13383 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13384 @value{GDBN} developers.
13385
13386 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13387 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13388 are:
13389
13390 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13391 @item Command Name
13392 @tab Remote Packet
13393 @tab Related Features
13394
13395 @item @code{fetch-register}
13396 @tab @code{p}
13397 @tab @code{info registers}
13398
13399 @item @code{set-register}
13400 @tab @code{P}
13401 @tab @code{set}
13402
13403 @item @code{binary-download}
13404 @tab @code{X}
13405 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13406
13407 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13408 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13409 @tab @code{info auxv}
13410
13411 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13412 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13413 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13414
13415 @item @code{attach}
13416 @tab @code{vAttach}
13417 @tab @code{attach}
13418
13419 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13420 @tab @code{vCont}
13421 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13422
13423 @item @code{run}
13424 @tab @code{vRun}
13425 @tab @code{run}
13426
13427 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13428 @tab @code{Z0}
13429 @tab @code{break}
13430
13431 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13432 @tab @code{Z1}
13433 @tab @code{hbreak}
13434
13435 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13436 @tab @code{Z2}
13437 @tab @code{watch}
13438
13439 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13440 @tab @code{Z3}
13441 @tab @code{rwatch}
13442
13443 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13444 @tab @code{Z4}
13445 @tab @code{awatch}
13446
13447 @item @code{target-features}
13448 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13449 @tab @code{set architecture}
13450
13451 @item @code{library-info}
13452 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13453 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13454
13455 @item @code{memory-map}
13456 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13457 @tab @code{info mem}
13458
13459 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13460 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13461 @tab @code{info spu}
13462
13463 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13464 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13465 @tab @code{info spu}
13466
13467 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13468 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13469 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13470
13471 @item @code{supported-packets}
13472 @tab @code{qSupported}
13473 @tab Remote communications parameters
13474
13475 @item @code{pass-signals}
13476 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13477 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13478
13479 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13480 @tab @code{vFile:close}
13481 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13482
13483 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13484 @tab @code{vFile:open}
13485 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13486
13487 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13488 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
13489 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13490
13491 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13492 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13493 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13494
13495 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13496 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13497 @tab @code{remote delete}
13498 @end multitable
13499
13500 @node Remote Stub
13501 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13502
13503 @cindex debugging stub, example
13504 @cindex remote stub, example
13505 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13506 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13507 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13508 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13509 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13510 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13511 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13512 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13513
13514 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13515 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13516 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13517 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13518 program, you need:
13519
13520 @enumerate
13521 @item
13522 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13523 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13524 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13525
13526 @item
13527 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13528 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13529
13530 @item
13531 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13532 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13533 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13534 documentation.
13535 @end enumerate
13536
13537 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13538 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13539 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13540
13541 @table @emph
13542 @item On the host,
13543 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13544 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13545 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13546
13547 @item On the target,
13548 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13549 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13550 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13551
13552 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13553 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13554 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13555 @end table
13556
13557 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13558 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13559 @sc{sparc} boards.
13560
13561 @cindex remote serial stub list
13562 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13563
13564 @table @code
13565
13566 @item i386-stub.c
13567 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13568 @cindex Intel
13569 @cindex i386
13570 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13571
13572 @item m68k-stub.c
13573 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13574 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13575 @cindex m680x0
13576 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13577
13578 @item sh-stub.c
13579 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13580 @cindex Renesas
13581 @cindex SH
13582 For Renesas SH architectures.
13583
13584 @item sparc-stub.c
13585 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13586 @cindex Sparc
13587 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13588
13589 @item sparcl-stub.c
13590 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13591 @cindex Fujitsu
13592 @cindex SparcLite
13593 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13594
13595 @end table
13596
13597 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13598 recently added stubs.
13599
13600 @menu
13601 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13602 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13603 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13604 @end menu
13605
13606 @node Stub Contents
13607 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13608
13609 @cindex remote serial stub
13610 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13611 subroutines:
13612
13613 @table @code
13614 @item set_debug_traps
13615 @findex set_debug_traps
13616 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13617 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13618 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13619 beginning of your program.
13620
13621 @item handle_exception
13622 @findex handle_exception
13623 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13624 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13625 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13626 run when a trap is triggered.
13627
13628 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13629 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13630 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13631 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13632 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13633 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13634 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13635 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13636 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13637 machine.
13638
13639 @item breakpoint
13640 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13641 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13642 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13643 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13644 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13645 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13646 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13647 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13648 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13649 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13650 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13651
13652 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13653 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13654 start of your debugging session.
13655 @end table
13656
13657 @node Bootstrapping
13658 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13659
13660 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13661 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13662 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13663 debugging target machine.
13664
13665 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13666 serial port.
13667
13668 @table @code
13669 @item int getDebugChar()
13670 @findex getDebugChar
13671 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13672 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13673 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13674
13675 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13676 @findex putDebugChar
13677 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13678 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13679 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13680 @end table
13681
13682 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13683 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13684 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13685 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13686 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13687 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13688 remote system to stop.
13689
13690 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13691 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13692 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13693 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13694
13695 Other routines you need to supply are:
13696
13697 @table @code
13698 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13699 @findex exceptionHandler
13700 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13701 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13702 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13703 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13704 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13705 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13706 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13707 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13708 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13709 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13710 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13711 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13712 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13713
13714 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13715 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13716 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13717 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13718 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13719
13720 @item void flush_i_cache()
13721 @findex flush_i_cache
13722 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13723 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13724 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13725
13726 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13727 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13728 @end table
13729
13730 @noindent
13731 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13732
13733 @table @code
13734 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13735 @findex memset
13736 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13737 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13738 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13739 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13740 @end table
13741
13742 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13743 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13744 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13745 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13746
13747
13748 @node Debug Session
13749 @subsection Putting it All Together
13750
13751 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13752 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13753 steps.
13754
13755 @enumerate
13756 @item
13757 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13758 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13759 @display
13760 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13761 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13762 @end display
13763
13764 @item
13765 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13766
13767 @smallexample
13768 set_debug_traps();
13769 breakpoint();
13770 @end smallexample
13771
13772 @item
13773 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13774 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13775
13776 @smallexample
13777 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13778 @end smallexample
13779
13780 @noindent
13781 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13782 function in your program, that function is called when
13783 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13784 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13785 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13786
13787 @item
13788 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13789 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13790
13791 @item
13792 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13793 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13794
13795 @item
13796 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13797 @c document that. FIXME.
13798 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13799 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13800
13801 @item
13802 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13803 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13804
13805 @end enumerate
13806
13807 @node Configurations
13808 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13809
13810 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13811 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13812 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13813
13814 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13815 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13816 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13817 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13818 are quite different from each other.
13819
13820 @menu
13821 * Native::
13822 * Embedded OS::
13823 * Embedded Processors::
13824 * Architectures::
13825 @end menu
13826
13827 @node Native
13828 @section Native
13829
13830 This section describes details specific to particular native
13831 configurations.
13832
13833 @menu
13834 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13835 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13836 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13837 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13838 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13839 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13840 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13841 @end menu
13842
13843 @node HP-UX
13844 @subsection HP-UX
13845
13846 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13847 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13848 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13849
13850
13851 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13852 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13853
13854 @cindex libkvm
13855 @cindex kernel memory image
13856 @cindex kernel crash dump
13857
13858 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13859 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13860 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13861 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13862 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13863 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13864 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13865 @code{kvm} target:
13866
13867 @smallexample
13868 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13869 @end smallexample
13870
13871 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13872 argument:
13873
13874 @smallexample
13875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13876 @end smallexample
13877
13878 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13879 available:
13880
13881 @table @code
13882 @kindex kvm
13883 @item kvm pcb
13884 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13885
13886 @item kvm proc
13887 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13888 modern FreeBSD systems.
13889 @end table
13890
13891 @node SVR4 Process Information
13892 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13893 @cindex /proc
13894 @cindex examine process image
13895 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13896
13897 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13898 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13899 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13900 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13901 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13902 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13903 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13904 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13905 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13906
13907 @table @code
13908 @kindex info proc
13909 @cindex process ID
13910 @item info proc
13911 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13912 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13913 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13914 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13915 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13916 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13917 executable file's absolute file name.
13918
13919 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13920 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13921 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13922 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13923 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13924 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13925
13926 @item info proc mappings
13927 @cindex memory address space mappings
13928 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13929 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13930 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13931 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13932 memory access rights to that range.
13933
13934 @item info proc stat
13935 @itemx info proc status
13936 @cindex process detailed status information
13937 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13938 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13939 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13940 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13941 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13942 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13943 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13944
13945 @item info proc all
13946 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13947 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13948
13949 @ignore
13950 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13951 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13952 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13953 @kindex info proc times
13954 @item info proc times
13955 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13956 its children.
13957
13958 @kindex info proc id
13959 @item info proc id
13960 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13961 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13962 @end ignore
13963
13964 @item set procfs-trace
13965 @kindex set procfs-trace
13966 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13967 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13968
13969 @item show procfs-trace
13970 @kindex show procfs-trace
13971 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13972
13973 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13974 @kindex set procfs-file
13975 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13976 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13977 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13978 standard output.
13979
13980 @item show procfs-file
13981 @kindex show procfs-file
13982 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13983
13984 @item proc-trace-entry
13985 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13986 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13987 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13988 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13989 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13990 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13991 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13992 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13993 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13994
13995 @item info pidlist
13996 @kindex info pidlist
13997 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13998 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13999 processes and all the threads within each process.
14000
14001 @item info meminfo
14002 @kindex info meminfo
14003 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
14004 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
14005 @end table
14006
14007 @node DJGPP Native
14008 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
14009 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
14010 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
14011 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
14012
14013 @cindex DPMI
14014 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
14015 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
14016 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
14017 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
14018
14019 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
14020 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
14021 subsection describes those commands.
14022
14023 @table @code
14024 @kindex info dos
14025 @item info dos
14026 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
14027 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14028
14029 @kindex sysinfo
14030 @cindex MS-DOS system info
14031 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
14032 @item info dos sysinfo
14033 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
14034 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
14035 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
14036
14037 @cindex GDT
14038 @cindex LDT
14039 @cindex IDT
14040 @cindex segment descriptor tables
14041 @cindex descriptor tables display
14042 @item info dos gdt
14043 @itemx info dos ldt
14044 @itemx info dos idt
14045 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
14046 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
14047 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
14048 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
14049 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
14050 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
14051 rights.
14052
14053 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
14054 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
14055 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
14056 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
14057 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
14058
14059 @cindex garbled pointers
14060 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
14061 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
14062 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
14063 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
14064 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
14065 debugged program's data segment:
14066
14067 @smallexample
14068 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
14069 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
14070 @end smallexample
14071
14072 @noindent
14073 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14074 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14075
14076 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14077 @item info dos pde
14078 @itemx info dos pte
14079 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14080 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14081 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14082 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14083 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14084 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14085 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14086 that is currently in use.
14087
14088 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14089 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14090 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14091 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14092 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14093 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14094 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14095
14096 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14097 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14098 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14099 controller.
14100
14101 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14102
14103 @cindex physical address from linear address
14104 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14105 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14106 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14107 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14108 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14109 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14110 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14111
14112 @smallexample
14113 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14114 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14115 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14116 @end smallexample
14117
14118 @noindent
14119 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14120 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14121 attributes of that page.
14122
14123 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14124 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14125 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14126 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14127 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14128 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14129
14130 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14131 transfer buffer:
14132
14133 @smallexample
14134 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14135 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14136 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14137 @end smallexample
14138
14139 @noindent
14140 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
14141 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14142 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14143 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14144 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14145
14146 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14147 @end table
14148
14149 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14150 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14151 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14152 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14153
14154 @table @code
14155 @kindex set com1base
14156 @kindex set com1irq
14157 @kindex set com2base
14158 @kindex set com2irq
14159 @kindex set com3base
14160 @kindex set com3irq
14161 @kindex set com4base
14162 @kindex set com4irq
14163 @item set com1base @var{addr}
14164 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14165 port.
14166
14167 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
14168 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14169 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14170
14171 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14172 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14173 other 3 COM ports.
14174
14175 @kindex show com1base
14176 @kindex show com1irq
14177 @kindex show com2base
14178 @kindex show com2irq
14179 @kindex show com3base
14180 @kindex show com3irq
14181 @kindex show com4base
14182 @kindex show com4irq
14183 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14184 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14185 lines used by the COM ports.
14186
14187 @item info serial
14188 @kindex info serial
14189 @cindex DOS serial port status
14190 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14191 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14192 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14193 counts of various errors encountered so far.
14194 @end table
14195
14196
14197 @node Cygwin Native
14198 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14199 @cindex MS Windows debugging
14200 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
14201 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14202
14203 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14204 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14205 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14206 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14207 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14208
14209 @table @code
14210 @kindex info w32
14211 @item info w32
14212 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14213 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14214
14215 @item info w32 selector
14216 This command displays information returned by
14217 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14218 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14219 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14220 Without argument, this command displays information
14221 about the six segment registers.
14222
14223 @kindex info dll
14224 @item info dll
14225 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14226
14227 @kindex dll-symbols
14228 @item dll-symbols
14229 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14230 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14231
14232 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14233 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14234 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14235 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14236 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14237 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14238 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14239 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14240 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14241 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14242 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14243
14244 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14245 @item show cygwin-exceptions
14246 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14247 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14248
14249 @kindex set new-console
14250 @item set new-console @var{mode}
14251 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14252 be started in a new console on next start.
14253 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14254 be started in the same console as the debugger.
14255
14256 @kindex show new-console
14257 @item show new-console
14258 Displays whether a new console is used
14259 when the debuggee is started.
14260
14261 @kindex set new-group
14262 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14263 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14264 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14265 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14266 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14267
14268 @kindex show new-group
14269 @item show new-group
14270 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14271
14272 @kindex set debugevents
14273 @item set debugevents
14274 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14275 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14276 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14277 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14278 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14279
14280 @kindex set debugexec
14281 @item set debugexec
14282 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14283 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14284
14285 @kindex set debugexceptions
14286 @item set debugexceptions
14287 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14288 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14289
14290 @kindex set debugmemory
14291 @item set debugmemory
14292 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14293 and writes by the debugger.
14294
14295 @kindex set shell
14296 @item set shell
14297 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14298 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14299
14300 @kindex show shell
14301 @item show shell
14302 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14303
14304 @end table
14305
14306 @menu
14307 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14308 @end menu
14309
14310 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14311 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14312 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14313 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14314
14315 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14316 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14317 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14318 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14319 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14320 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14321 ``minimal symbols''.
14322
14323 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14324 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14325 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14326 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14327 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14328 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14329 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14330 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14331 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14332 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14333
14334 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14335
14336 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14337 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14338 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14339 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14340 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14341 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14342 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14343 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14344 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14345
14346 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14347 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14348 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14349 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14350 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14351 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14352
14353 @smallexample
14354 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14355 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14356
14357 Non-debugging symbols:
14358 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14359 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14360 @end smallexample
14361
14362 @smallexample
14363 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14364 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14365
14366 Non-debugging symbols:
14367 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14368 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14369 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14370 [etc...]
14371 @end smallexample
14372
14373 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14374
14375 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14376 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14377 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14378 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14379 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14380 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14381 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14382
14383 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14384 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14385 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14386 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14387 problem:
14388
14389 @smallexample
14390 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14391 $1 = 268572168
14392 @end smallexample
14393
14394 @smallexample
14395 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14396 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14397 @end smallexample
14398
14399 And two possible solutions:
14400
14401 @smallexample
14402 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14403 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14404 @end smallexample
14405
14406 @smallexample
14407 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14408 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14409 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14410 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14411 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14412 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14413 @end smallexample
14414
14415 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14416 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14417 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14418 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14419 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14420
14421 @smallexample
14422 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14423 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14424 @end smallexample
14425
14426 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14427 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14428 safe.
14429
14430 @node Hurd Native
14431 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14432 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14433
14434 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14435 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14436
14437 @table @code
14438 @item set signals
14439 @itemx set sigs
14440 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14441 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14442 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14443 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14444 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14445 @code{signals}.
14446
14447 @item show signals
14448 @itemx show sigs
14449 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14450 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14451 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14452
14453 @item set signal-thread
14454 @itemx set sigthread
14455 @kindex set signal-thread
14456 @kindex set sigthread
14457 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14458 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14459 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14460 signal-thread}.
14461
14462 @item show signal-thread
14463 @itemx show sigthread
14464 @kindex show signal-thread
14465 @kindex show sigthread
14466 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14467 delivered a signal.
14468
14469 @item set stopped
14470 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14471 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14472 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14473 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14474
14475 @item show stopped
14476 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14477 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14478 stopped.
14479
14480 @item set exceptions
14481 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14482 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14483 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14484 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14485 trapping on.
14486
14487 @item show exceptions
14488 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14489 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14490
14491 @item set task pause
14492 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14493 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14494 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14495 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14496 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14497 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14498 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14499 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14500 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14501
14502 @item show task pause
14503 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14504 Show the current state of task suspension.
14505
14506 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14507 @cindex task suspend count
14508 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14509 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14510 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14511
14512 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14513 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14514
14515 @item set task exception-port
14516 @itemx set task excp
14517 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14518 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14519 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14520 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14521
14522 @item set noninvasive
14523 @cindex noninvasive task options
14524 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14525 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14526 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14527 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14528
14529 @item info send-rights
14530 @itemx info receive-rights
14531 @itemx info port-rights
14532 @itemx info port-sets
14533 @itemx info dead-names
14534 @itemx info ports
14535 @itemx info psets
14536 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14537 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14538 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14539 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14540 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14541 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14542 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14543 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14544 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14545
14546 @item set thread pause
14547 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14548 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14549 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14550 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14551 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14552 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14553 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14554 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14555 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14556 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14557 only the current thread.
14558
14559 @item show thread pause
14560 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14561 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14562
14563 @item set thread run
14564 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14565
14566 @item show thread run
14567 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14568
14569 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14570 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14571 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14572 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14573 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14574 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14575 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14576
14577 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14578 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14579 detaching.
14580
14581 @item set thread exception-port
14582 @itemx set thread excp
14583 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14584 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14585 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14586
14587 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14588 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14589 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14590 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14591
14592 @item set thread default
14593 @itemx show thread default
14594 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14595 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14596 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14597 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14598 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14599 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14600 the non-default commands.
14601 @end table
14602
14603
14604 @node Neutrino
14605 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14606 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14607
14608 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14609 Neutrino target:
14610
14611 @table @code
14612 @item set debug nto-debug
14613 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14614 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14615 Neutrino support.
14616
14617 @item show debug nto-debug
14618 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14619 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14620 @end table
14621
14622
14623 @node Embedded OS
14624 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14625
14626 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14627 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14628 architectures.
14629
14630 @menu
14631 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14632 @end menu
14633
14634 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14635 various real-time operating systems.
14636
14637 @node VxWorks
14638 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14639
14640 @cindex VxWorks
14641
14642 @table @code
14643
14644 @kindex target vxworks
14645 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14646 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14647 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14648
14649 @end table
14650
14651 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14652 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14653
14654 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14655 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14656 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14657 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14658 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14659 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14660 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14661
14662 @table @code
14663 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14664 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14665 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14666 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14667 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14668 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14669 of a thin network line.
14670 @end table
14671
14672 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14673 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14674 procedures.
14675
14676 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14677 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14678 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14679 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14680 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14681 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14682 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14683 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14684 manual.
14685 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14686
14687 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14688 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14689 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14690 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14691
14692 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14693
14694 @smallexample
14695 (vxgdb)
14696 @end smallexample
14697
14698 @menu
14699 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14700 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14701 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14702 @end menu
14703
14704 @node VxWorks Connection
14705 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14706
14707 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14708 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14709
14710 @smallexample
14711 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14712 @end smallexample
14713
14714 @need 750
14715 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14716
14717 @smallexample
14718 Attaching remote machine across net...
14719 Connected to tt.
14720 @end smallexample
14721
14722 @need 1000
14723 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14724 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14725 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14726 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14727 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14728
14729 @smallexample
14730 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14731 @end smallexample
14732
14733 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14734 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14735 command again.
14736
14737 @node VxWorks Download
14738 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14739
14740 @cindex download to VxWorks
14741 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14742 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14743 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14744 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14745 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14746 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14747 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14748 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14749 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14750 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14751 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14752 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14753 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14754 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14755 program, type this on VxWorks:
14756
14757 @smallexample
14758 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14759 @end smallexample
14760
14761 @noindent
14762 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14763
14764 @smallexample
14765 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14766 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14767 @end smallexample
14768
14769 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14770
14771 @smallexample
14772 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14773 @end smallexample
14774
14775 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14776 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14777 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14778 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14779 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14780 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14781 table.)
14782
14783 @node VxWorks Attach
14784 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14785
14786 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14787 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14788 follows:
14789
14790 @smallexample
14791 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14792 @end smallexample
14793
14794 @noindent
14795 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14796 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14797 the time of attachment.
14798
14799 @node Embedded Processors
14800 @section Embedded Processors
14801
14802 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14803 configurations.
14804
14805 @cindex send command to simulator
14806 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14807 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14808
14809 @table @code
14810 @item sim @var{command}
14811 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14812 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14813 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14814 acceptable commands.
14815 @end table
14816
14817
14818 @menu
14819 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14820 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14821 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14822 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14823 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14824 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14825 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
14826 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14827 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14828 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14829 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14830 * CRIS:: CRIS
14831 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14832 @end menu
14833
14834 @node ARM
14835 @subsection ARM
14836 @cindex ARM RDI
14837
14838 @table @code
14839 @kindex target rdi
14840 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14841 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14842 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14843 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14844
14845 @kindex target rdp
14846 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14847 ARM Demon monitor.
14848
14849 @end table
14850
14851 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14852
14853 @table @code
14854 @item set arm disassembler
14855 @kindex set arm
14856 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14857 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14858
14859 @item show arm disassembler
14860 @kindex show arm
14861 Show the current disassembly style.
14862
14863 @item set arm apcs32
14864 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14865 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14866
14867 @item show arm apcs32
14868 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14869
14870 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14871 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14872 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14873
14874 @table @code
14875 @item auto
14876 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14877 @item softfpa
14878 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14879 processors.
14880 @item fpa
14881 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14882 @item softvfp
14883 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14884 @item vfp
14885 VFP co-processor.
14886 @end table
14887
14888 @item show arm fpu
14889 Show the current type of the FPU.
14890
14891 @item set arm abi
14892 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14893
14894 @item show arm abi
14895 Show the currently used ABI.
14896
14897 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
14898 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
14899 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
14900 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
14901 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
14902 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
14903 register).
14904
14905 @item show arm fallback-mode
14906 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
14907
14908 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
14909 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
14910 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
14911 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
14912 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
14913
14914 @item show arm force-mode
14915 Show the current forced instruction mode.
14916
14917 @item set debug arm
14918 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14919 target support subsystem.
14920
14921 @item show debug arm
14922 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14923 @end table
14924
14925 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14926 using the RDI interface:
14927
14928 @table @code
14929 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14930 @kindex rdilogfile
14931 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14932 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14933 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14934 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14935 @file{rdi.log}.
14936
14937 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14938 @kindex rdilogenable
14939 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14940 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14941 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14942 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14943 are logged to a file.
14944
14945 @item set rdiromatzero
14946 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14947 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14948 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14949 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14950 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14951 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14952
14953 @item show rdiromatzero
14954 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14955 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14956
14957 @item set rdiheartbeat
14958 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14959 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14960 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14961 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14962 well as the Angel monitor.
14963
14964 @item show rdiheartbeat
14965 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14966 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14967 @end table
14968
14969
14970 @node M32R/D
14971 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14972
14973 @table @code
14974 @kindex target m32r
14975 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14976 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14977
14978 @kindex target m32rsdi
14979 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14980 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14981 @end table
14982
14983 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14984
14985 @table @code
14986 @item set download-path @var{path}
14987 @kindex set download-path
14988 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14989 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14990
14991 @item show download-path
14992 @kindex show download-path
14993 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14994
14995 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14996 @kindex set board-address
14997 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14998 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14999
15000 @item show board-address
15001 @kindex show board-address
15002 Show the current IP address of the target board.
15003
15004 @item set server-address @var{addr}
15005 @kindex set server-address
15006 @cindex download server address (M32R)
15007 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
15008 host machine.
15009
15010 @item show server-address
15011 @kindex show server-address
15012 Display the IP address of the download server.
15013
15014 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15015 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
15016 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
15017 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
15018 executable file is uploaded.
15019
15020 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15021 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
15022 Test the @code{upload} command.
15023 @end table
15024
15025 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
15026
15027 @table @code
15028 @item sdireset
15029 @kindex sdireset
15030 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
15031 This command resets the SDI connection.
15032
15033 @item sdistatus
15034 @kindex sdistatus
15035 This command shows the SDI connection status.
15036
15037 @item debug_chaos
15038 @kindex debug_chaos
15039 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
15040 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
15041
15042 @item use_debug_dma
15043 @kindex use_debug_dma
15044 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
15045
15046 @item use_mon_code
15047 @kindex use_mon_code
15048 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
15049
15050 @item use_ib_break
15051 @kindex use_ib_break
15052 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
15053
15054 @item use_dbt_break
15055 @kindex use_dbt_break
15056 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
15057 @end table
15058
15059 @node M68K
15060 @subsection M68k
15061
15062 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
15063 target command for the following ROM monitor.
15064
15065 @table @code
15066
15067 @kindex target dbug
15068 @item target dbug @var{dev}
15069 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
15070
15071 @end table
15072
15073 @node MIPS Embedded
15074 @subsection MIPS Embedded
15075
15076 @cindex MIPS boards
15077 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
15078 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
15079 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
15080
15081 @need 1000
15082 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
15083
15084 @table @code
15085 @item target mips @var{port}
15086 @kindex target mips @var{port}
15087 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
15088 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
15089 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
15090 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
15091 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15092 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15093
15094 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15095 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15096 debugger:
15097
15098 @smallexample
15099 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15100 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15101 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
15102 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
15103 (@value{GDBP}) run
15104 @end smallexample
15105
15106 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
15107 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
15108 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
15109 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
15110 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15111
15112 @item target pmon @var{port}
15113 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
15114 PMON ROM monitor.
15115
15116 @item target ddb @var{port}
15117 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
15118 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
15119
15120 @item target lsi @var{port}
15121 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
15122 LSI variant of PMON.
15123
15124 @kindex target r3900
15125 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
15126 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
15127
15128 @kindex target array
15129 @item target array @var{dev}
15130 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
15131
15132 @end table
15133
15134
15135 @noindent
15136 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
15137
15138 @table @code
15139 @item set mipsfpu double
15140 @itemx set mipsfpu single
15141 @itemx set mipsfpu none
15142 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
15143 @itemx show mipsfpu
15144 @kindex set mipsfpu
15145 @kindex show mipsfpu
15146 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
15147 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
15148 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
15149 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
15150 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
15151 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
15152 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
15153 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
15154 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
15155 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
15156 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
15157 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
15158 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
15159
15160 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
15161 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
15162 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15163
15164 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15165 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
15166
15167 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
15168 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15169 @itemx show timeout
15170 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
15171 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15172 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15173 @kindex set timeout
15174 @kindex show timeout
15175 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
15176 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
15177 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15178 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15179 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15180 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
15181 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15182 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15183 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15184 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15185
15186 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15187 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15188 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15189 to run before stopping.
15190
15191 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15192 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15193 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15194 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15195 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15196 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15197
15198 @item show syn-garbage-limit
15199 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15200 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15201 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15202
15203 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15204 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15205 @cindex remote monitor prompt
15206 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15207 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15208 @table @asis
15209 @item pmon target
15210 @samp{PMON}
15211 @item ddb target
15212 @samp{NEC010}
15213 @item lsi target
15214 @samp{PMON>}
15215 @end table
15216
15217 @item show monitor-prompt
15218 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15219 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15220 remote monitor.
15221
15222 @item set monitor-warnings
15223 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15224 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15225 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15226 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15227 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15228
15229 @item show monitor-warnings
15230 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15231 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15232
15233 @item pmon @var{command}
15234 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15235 @cindex send PMON command
15236 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15237 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15238 @end table
15239
15240 @node OpenRISC 1000
15241 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
15242 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
15243
15244 @cindex or1k boards
15245 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15246 about platform and commands.
15247
15248 @table @code
15249
15250 @kindex target jtag
15251 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15252
15253 Connects to remote JTAG server.
15254 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15255 connected via parallel port to the board.
15256
15257 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15258
15259 @kindex or1ksim
15260 @item or1ksim @var{command}
15261 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15262 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15263
15264 @kindex info or1k spr
15265 @item info or1k spr
15266 Displays spr groups.
15267
15268 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15269 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15270 Displays register names in selected group.
15271
15272 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15273 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15274 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15275 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15276 Shows information about specified spr register.
15277
15278 @kindex spr
15279 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15280 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15281 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15282 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15283 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15284 @end table
15285
15286 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15287 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15288 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15289 triggers can be set using:
15290 @table @code
15291 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15292 Load effective address/data
15293 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15294 Store effective address/data
15295 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15296 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15297 @item $FETCH
15298 Fetch data
15299 @end table
15300
15301 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15302 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15303
15304 @code{htrace} commands:
15305 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15306 @table @code
15307 @kindex hwatch
15308 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15309 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15310 or Data. For example:
15311
15312 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15313
15314 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15315
15316 @kindex htrace
15317 @item htrace info
15318 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15319
15320 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15321 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15322
15323 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15324 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15325
15326 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15327 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15328
15329 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15330 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15331 triggered.
15332
15333 @item htrace enable
15334 @itemx htrace disable
15335 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15336
15337 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15338 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15339
15340 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15341 will be written there.
15342
15343 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15344 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15345
15346 @item htrace mode continuous
15347 Set continuous trace mode.
15348
15349 @item htrace mode suspend
15350 Set suspend trace mode.
15351
15352 @end table
15353
15354 @node PowerPC Embedded
15355 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
15356
15357 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15358
15359 @table @code
15360 @kindex set powerpc
15361 @item set powerpc soft-float
15362 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15363 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15364 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15365 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15366
15367 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15368 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15369 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15370 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15371 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15372 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15373 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15374 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15375
15376 @kindex target dink32
15377 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15378 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15379
15380 @kindex target ppcbug
15381 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15382 @kindex target ppcbug1
15383 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15384 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15385
15386 @kindex target sds
15387 @item target sds @var{dev}
15388 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15389 @end table
15390
15391 @cindex SDS protocol
15392 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15393 by @value{GDBN}:
15394
15395 @table @code
15396 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15397 @kindex set sdstimeout
15398 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15399 default is 2 seconds.
15400
15401 @item show sdstimeout
15402 @kindex show sdstimeout
15403 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15404
15405 @item sds @var{command}
15406 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15407 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15408 @end table
15409
15410
15411 @node PA
15412 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15413
15414 @table @code
15415
15416 @kindex target op50n
15417 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15418 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15419
15420 @kindex target w89k
15421 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15422 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15423
15424 @end table
15425
15426 @node Sparclet
15427 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15428
15429 @cindex Sparclet
15430
15431 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15432 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15433 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15434 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15435 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15436
15437 @table @code
15438 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15439 @kindex remotetimeout
15440 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15441 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15442 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15443 @end table
15444
15445 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15446 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15447 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15448 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15449 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15450
15451 @smallexample
15452 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15453 @end smallexample
15454
15455 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15456
15457 @smallexample
15458 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15459 @end smallexample
15460
15461 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15462 Once you have set
15463 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15464 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15465 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15466
15467 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15468
15469 @smallexample
15470 (gdbslet)
15471 @end smallexample
15472
15473 @menu
15474 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15475 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15476 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15477 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15478 @end menu
15479
15480 @node Sparclet File
15481 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15482
15483 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15484
15485 @smallexample
15486 (gdbslet) file prog
15487 @end smallexample
15488
15489 @need 1000
15490 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15491 @value{GDBN} locates
15492 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15493 path.
15494 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15495 files will be searched as well.
15496 @value{GDBN} locates
15497 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15498 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15499 If it fails
15500 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15501
15502 @smallexample
15503 prog: No such file or directory.
15504 @end smallexample
15505
15506 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15507 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15508 @code{target} command again.
15509
15510 @node Sparclet Connection
15511 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15512
15513 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15514 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15515
15516 @smallexample
15517 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15518 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15519 main () at ../prog.c:3
15520 @end smallexample
15521
15522 @need 750
15523 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15524
15525 @smallexample
15526 Connected to ttya.
15527 @end smallexample
15528
15529 @node Sparclet Download
15530 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15531
15532 @cindex download to Sparclet
15533 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15534 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15535 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15536 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15537 command.
15538 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15539 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15540 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15541 of each of the file's sections.
15542 For instance, if the program
15543 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15544 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15545
15546 @smallexample
15547 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15548 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15549 @end smallexample
15550
15551 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15552 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15553 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15554
15555 @node Sparclet Execution
15556 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15557
15558 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15559 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15560 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15561 manual for the list of commands.
15562
15563 @smallexample
15564 (gdbslet) b main
15565 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15566 (gdbslet) run
15567 Starting program: prog
15568 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15569 3 char *symarg = 0;
15570 (gdbslet) step
15571 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15572 (gdbslet)
15573 @end smallexample
15574
15575 @node Sparclite
15576 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15577
15578 @table @code
15579
15580 @kindex target sparclite
15581 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15582 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15583 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15584 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15585 remote protocol.
15586
15587 @end table
15588
15589 @node Z8000
15590 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15591
15592 @cindex Z8000
15593 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15594 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15595
15596 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15597 a Z8000 simulator.
15598
15599 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15600 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15601 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15602 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15603
15604 @table @code
15605 @item target sim @var{args}
15606 @kindex sim
15607 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15608 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15609 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15610 @end table
15611
15612 @noindent
15613 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15614 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15615 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15616 to run your program, and so on.
15617
15618 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15619 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15620 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15621
15622 @table @code
15623
15624 @item cycles
15625 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15626
15627 @item insts
15628 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15629
15630 @item time
15631 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15632
15633 @end table
15634
15635 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15636 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15637 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15638 simulated clock ticks.
15639
15640 @node AVR
15641 @subsection Atmel AVR
15642 @cindex AVR
15643
15644 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15645 following AVR-specific commands:
15646
15647 @table @code
15648 @item info io_registers
15649 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15650 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15651 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15652 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15653 @end table
15654
15655 @node CRIS
15656 @subsection CRIS
15657 @cindex CRIS
15658
15659 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15660 following CRIS-specific commands:
15661
15662 @table @code
15663 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15664 @cindex CRIS version
15665 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15666 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15667 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15668
15669 @item show cris-version
15670 Show the current CRIS version.
15671
15672 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15673 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15674 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15675 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15676 @code{R59}.
15677
15678 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15679 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15680
15681 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15682 @cindex CRIS mode
15683 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15684 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15685 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15686
15687 @item show cris-mode
15688 Show the current CRIS mode.
15689 @end table
15690
15691 @node Super-H
15692 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15693 @cindex Super-H
15694
15695 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15696 commands:
15697
15698 @table @code
15699 @item regs
15700 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15701 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15702
15703 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
15704 @kindex set sh calling-convention
15705 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
15706 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
15707 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
15708 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
15709 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
15710 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
15711 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
15712 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
15713 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
15714 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
15715
15716 @item show sh calling-convention
15717 @kindex show sh calling-convention
15718 Show the current calling convention setting.
15719
15720 @end table
15721
15722
15723 @node Architectures
15724 @section Architectures
15725
15726 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15727 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15728
15729 @menu
15730 * i386::
15731 * A29K::
15732 * Alpha::
15733 * MIPS::
15734 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15735 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15736 * PowerPC::
15737 @end menu
15738
15739 @node i386
15740 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15741
15742 @table @code
15743 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15744 @kindex set struct-convention
15745 @cindex struct return convention
15746 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15747 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15748 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15749 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15750 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15751 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15752 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15753 be returned in a register.
15754
15755 @item show struct-convention
15756 @kindex show struct-convention
15757 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15758 from functions.
15759 @end table
15760
15761 @node A29K
15762 @subsection A29K
15763
15764 @table @code
15765
15766 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15767 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15768 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15769 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15770 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15771 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15772 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15773 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15774 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15775 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15776 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15777 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15778 hexadecimal.
15779
15780 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15781 @item show rstack_high_address
15782 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15783 processors.
15784
15785 @end table
15786
15787 @node Alpha
15788 @subsection Alpha
15789
15790 See the following section.
15791
15792 @node MIPS
15793 @subsection MIPS
15794
15795 @cindex stack on Alpha
15796 @cindex stack on MIPS
15797 @cindex Alpha stack
15798 @cindex MIPS stack
15799 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15800 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15801 find the beginning of a function.
15802
15803 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15804 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15805 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15806 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15807 commands:
15808
15809 @table @code
15810 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15811 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15812 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15813 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15814 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15815 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15816 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15817 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15818
15819 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15820 Display the current limit.
15821 @end table
15822
15823 @noindent
15824 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15825 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15826
15827 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15828 programs:
15829
15830 @table @code
15831 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15832 @kindex set mips abi
15833 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15834 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15835 values of @var{arg} are:
15836
15837 @table @samp
15838 @item auto
15839 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15840 default).
15841 @item o32
15842 @item o64
15843 @item n32
15844 @item n64
15845 @item eabi32
15846 @item eabi64
15847 @item auto
15848 @end table
15849
15850 @item show mips abi
15851 @kindex show mips abi
15852 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15853
15854 @item set mipsfpu
15855 @itemx show mipsfpu
15856 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15857
15858 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15859 @kindex set mips mask-address
15860 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15861 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15862 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15863 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15864 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15865
15866 @item show mips mask-address
15867 @kindex show mips mask-address
15868 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15869 not.
15870
15871 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15872 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15873 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15874 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15875 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15876 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15877
15878 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15879 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15880 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15881
15882 @item set debug mips
15883 @kindex set debug mips
15884 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15885 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15886
15887 @item show debug mips
15888 @kindex show debug mips
15889 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15890 @end table
15891
15892
15893 @node HPPA
15894 @subsection HPPA
15895 @cindex HPPA support
15896
15897 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15898 following special commands:
15899
15900 @table @code
15901 @item set debug hppa
15902 @kindex set debug hppa
15903 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15904 messages are to be displayed.
15905
15906 @item show debug hppa
15907 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15908
15909 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15910 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15911 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15912 given @var{address}.
15913
15914 @end table
15915
15916
15917 @node SPU
15918 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15919 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15920 @cindex SPU
15921
15922 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15923 it provides the following special commands:
15924
15925 @table @code
15926 @item info spu event
15927 @kindex info spu
15928 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15929 and pending event status.
15930
15931 @item info spu signal
15932 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15933 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15934 notification channels.
15935
15936 @item info spu mailbox
15937 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15938 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15939 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15940
15941 @item info spu dma
15942 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15943 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15944 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15945
15946 @item info spu proxydma
15947 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15948 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15949 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15950
15951 @end table
15952
15953 @node PowerPC
15954 @subsection PowerPC
15955 @cindex PowerPC architecture
15956
15957 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
15958 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
15959 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
15960 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
15961 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
15962
15963 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
15964 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
15965 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
15966
15967
15968 @node Controlling GDB
15969 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15970
15971 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15972 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15973 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15974 described here.
15975
15976 @menu
15977 * Prompt:: Prompt
15978 * Editing:: Command editing
15979 * Command History:: Command history
15980 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15981 * Numbers:: Numbers
15982 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15983 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15984 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15985 @end menu
15986
15987 @node Prompt
15988 @section Prompt
15989
15990 @cindex prompt
15991
15992 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15993 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15994 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15995 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15996 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15997 which one you are talking to.
15998
15999 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
16000 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
16001 or a prompt that does not.
16002
16003 @table @code
16004 @kindex set prompt
16005 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
16006 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
16007
16008 @kindex show prompt
16009 @item show prompt
16010 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
16011 @end table
16012
16013 @node Editing
16014 @section Command Editing
16015 @cindex readline
16016 @cindex command line editing
16017
16018 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
16019 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
16020 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
16021 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
16022 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
16023 debugging sessions.
16024
16025 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
16026 command @code{set}.
16027
16028 @table @code
16029 @kindex set editing
16030 @cindex editing
16031 @item set editing
16032 @itemx set editing on
16033 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
16034
16035 @item set editing off
16036 Disable command line editing.
16037
16038 @kindex show editing
16039 @item show editing
16040 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
16041 @end table
16042
16043 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
16044 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
16045 encouraged to read that chapter.
16046
16047 @node Command History
16048 @section Command History
16049 @cindex command history
16050
16051 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
16052 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
16053 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
16054 history facility.
16055
16056 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
16057 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
16058 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
16059
16060 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
16061 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
16062 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
16063 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
16064 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
16065 pressed on a line by itself.
16066
16067 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
16068 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
16069 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
16070 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
16071
16072 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
16073 history.
16074
16075 @table @code
16076 @cindex history substitution
16077 @cindex history file
16078 @kindex set history filename
16079 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
16080 @item set history filename @var{fname}
16081 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
16082 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
16083 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
16084 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
16085 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
16086 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
16087 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
16088 is not set.
16089
16090 @cindex save command history
16091 @kindex set history save
16092 @item set history save
16093 @itemx set history save on
16094 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
16095 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
16096
16097 @item set history save off
16098 Stop recording command history in a file.
16099
16100 @cindex history size
16101 @kindex set history size
16102 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
16103 @item set history size @var{size}
16104 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
16105 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
16106 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
16107 @end table
16108
16109 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
16110 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
16111
16112 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
16113 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
16114 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
16115 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
16116 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
16117 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
16118 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
16119 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
16120
16121 The commands to control history expansion are:
16122
16123 @table @code
16124 @item set history expansion on
16125 @itemx set history expansion
16126 @kindex set history expansion
16127 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
16128
16129 @item set history expansion off
16130 Disable history expansion.
16131
16132 @c @group
16133 @kindex show history
16134 @item show history
16135 @itemx show history filename
16136 @itemx show history save
16137 @itemx show history size
16138 @itemx show history expansion
16139 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
16140 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
16141 @c @end group
16142 @end table
16143
16144 @table @code
16145 @kindex show commands
16146 @cindex show last commands
16147 @cindex display command history
16148 @item show commands
16149 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
16150
16151 @item show commands @var{n}
16152 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
16153
16154 @item show commands +
16155 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
16156 @end table
16157
16158 @node Screen Size
16159 @section Screen Size
16160 @cindex size of screen
16161 @cindex pauses in output
16162
16163 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
16164 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
16165 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
16166 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
16167 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
16168 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
16169 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
16170 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
16171
16172 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
16173 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
16174 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
16175 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
16176 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
16177 width} commands:
16178
16179 @table @code
16180 @kindex set height
16181 @kindex set width
16182 @kindex show width
16183 @kindex show height
16184 @item set height @var{lpp}
16185 @itemx show height
16186 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
16187 @itemx show width
16188 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
16189 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
16190 commands display the current settings.
16191
16192 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
16193 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
16194 file or to an editor buffer.
16195
16196 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16197 from wrapping its output.
16198
16199 @item set pagination on
16200 @itemx set pagination off
16201 @kindex set pagination
16202 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16203 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16204
16205 @item show pagination
16206 @kindex show pagination
16207 Show the current pagination mode.
16208 @end table
16209
16210 @node Numbers
16211 @section Numbers
16212 @cindex number representation
16213 @cindex entering numbers
16214
16215 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16216 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16217 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16218 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16219 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
16220 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16221 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16222 both input and output with the commands described below.
16223
16224 @table @code
16225 @kindex set input-radix
16226 @item set input-radix @var{base}
16227 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16228 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16229 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16230 example, any of
16231
16232 @smallexample
16233 set input-radix 012
16234 set input-radix 10.
16235 set input-radix 0xa
16236 @end smallexample
16237
16238 @noindent
16239 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16240 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16241 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16242 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16243 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16244 change the radix.
16245
16246 @kindex set output-radix
16247 @item set output-radix @var{base}
16248 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16249 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16250 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16251
16252 @kindex show input-radix
16253 @item show input-radix
16254 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16255
16256 @kindex show output-radix
16257 @item show output-radix
16258 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16259
16260 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16261 @itemx show radix
16262 @kindex set radix
16263 @kindex show radix
16264 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16265 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16266 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16267 default value of 10.
16268
16269 @end table
16270
16271 @node ABI
16272 @section Configuring the Current ABI
16273
16274 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16275 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16276 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16277 current ABI.
16278
16279 @cindex OS ABI
16280 @kindex set osabi
16281 @kindex show osabi
16282
16283 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16284 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16285 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16286 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16287 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16288 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16289 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16290 platform provides.
16291
16292 @table @code
16293 @item show osabi
16294 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16295
16296 @item set osabi
16297 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16298
16299 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16300 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16301 @end table
16302
16303 @cindex float promotion
16304
16305 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16306 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16307 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16308 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16309 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16310 @code{double} and then passed.
16311
16312 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16313 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16314 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16315
16316 @table @code
16317 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16318 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16319 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16320 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16321 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16322
16323 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16324 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16325 functions.
16326
16327 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16328 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16329 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16330 @end table
16331
16332 @kindex set cp-abi
16333 @kindex show cp-abi
16334 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16335 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16336 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16337 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16338 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16339 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16340 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16341 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16342 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16343 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16344 ``auto''.
16345
16346 @table @code
16347 @item show cp-abi
16348 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16349
16350 @item set cp-abi
16351 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16352
16353 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16354 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16355 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16356 @end table
16357
16358 @node Messages/Warnings
16359 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16360
16361 @cindex verbose operation
16362 @cindex optional warnings
16363 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16364 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16365 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16366 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16367
16368 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16369 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16370 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16371
16372 @table @code
16373 @kindex set verbose
16374 @item set verbose on
16375 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16376
16377 @item set verbose off
16378 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16379
16380 @kindex show verbose
16381 @item show verbose
16382 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16383 @end table
16384
16385 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16386 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16387 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16388 Symbol Files}).
16389
16390 @table @code
16391
16392 @kindex set complaints
16393 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16394 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16395 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16396 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16397 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16398
16399 @kindex show complaints
16400 @item show complaints
16401 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16402
16403 @end table
16404
16405 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16406 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16407 you try to run a program which is already running:
16408
16409 @smallexample
16410 (@value{GDBP}) run
16411 The program being debugged has been started already.
16412 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16413 @end smallexample
16414
16415 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16416 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16417
16418 @table @code
16419
16420 @kindex set confirm
16421 @cindex flinching
16422 @cindex confirmation
16423 @cindex stupid questions
16424 @item set confirm off
16425 Disables confirmation requests.
16426
16427 @item set confirm on
16428 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16429
16430 @kindex show confirm
16431 @item show confirm
16432 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16433
16434 @end table
16435
16436 @cindex command tracing
16437 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16438 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16439 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16440 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16441
16442 @table @code
16443 @kindex set trace-commands
16444 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16445 @item set trace-commands on
16446 Enable command tracing.
16447 @item set trace-commands off
16448 Disable command tracing.
16449 @item show trace-commands
16450 Display the current state of command tracing.
16451 @end table
16452
16453 @node Debugging Output
16454 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16455 @cindex optional debugging messages
16456
16457 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16458 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16459 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16460 section documents those commands.
16461
16462 @table @code
16463 @kindex set exec-done-display
16464 @item set exec-done-display
16465 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16466 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16467 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16468 @kindex show exec-done-display
16469 @item show exec-done-display
16470 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16471 notification.
16472 @kindex set debug
16473 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16474 @cindex architecture debugging info
16475 @item set debug arch
16476 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16477 @kindex show debug
16478 @item show debug arch
16479 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16480 @item set debug aix-thread
16481 @cindex AIX threads
16482 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16483 module.
16484 @item show debug aix-thread
16485 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16486 @item set debug displaced
16487 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
16488 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
16489 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
16490 @item show debug displaced
16491 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
16492 related to displaced stepping.
16493 @item set debug event
16494 @cindex event debugging info
16495 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16496 default is off.
16497 @item show debug event
16498 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16499 info.
16500 @item set debug expression
16501 @cindex expression debugging info
16502 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16503 expression parsing. The default is off.
16504 @item show debug expression
16505 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16506 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16507 @item set debug frame
16508 @cindex frame debugging info
16509 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16510 default is off.
16511 @item show debug frame
16512 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16513 info.
16514 @item set debug infrun
16515 @cindex inferior debugging info
16516 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16517 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16518 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16519 @item show debug infrun
16520 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16521 @item set debug lin-lwp
16522 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16523 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16524 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16525 @item show debug lin-lwp
16526 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16527 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
16528 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
16529 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16530 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
16531 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
16532 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
16533 @item set debug observer
16534 @cindex observer debugging info
16535 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16536 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16537 @item show debug observer
16538 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16539 @item set debug overload
16540 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16541 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16542 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16543 is off.
16544 @item show debug overload
16545 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16546 debugging info.
16547 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16548 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16549 @cindex debug remote protocol
16550 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16551 @cindex display remote packets
16552 @item set debug remote
16553 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16554 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16555 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16556 @item show debug remote
16557 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16558 @item set debug serial
16559 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16560 default is off.
16561 @item show debug serial
16562 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16563 info.
16564 @item set debug solib-frv
16565 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16566 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16567 @item show debug solib-frv
16568 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16569 messages.
16570 @item set debug target
16571 @cindex target debugging info
16572 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16573 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16574 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16575 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16576 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16577 @item show debug target
16578 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16579 info.
16580 @item set debug timestamp
16581 @cindex timestampping debugging info
16582 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
16583 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
16584 message.
16585 @item show debug timestamp
16586 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
16587 debugging info.
16588 @item set debugvarobj
16589 @cindex variable object debugging info
16590 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16591 info. The default is off.
16592 @item show debugvarobj
16593 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16594 debugging info.
16595 @item set debug xml
16596 @cindex XML parser debugging
16597 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16598 @item show debug xml
16599 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16600 @end table
16601
16602 @node Sequences
16603 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16604
16605 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16606 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16607 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16608 files.
16609
16610 @menu
16611 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16612 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16613 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16614 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16615 @end menu
16616
16617 @node Define
16618 @section User-defined Commands
16619
16620 @cindex user-defined command
16621 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16622 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16623 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16624 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16625 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16626 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16627
16628 @smallexample
16629 define adder
16630 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16631 end
16632 @end smallexample
16633
16634 @noindent
16635 To execute the command use:
16636
16637 @smallexample
16638 adder 1 2 3
16639 @end smallexample
16640
16641 @noindent
16642 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16643 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16644 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16645 functions calls.
16646
16647 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16648 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16649 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16650 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16651
16652 @smallexample
16653 define adder
16654 if $argc == 2
16655 print $arg0 + $arg1
16656 end
16657 if $argc == 3
16658 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16659 end
16660 end
16661 @end smallexample
16662
16663 @table @code
16664
16665 @kindex define
16666 @item define @var{commandname}
16667 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16668 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16669
16670 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16671 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16672 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16673
16674 @kindex document
16675 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16676 @item document @var{commandname}
16677 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16678 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16679 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16680 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16681 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16682 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16683
16684 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16685 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16686 does not change the documentation.
16687
16688 @kindex dont-repeat
16689 @cindex don't repeat command
16690 @item dont-repeat
16691 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16692 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16693 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16694
16695 @kindex help user-defined
16696 @item help user-defined
16697 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16698 (if any) for each.
16699
16700 @kindex show user
16701 @item show user
16702 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16703 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16704 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16705 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16706
16707 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16708 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16709 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16710 @item show max-user-call-depth
16711 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16712 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16713 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16714 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16715 @end table
16716
16717 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16718 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16719
16720 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16721 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16722 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16723
16724 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16725 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16726 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16727 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16728
16729 @node Hooks
16730 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16731 @cindex command hooks
16732 @cindex hooks, for commands
16733 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16734
16735 @kindex hook
16736 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16737 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16738 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16739 before that command.
16740
16741 @cindex hooks, post-command
16742 @kindex hookpost
16743 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16744 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16745 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16746 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16747 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16748
16749 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16750 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16751
16752 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16753 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16754
16755 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16756 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16757 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16758 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16759 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16760
16761 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16762 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16763 you could define:
16764
16765 @smallexample
16766 define hook-stop
16767 handle SIGALRM nopass
16768 end
16769
16770 define hook-run
16771 handle SIGALRM pass
16772 end
16773
16774 define hook-continue
16775 handle SIGALRM pass
16776 end
16777 @end smallexample
16778
16779 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16780 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16781 you could define:
16782
16783 @smallexample
16784 define hook-echo
16785 echo <<<---
16786 end
16787
16788 define hookpost-echo
16789 echo --->>>\n
16790 end
16791
16792 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16793 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16794 (@value{GDBP})
16795
16796 @end smallexample
16797
16798 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16799 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16800 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16801 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16802 @c or not?
16803 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16804 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16805 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16806
16807 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16808 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16809
16810 @node Command Files
16811 @section Command Files
16812
16813 @cindex command files
16814 @cindex scripting commands
16815 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16816 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16817 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16818 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16819 terminal.
16820
16821 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16822 command:
16823
16824 @table @code
16825 @kindex source
16826 @cindex execute commands from a file
16827 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16828 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16829 @end table
16830
16831 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16832 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16833 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16834 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16835 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16836
16837 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16838 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16839
16840 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16841 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16842 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16843
16844 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16845 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16846 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16847 when called from command files.
16848
16849 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16850 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16851 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16852 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16853 the next command.
16854
16855 @smallexample
16856 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16857 @end smallexample
16858
16859 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16860 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16861 would be directed to @file{log}.
16862
16863 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16864 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16865 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16866 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16867 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16868 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16869 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16870 conditionally, etc.
16871
16872 @table @code
16873 @kindex if
16874 @kindex else
16875 @item if
16876 @itemx else
16877 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16878 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16879 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16880 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16881 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16882 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16883 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16884
16885 @kindex while
16886 @item while
16887 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16888 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16889 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16890 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16891 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16892 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16893
16894 @kindex loop_break
16895 @item loop_break
16896 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16897 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16898 line.
16899
16900 @kindex loop_continue
16901 @item loop_continue
16902 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16903 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16904 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16905 the controlling expression.
16906
16907 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16908 @item end
16909 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16910 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16911 @end table
16912
16913
16914 @node Output
16915 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16916
16917 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16918 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16919 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16920 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16921 want.
16922
16923 @table @code
16924 @kindex echo
16925 @item echo @var{text}
16926 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16927 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16928 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16929 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16930 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16931 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16932 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16933 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16934 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16935 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16936 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16937
16938 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16939 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16940
16941 @smallexample
16942 echo This is some text\n\
16943 which is continued\n\
16944 onto several lines.\n
16945 @end smallexample
16946
16947 produces the same output as
16948
16949 @smallexample
16950 echo This is some text\n
16951 echo which is continued\n
16952 echo onto several lines.\n
16953 @end smallexample
16954
16955 @kindex output
16956 @item output @var{expression}
16957 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16958 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16959 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16960 on expressions.
16961
16962 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16963 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16964 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16965 Formats}, for more information.
16966
16967 @kindex printf
16968 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16969 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
16970 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
16971 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
16972 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
16973 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
16974 executing the code below:
16975
16976 @smallexample
16977 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16978 @end smallexample
16979
16980 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
16981 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
16982 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
16983 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
16984 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
16985 printed.
16986
16987 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16988
16989 @smallexample
16990 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16991 @end smallexample
16992
16993 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
16994 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
16995 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
16996
16997 @itemize @bullet
16998 @item
16999 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
17000
17001 @item
17002 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
17003 width.
17004
17005 @item
17006 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
17007 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
17008
17009 @item
17010 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
17011 supported.
17012
17013 @item
17014 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
17015
17016 @item
17017 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
17018 @end itemize
17019
17020 @noindent
17021 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
17022 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
17023 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
17024 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
17025
17026 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
17027 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
17028 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
17029 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
17030 supported.
17031
17032 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
17033 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
17034 together with a floating point specifier.
17035 letters:
17036
17037 @itemize @bullet
17038 @item
17039 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
17040
17041 @item
17042 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
17043
17044 @item
17045 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
17046 @end itemize
17047
17048 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
17049 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
17050 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
17051
17052 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
17053 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
17054
17055 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
17056 @smallexample
17057 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
17058 @end smallexample
17059
17060 @end table
17061
17062 @node Interpreters
17063 @chapter Command Interpreters
17064 @cindex command interpreters
17065
17066 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
17067 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
17068 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
17069
17070 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
17071 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
17072 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
17073 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
17074
17075 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
17076 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
17077 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
17078 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
17079
17080 @table @code
17081 @item console
17082 @cindex console interpreter
17083 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
17084 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
17085 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
17086
17087 @item mi
17088 @cindex mi interpreter
17089 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
17090 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
17091 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
17092 Interface}.
17093
17094 @item mi2
17095 @cindex mi2 interpreter
17096 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
17097
17098 @item mi1
17099 @cindex mi1 interpreter
17100 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
17101
17102 @end table
17103
17104 @cindex invoke another interpreter
17105 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
17106 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
17107 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
17108 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
17109 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
17110 the IDE inoperable!
17111
17112 @kindex interpreter-exec
17113 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
17114 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
17115 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
17116 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
17117
17118 @smallexample
17119 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
17120 @end smallexample
17121
17122 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
17123 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
17124
17125 @node TUI
17126 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
17127 @cindex TUI
17128 @cindex Text User Interface
17129
17130 @menu
17131 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
17132 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
17133 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
17134 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
17135 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
17136 @end menu
17137
17138 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
17139 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
17140 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
17141 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
17142 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
17143 is available.
17144
17145 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
17146 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
17147 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
17148 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
17149 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
17150 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
17151
17152 @node TUI Overview
17153 @section TUI Overview
17154
17155 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
17156
17157 @table @emph
17158 @item command
17159 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
17160 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
17161 managed using readline.
17162
17163 @item source
17164 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
17165 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
17166
17167 @item assembly
17168 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
17169
17170 @item register
17171 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
17172 when their values change.
17173 @end table
17174
17175 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
17176 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
17177 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
17178 indicates the breakpoint type:
17179
17180 @table @code
17181 @item B
17182 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17183
17184 @item b
17185 Breakpoint which was never hit.
17186
17187 @item H
17188 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17189
17190 @item h
17191 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
17192 @end table
17193
17194 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
17195
17196 @table @code
17197 @item +
17198 Breakpoint is enabled.
17199
17200 @item -
17201 Breakpoint is disabled.
17202 @end table
17203
17204 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
17205 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
17206 changes.
17207
17208 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
17209 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
17210 layouts:
17211
17212 @itemize @bullet
17213 @item
17214 source only,
17215
17216 @item
17217 assembly only,
17218
17219 @item
17220 source and assembly,
17221
17222 @item
17223 source and registers, or
17224
17225 @item
17226 assembly and registers.
17227 @end itemize
17228
17229 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17230
17231 @table @emph
17232 @item target
17233 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
17234 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17235
17236 @item process
17237 Gives the current process or thread number.
17238 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
17239
17240 @item function
17241 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
17242 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
17243 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
17244 the string @code{??} is displayed.
17245
17246 @item line
17247 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
17248 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
17249
17250 @item pc
17251 Indicates the current program counter address.
17252 @end table
17253
17254 @node TUI Keys
17255 @section TUI Key Bindings
17256 @cindex TUI key bindings
17257
17258 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
17259 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
17260 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
17261
17262 @table @kbd
17263 @kindex C-x C-a
17264 @item C-x C-a
17265 @kindex C-x a
17266 @itemx C-x a
17267 @kindex C-x A
17268 @itemx C-x A
17269 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
17270 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
17271 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
17272 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
17273 The screen is then refreshed.
17274
17275 @kindex C-x 1
17276 @item C-x 1
17277 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
17278 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
17279 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
17280
17281 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
17282
17283 @kindex C-x 2
17284 @item C-x 2
17285 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
17286 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
17287 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
17288 previous layout and the new one.
17289
17290 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17291
17292 @kindex C-x o
17293 @item C-x o
17294 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17295 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17296 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17297
17298 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17299
17300 @kindex C-x s
17301 @item C-x s
17302 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17303 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17304 @end table
17305
17306 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17307
17308 @table @asis
17309 @kindex PgUp
17310 @item @key{PgUp}
17311 Scroll the active window one page up.
17312
17313 @kindex PgDn
17314 @item @key{PgDn}
17315 Scroll the active window one page down.
17316
17317 @kindex Up
17318 @item @key{Up}
17319 Scroll the active window one line up.
17320
17321 @kindex Down
17322 @item @key{Down}
17323 Scroll the active window one line down.
17324
17325 @kindex Left
17326 @item @key{Left}
17327 Scroll the active window one column left.
17328
17329 @kindex Right
17330 @item @key{Right}
17331 Scroll the active window one column right.
17332
17333 @kindex C-L
17334 @item @kbd{C-L}
17335 Refresh the screen.
17336 @end table
17337
17338 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17339 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17340 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17341 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17342 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17343
17344 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17345 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17346 @cindex TUI single key mode
17347
17348 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17349 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17350 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17351
17352 @table @kbd
17353 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17354 @item c
17355 continue
17356
17357 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17358 @item d
17359 down
17360
17361 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17362 @item f
17363 finish
17364
17365 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17366 @item n
17367 next
17368
17369 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17370 @item q
17371 exit the SingleKey mode.
17372
17373 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17374 @item r
17375 run
17376
17377 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17378 @item s
17379 step
17380
17381 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17382 @item u
17383 up
17384
17385 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17386 @item v
17387 info locals
17388
17389 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17390 @item w
17391 where
17392 @end table
17393
17394 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17395 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17396 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17397 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17398 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17399 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17400
17401
17402 @node TUI Commands
17403 @section TUI-specific Commands
17404 @cindex TUI commands
17405
17406 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17407 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17408 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17409 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17410
17411 @table @code
17412 @item info win
17413 @kindex info win
17414 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17415
17416 @item layout next
17417 @kindex layout
17418 Display the next layout.
17419
17420 @item layout prev
17421 Display the previous layout.
17422
17423 @item layout src
17424 Display the source window only.
17425
17426 @item layout asm
17427 Display the assembly window only.
17428
17429 @item layout split
17430 Display the source and assembly window.
17431
17432 @item layout regs
17433 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17434
17435 @item focus next
17436 @kindex focus
17437 Make the next window active for scrolling.
17438
17439 @item focus prev
17440 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17441
17442 @item focus src
17443 Make the source window active for scrolling.
17444
17445 @item focus asm
17446 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17447
17448 @item focus regs
17449 Make the register window active for scrolling.
17450
17451 @item focus cmd
17452 Make the command window active for scrolling.
17453
17454 @item refresh
17455 @kindex refresh
17456 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17457
17458 @item tui reg float
17459 @kindex tui reg
17460 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17461
17462 @item tui reg general
17463 Show the general registers in the register window.
17464
17465 @item tui reg next
17466 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17467 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17468 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17469 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17470
17471 @item tui reg system
17472 Show the system registers in the register window.
17473
17474 @item update
17475 @kindex update
17476 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17477
17478 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17479 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17480 @kindex winheight
17481 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17482 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17483 decrease it.
17484
17485 @item tabset @var{nchars}
17486 @kindex tabset
17487 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17488 @end table
17489
17490 @node TUI Configuration
17491 @section TUI Configuration Variables
17492 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17493
17494 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17495
17496 @table @code
17497 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17498 @kindex set tui border-kind
17499 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17500 The possible values are the following:
17501 @table @code
17502 @item space
17503 Use a space character to draw the border.
17504
17505 @item ascii
17506 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17507
17508 @item acs
17509 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17510 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17511 @end table
17512
17513 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17514 @kindex set tui border-mode
17515 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17516 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17517 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17518 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17519 @table @code
17520 @item normal
17521 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17522
17523 @item standout
17524 Use standout mode.
17525
17526 @item reverse
17527 Use reverse video mode.
17528
17529 @item half
17530 Use half bright mode.
17531
17532 @item half-standout
17533 Use half bright and standout mode.
17534
17535 @item bold
17536 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17537
17538 @item bold-standout
17539 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17540 @end table
17541 @end table
17542
17543 @node Emacs
17544 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17545
17546 @cindex Emacs
17547 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17548 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17549 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17550 @value{GDBN}.
17551
17552 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17553 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17554 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17555 created Emacs buffer.
17556 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17557
17558 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17559 things:
17560
17561 @itemize @bullet
17562 @item
17563 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17564 the GUD buffer.
17565
17566 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17567 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17568
17569 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17570 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17571 in this way.
17572
17573 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17574 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17575 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17576 stop.
17577
17578 @item
17579 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17580
17581 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17582 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17583 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17584 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17585 and the source.
17586
17587 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17588 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17589 @end itemize
17590
17591 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17592 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17593 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17594 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17595
17596 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17597 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17598 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17599 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17600 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17601 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17602 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17603 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17604 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17605
17606 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17607 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17608 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17609 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17610
17611 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17612 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17613 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17614 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17615 one you want.
17616
17617 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17618 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17619
17620 @table @kbd
17621 @item C-h m
17622 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17623
17624 @item C-c C-s
17625 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17626 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17627
17628 @item C-c C-n
17629 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17630 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17631 to show the current file and location.
17632
17633 @item C-c C-i
17634 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17635 display window accordingly.
17636
17637 @item C-c C-f
17638 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17639 @code{finish} command.
17640
17641 @item C-c C-r
17642 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17643 command.
17644
17645 @item C-c <
17646 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17647 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17648 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17649
17650 @item C-c >
17651 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17652 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17653 @end table
17654
17655 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17656 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17657
17658 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17659 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17660 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17661 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17662 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17663 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17664 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17665
17666 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17667 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17668 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17669 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17670 frame.
17671
17672 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17673 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17674 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17675 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17676 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17677 to correspond properly with the code.
17678
17679 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17680 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17681 Emacs Manual}).
17682
17683 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17684 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17685 @ignore
17686 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17687 @kindex Epoch
17688 @kindex inspect
17689
17690 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17691 called the @code{epoch}
17692 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17693 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17694 each value is printed in its own window.
17695 @end ignore
17696
17697
17698 @node GDB/MI
17699 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17700
17701 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17702
17703 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17704 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17705 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17706 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17707 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17708 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17709
17710 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17711 in the form of a reference manual.
17712
17713 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17714 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17715 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17716
17717 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17718
17719 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17720 This chapter uses the following notation:
17721
17722 @itemize @bullet
17723 @item
17724 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17725
17726 @item
17727 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17728 it may or may not be given.
17729
17730 @item
17731 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17732 may repeat zero or more times.
17733
17734 @item
17735 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17736 may repeat one or more times.
17737
17738 @item
17739 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17740 @end itemize
17741
17742 @ignore
17743 @heading Dependencies
17744 @end ignore
17745
17746 @menu
17747 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17748 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17749 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17750 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17751 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17752 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17753 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17754 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17755 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17756 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17757 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17758 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17759 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17760 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17761 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17762 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17763 @ignore
17764 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17765 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17766 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17767 @end ignore
17768 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17769 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
17770 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17771 @end menu
17772
17773 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17774 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17775 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17776
17777 @menu
17778 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17779 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17780 @end menu
17781
17782 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17783 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17784
17785 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17786 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17787 @table @code
17788 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17789 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17790
17791 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17792 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17793 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17794
17795 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17796 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17797 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17798
17799 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17800 "any sequence of digits"
17801
17802 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17803 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17804
17805 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17806 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17807
17808 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17809 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17810
17811 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17812 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17813 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17814
17815 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17816 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17817
17818 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17819 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17820 @end table
17821
17822 @noindent
17823 Notes:
17824
17825 @itemize @bullet
17826 @item
17827 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17828 output is described below.
17829
17830 @item
17831 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17832 finishes.
17833
17834 @item
17835 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17836 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17837 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17838 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17839 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17840 @end itemize
17841
17842 Pragmatics:
17843
17844 @itemize @bullet
17845 @item
17846 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17847
17848 @item
17849 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17850 @end itemize
17851
17852 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17853 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17854
17855 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17856 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17857 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17858 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17859 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17860 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17861
17862 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17863 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17864 @var{token}.
17865
17866 @table @code
17867 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17868 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17869
17870 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17871 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17872
17873 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17874 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17875
17876 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17877 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17878
17879 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17880 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17881
17882 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17883 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17884
17885 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17886 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17887
17888 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17889 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17890
17891 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17892 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17893
17894 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17895 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17896 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17897
17898 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17899 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17900
17901 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17902 @code{ @var{string} }
17903
17904 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17905 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17906
17907 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17908 @code{@var{c-string}}
17909
17910 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17911 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17912
17913 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17914 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17915 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17916
17917 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17918 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17919
17920 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17921 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17922
17923 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17924 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17925
17926 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17927 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17928
17929 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17930 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17931
17932 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17933 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17934 @end table
17935
17936 @noindent
17937 Notes:
17938
17939 @itemize @bullet
17940 @item
17941 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17942
17943 @item
17944 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
17945 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
17946 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
17947 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
17948 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
17949 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
17950 prior command.
17951
17952 @item
17953 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17954 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17955 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17956 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17957
17958 @item
17959 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17960 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17961 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17962 @samp{*}.
17963
17964 @item
17965 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17966 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17967 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17968 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17969
17970 @item
17971 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17972 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17973 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17974 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17975
17976 @item
17977 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17978 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17979 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17980
17981 @item
17982 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17983 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17984 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17985 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17986
17987 @item
17988 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17989 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17990 @var{values}.
17991
17992
17993 @end itemize
17994
17995 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17996 details about the various output records.
17997
17998 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17999 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
18000 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
18001
18002 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
18003 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
18004
18005 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
18006 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
18007 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
18008 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
18009 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
18010 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
18011
18012 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
18013 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
18014 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
18015
18016 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18017 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
18018 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
18019 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
18020
18021 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
18022 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
18023
18024 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
18025 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
18026 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
18027 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
18028 might change.
18029
18030 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
18031 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
18032 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
18033 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
18034
18035 @itemize @bullet
18036 @item
18037 New MI commands may be added.
18038
18039 @item
18040 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
18041
18042 @item
18043 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
18044 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
18045
18046 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
18047 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
18048
18049 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
18050 @c resolve inconsistencies.
18051 @end itemize
18052
18053 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
18054 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
18055 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
18056 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
18057 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
18058
18059 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
18060 @c version?
18061
18062 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
18063 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
18064 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
18065 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
18066 @cindex mailing lists
18067
18068 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18069 @node GDB/MI Output Records
18070 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
18071
18072 @menu
18073 * GDB/MI Result Records::
18074 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
18075 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
18076 @end menu
18077
18078 @node GDB/MI Result Records
18079 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
18080
18081 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18082 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
18083 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
18084 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
18085
18086 @table @code
18087 @findex ^done
18088 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
18089 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
18090 values.
18091
18092 @item "^running"
18093 @findex ^running
18094 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
18095 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
18096 running.
18097
18098 @item "^connected"
18099 @findex ^connected
18100 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
18101
18102 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
18103 @findex ^error
18104 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
18105 error message.
18106
18107 @item "^exit"
18108 @findex ^exit
18109 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
18110
18111 @end table
18112
18113 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
18114 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
18115
18116 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
18117 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18118 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
18119 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
18120 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
18121
18122 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
18123 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
18124 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
18125 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
18126 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
18127
18128 @table @code
18129 @item "~" @var{string-output}
18130 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
18131 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
18132
18133 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
18134 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
18135 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
18136 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
18137
18138 @item "&" @var{string-output}
18139 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
18140 internals.
18141 @end table
18142
18143 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
18144 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
18145
18146 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18147 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
18148 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
18149 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
18150 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
18151 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
18152
18153 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
18154 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
18155
18156 @table @code
18157 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
18158 @end table
18159
18160 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
18161
18162 @table @code
18163 @item breakpoint-hit
18164 A breakpoint was reached.
18165 @item watchpoint-trigger
18166 A watchpoint was triggered.
18167 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
18168 A read watchpoint was triggered.
18169 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
18170 An access watchpoint was triggered.
18171 @item function-finished
18172 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18173 @item location-reached
18174 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18175 @item watchpoint-scope
18176 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
18177 @item end-stepping-range
18178 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
18179 similar CLI command was accomplished.
18180 @item exited-signalled
18181 The inferior exited because of a signal.
18182 @item exited
18183 The inferior exited.
18184 @item exited-normally
18185 The inferior exited normally.
18186 @item signal-received
18187 A signal was received by the inferior.
18188 @end table
18189
18190
18191 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18192 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
18193 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
18194 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
18195
18196 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
18197 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
18198 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
18199 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
18200
18201 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
18202 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
18203
18204 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
18205
18206 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
18207 information of the breakpoint.
18208
18209 @smallexample
18210 -> -break-insert main
18211 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18212 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
18213 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
18214 <- (gdb)
18215 @end smallexample
18216
18217 @subheading Program Execution
18218
18219 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
18220 reason that execution stopped.
18221
18222 @smallexample
18223 -> -exec-run
18224 <- ^running
18225 <- (gdb)
18226 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
18227 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
18228 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
18229 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
18230 <- (gdb)
18231 -> -exec-continue
18232 <- ^running
18233 <- (gdb)
18234 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18235 <- (gdb)
18236 @end smallexample
18237
18238 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
18239
18240 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
18241
18242 @smallexample
18243 -> (gdb)
18244 <- -gdb-exit
18245 <- ^exit
18246 @end smallexample
18247
18248 @subheading A Bad Command
18249
18250 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
18251
18252 @smallexample
18253 -> -rubbish
18254 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
18255 <- (gdb)
18256 @end smallexample
18257
18258
18259 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18260 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
18261 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
18262
18263 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
18264 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
18265
18266 @subheading Motivation
18267
18268 The motivation for this collection of commands.
18269
18270 @subheading Introduction
18271
18272 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
18273
18274 @subheading Commands
18275
18276 For each command in the block, the following is described:
18277
18278 @subsubheading Synopsis
18279
18280 @smallexample
18281 -command @var{args}@dots{}
18282 @end smallexample
18283
18284 @subsubheading Result
18285
18286 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18287
18288 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
18289
18290 @subsubheading Example
18291
18292 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
18293 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18294
18295
18296 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18297 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18298 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18299
18300 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18301 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18302 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18303 breakpoints.
18304
18305 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18306 @findex -break-after
18307
18308 @subsubheading Synopsis
18309
18310 @smallexample
18311 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18312 @end smallexample
18313
18314 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18315 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18316 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18317 @samp{-break-list} command below.
18318
18319 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18320
18321 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18322
18323 @subsubheading Example
18324
18325 @smallexample
18326 (gdb)
18327 -break-insert main
18328 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18329 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
18330 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18331 (gdb)
18332 -break-after 1 3
18333 ~
18334 ^done
18335 (gdb)
18336 -break-list
18337 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18338 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18339 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18340 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18341 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18342 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18343 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18344 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18345 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18346 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18347 (gdb)
18348 @end smallexample
18349
18350 @ignore
18351 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18352 @findex -break-catch
18353
18354 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18355 @findex -break-commands
18356 @end ignore
18357
18358
18359 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18360 @findex -break-condition
18361
18362 @subsubheading Synopsis
18363
18364 @smallexample
18365 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18366 @end smallexample
18367
18368 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18369 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18370 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18371 command below).
18372
18373 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18374
18375 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18376
18377 @subsubheading Example
18378
18379 @smallexample
18380 (gdb)
18381 -break-condition 1 1
18382 ^done
18383 (gdb)
18384 -break-list
18385 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18386 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18387 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18388 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18389 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18390 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18391 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18392 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18393 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18394 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18395 (gdb)
18396 @end smallexample
18397
18398 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18399 @findex -break-delete
18400
18401 @subsubheading Synopsis
18402
18403 @smallexample
18404 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18405 @end smallexample
18406
18407 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18408 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18409
18410 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18411
18412 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18413
18414 @subsubheading Example
18415
18416 @smallexample
18417 (gdb)
18418 -break-delete 1
18419 ^done
18420 (gdb)
18421 -break-list
18422 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18423 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18424 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18425 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18426 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18427 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18428 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18429 body=[]@}
18430 (gdb)
18431 @end smallexample
18432
18433 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18434 @findex -break-disable
18435
18436 @subsubheading Synopsis
18437
18438 @smallexample
18439 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18440 @end smallexample
18441
18442 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18443 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18444
18445 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18446
18447 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18448
18449 @subsubheading Example
18450
18451 @smallexample
18452 (gdb)
18453 -break-disable 2
18454 ^done
18455 (gdb)
18456 -break-list
18457 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18458 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18459 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18460 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18461 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18462 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18463 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18464 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18465 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18466 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18467 (gdb)
18468 @end smallexample
18469
18470 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18471 @findex -break-enable
18472
18473 @subsubheading Synopsis
18474
18475 @smallexample
18476 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18477 @end smallexample
18478
18479 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18480
18481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18482
18483 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18484
18485 @subsubheading Example
18486
18487 @smallexample
18488 (gdb)
18489 -break-enable 2
18490 ^done
18491 (gdb)
18492 -break-list
18493 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18494 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18495 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18496 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18497 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18498 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18499 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18500 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18501 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18502 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18503 (gdb)
18504 @end smallexample
18505
18506 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18507 @findex -break-info
18508
18509 @subsubheading Synopsis
18510
18511 @smallexample
18512 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18513 @end smallexample
18514
18515 @c REDUNDANT???
18516 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18517
18518 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18519
18520 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18521
18522 @subsubheading Example
18523 N.A.
18524
18525 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18526 @findex -break-insert
18527
18528 @subsubheading Synopsis
18529
18530 @smallexample
18531 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18532 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18533 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18534 @end smallexample
18535
18536 @noindent
18537 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18538
18539 @itemize @bullet
18540 @item function
18541 @c @item +offset
18542 @c @item -offset
18543 @c @item linenum
18544 @item filename:linenum
18545 @item filename:function
18546 @item *address
18547 @end itemize
18548
18549 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18550
18551 @table @samp
18552 @item -t
18553 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18554 @item -h
18555 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18556 @item -c @var{condition}
18557 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18558 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18559 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18560 @item -f
18561 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18562 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18563 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18564 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18565 cannot be parsed.
18566 @end table
18567
18568 @subsubheading Result
18569
18570 The result is in the form:
18571
18572 @smallexample
18573 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18574 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18575 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18576 times="@var{times}"@}
18577 @end smallexample
18578
18579 @noindent
18580 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18581 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18582 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18583 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18584 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18585 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18586 which use the same output).
18587
18588 Note: this format is open to change.
18589 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18590
18591 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18592
18593 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18594 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18595
18596 @subsubheading Example
18597
18598 @smallexample
18599 (gdb)
18600 -break-insert main
18601 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18602 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18603 (gdb)
18604 -break-insert -t foo
18605 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18606 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18607 (gdb)
18608 -break-list
18609 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18610 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18611 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18612 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18613 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18614 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18615 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18616 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18617 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18618 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18619 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18620 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18621 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18622 (gdb)
18623 -break-insert -r foo.*
18624 ~int foo(int, int);
18625 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18626 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18627 (gdb)
18628 @end smallexample
18629
18630 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18631 @findex -break-list
18632
18633 @subsubheading Synopsis
18634
18635 @smallexample
18636 -break-list
18637 @end smallexample
18638
18639 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18640
18641 @table @samp
18642 @item Number
18643 number of the breakpoint
18644 @item Type
18645 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18646 @item Disposition
18647 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18648 or @samp{nokeep}
18649 @item Enabled
18650 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18651 @item Address
18652 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18653 @item What
18654 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18655 name, line number
18656 @item Times
18657 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18658 @end table
18659
18660 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18661 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18662
18663 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18664
18665 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18666
18667 @subsubheading Example
18668
18669 @smallexample
18670 (gdb)
18671 -break-list
18672 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18673 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18674 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18675 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18676 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18677 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18678 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18679 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18680 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18681 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18682 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18683 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18684 (gdb)
18685 @end smallexample
18686
18687 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18688
18689 @smallexample
18690 (gdb)
18691 -break-list
18692 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18693 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18694 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18695 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18696 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18697 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18698 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18699 body=[]@}
18700 (gdb)
18701 @end smallexample
18702
18703 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18704 @findex -break-watch
18705
18706 @subsubheading Synopsis
18707
18708 @smallexample
18709 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18710 @end smallexample
18711
18712 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18713 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18714 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18715 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18716 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18717 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18718 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18719 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18720
18721 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18722 breakpoints inserted.
18723
18724 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18725
18726 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18727 @samp{rwatch}.
18728
18729 @subsubheading Example
18730
18731 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18732
18733 @smallexample
18734 (gdb)
18735 -break-watch x
18736 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18737 (gdb)
18738 -exec-continue
18739 ^running
18740 (gdb)
18741 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18742 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18743 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18744 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18745 (gdb)
18746 @end smallexample
18747
18748 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18749 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18750 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18751
18752 @smallexample
18753 (gdb)
18754 -break-watch C
18755 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18756 (gdb)
18757 -exec-continue
18758 ^running
18759 (gdb)
18760 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18761 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18762 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18763 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18764 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18765 (gdb)
18766 -exec-continue
18767 ^running
18768 (gdb)
18769 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18770 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18771 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18772 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18773 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18774 (gdb)
18775 @end smallexample
18776
18777 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18778 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18779 deleted.
18780
18781 @smallexample
18782 (gdb)
18783 -break-watch C
18784 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18785 (gdb)
18786 -break-list
18787 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18788 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18789 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18790 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18791 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18792 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18793 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18794 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18795 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18796 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18797 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18798 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18799 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18800 (gdb)
18801 -exec-continue
18802 ^running
18803 (gdb)
18804 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18805 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18806 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18807 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18808 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18809 (gdb)
18810 -break-list
18811 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18812 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18813 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18814 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18815 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18816 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18817 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18818 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18819 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18820 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18821 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18822 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18823 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18824 (gdb)
18825 -exec-continue
18826 ^running
18827 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18828 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18829 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18830 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18831 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18832 (gdb)
18833 -break-list
18834 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18835 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18836 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18837 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18838 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18839 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18840 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18841 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18842 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18843 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18844 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18845 times="1"@}]@}
18846 (gdb)
18847 @end smallexample
18848
18849 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18850 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18851 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18852
18853 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18854 @findex -exec-arguments
18855
18856
18857 @subsubheading Synopsis
18858
18859 @smallexample
18860 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18861 @end smallexample
18862
18863 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18864 @samp{-exec-run}.
18865
18866 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18867
18868 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18869
18870 @subsubheading Example
18871
18872 @c FIXME!
18873 Don't have one around.
18874
18875
18876 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18877 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18878
18879 @subsubheading Synopsis
18880
18881 @smallexample
18882 -exec-show-arguments
18883 @end smallexample
18884
18885 Print the arguments of the program.
18886
18887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18888
18889 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18890
18891 @subsubheading Example
18892 N.A.
18893
18894
18895 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18896 @findex -environment-cd
18897
18898 @subsubheading Synopsis
18899
18900 @smallexample
18901 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18902 @end smallexample
18903
18904 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18905
18906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18907
18908 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18909
18910 @subsubheading Example
18911
18912 @smallexample
18913 (gdb)
18914 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18915 ^done
18916 (gdb)
18917 @end smallexample
18918
18919
18920 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18921 @findex -environment-directory
18922
18923 @subsubheading Synopsis
18924
18925 @smallexample
18926 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18927 @end smallexample
18928
18929 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18930 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18931 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18932 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18933 occurs as normal.
18934 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18935 multiple directories in a single command
18936 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18937 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18938 If blanks are needed as
18939 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18940 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18941 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18942 character must not be used
18943 in any directory name.
18944 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18945
18946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18947
18948 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18949
18950 @subsubheading Example
18951
18952 @smallexample
18953 (gdb)
18954 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18955 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18956 (gdb)
18957 -environment-directory ""
18958 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18959 (gdb)
18960 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18961 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18962 (gdb)
18963 -environment-directory -r
18964 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18965 (gdb)
18966 @end smallexample
18967
18968
18969 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18970 @findex -environment-path
18971
18972 @subsubheading Synopsis
18973
18974 @smallexample
18975 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18976 @end smallexample
18977
18978 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18979 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18980 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18981 supplied in addition to the
18982 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18983 occurs as normal.
18984 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18985 multiple directories in a single command
18986 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18987 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18988 If blanks are needed as
18989 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18990 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18991 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18992 character must not be used
18993 in any directory name.
18994 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18995
18996
18997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18998
18999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
19000
19001 @subsubheading Example
19002
19003 @smallexample
19004 (gdb)
19005 -environment-path
19006 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
19007 (gdb)
19008 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
19009 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
19010 (gdb)
19011 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
19012 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
19013 (gdb)
19014 @end smallexample
19015
19016
19017 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
19018 @findex -environment-pwd
19019
19020 @subsubheading Synopsis
19021
19022 @smallexample
19023 -environment-pwd
19024 @end smallexample
19025
19026 Show the current working directory.
19027
19028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19029
19030 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
19031
19032 @subsubheading Example
19033
19034 @smallexample
19035 (gdb)
19036 -environment-pwd
19037 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
19038 (gdb)
19039 @end smallexample
19040
19041 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19042 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
19043 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
19044
19045
19046 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
19047 @findex -thread-info
19048
19049 @subsubheading Synopsis
19050
19051 @smallexample
19052 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
19053 @end smallexample
19054
19055 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
19056 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
19057 threads. When printing information about all threads,
19058 also reports the current thread.
19059
19060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19061
19062 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
19063 about all threads.
19064
19065 @subsubheading Example
19066
19067 @smallexample
19068 -thread-info
19069 ^done,threads=[
19070 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
19071 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},
19072 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
19073 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
19074 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}@}],
19075 current-thread-id="1"
19076 (gdb)
19077 @end smallexample
19078
19079 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
19080 @findex -thread-list-ids
19081
19082 @subsubheading Synopsis
19083
19084 @smallexample
19085 -thread-list-ids
19086 @end smallexample
19087
19088 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
19089 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
19090
19091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19092
19093 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
19094
19095 @subsubheading Example
19096
19097 No threads present, besides the main process:
19098
19099 @smallexample
19100 (gdb)
19101 -thread-list-ids
19102 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
19103 (gdb)
19104 @end smallexample
19105
19106
19107 Several threads:
19108
19109 @smallexample
19110 (gdb)
19111 -thread-list-ids
19112 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19113 number-of-threads="3"
19114 (gdb)
19115 @end smallexample
19116
19117
19118 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
19119 @findex -thread-select
19120
19121 @subsubheading Synopsis
19122
19123 @smallexample
19124 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
19125 @end smallexample
19126
19127 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
19128 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
19129
19130 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19131
19132 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
19133
19134 @subsubheading Example
19135
19136 @smallexample
19137 (gdb)
19138 -exec-next
19139 ^running
19140 (gdb)
19141 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
19142 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
19143 (gdb)
19144 -thread-list-ids
19145 ^done,
19146 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19147 number-of-threads="3"
19148 (gdb)
19149 -thread-select 3
19150 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
19151 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
19152 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
19153 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
19154 (gdb)
19155 @end smallexample
19156
19157 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19158 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
19159 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
19160
19161 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
19162 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
19163 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
19164 other cases.
19165
19166 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
19167 @findex -exec-continue
19168
19169 @subsubheading Synopsis
19170
19171 @smallexample
19172 -exec-continue
19173 @end smallexample
19174
19175 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
19176 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
19177
19178 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19179
19180 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
19181
19182 @subsubheading Example
19183
19184 @smallexample
19185 -exec-continue
19186 ^running
19187 (gdb)
19188 @@Hello world
19189 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
19190 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
19191 line="13"@}
19192 (gdb)
19193 @end smallexample
19194
19195
19196 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
19197 @findex -exec-finish
19198
19199 @subsubheading Synopsis
19200
19201 @smallexample
19202 -exec-finish
19203 @end smallexample
19204
19205 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
19206 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
19207
19208 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19209
19210 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
19211
19212 @subsubheading Example
19213
19214 Function returning @code{void}.
19215
19216 @smallexample
19217 -exec-finish
19218 ^running
19219 (gdb)
19220 @@hello from foo
19221 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19222 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
19223 (gdb)
19224 @end smallexample
19225
19226 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
19227 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
19228 value itself.
19229
19230 @smallexample
19231 -exec-finish
19232 ^running
19233 (gdb)
19234 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
19235 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
19236 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19237 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
19238 (gdb)
19239 @end smallexample
19240
19241
19242 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
19243 @findex -exec-interrupt
19244
19245 @subsubheading Synopsis
19246
19247 @smallexample
19248 -exec-interrupt
19249 @end smallexample
19250
19251 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
19252 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
19253 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
19254 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
19255 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
19256
19257 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19258
19259 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
19260
19261 @subsubheading Example
19262
19263 @smallexample
19264 (gdb)
19265 111-exec-continue
19266 111^running
19267
19268 (gdb)
19269 222-exec-interrupt
19270 222^done
19271 (gdb)
19272 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
19273 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19274 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
19275 (gdb)
19276
19277 (gdb)
19278 -exec-interrupt
19279 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
19280 (gdb)
19281 @end smallexample
19282
19283
19284 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
19285 @findex -exec-next
19286
19287 @subsubheading Synopsis
19288
19289 @smallexample
19290 -exec-next
19291 @end smallexample
19292
19293 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19294 of the next source line is reached.
19295
19296 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19297
19298 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19299
19300 @subsubheading Example
19301
19302 @smallexample
19303 -exec-next
19304 ^running
19305 (gdb)
19306 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19307 (gdb)
19308 @end smallexample
19309
19310
19311 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19312 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19313
19314 @subsubheading Synopsis
19315
19316 @smallexample
19317 -exec-next-instruction
19318 @end smallexample
19319
19320 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19321 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19322 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19323 printed as well.
19324
19325 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19326
19327 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19328
19329 @subsubheading Example
19330
19331 @smallexample
19332 (gdb)
19333 -exec-next-instruction
19334 ^running
19335
19336 (gdb)
19337 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19338 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19339 (gdb)
19340 @end smallexample
19341
19342
19343 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19344 @findex -exec-return
19345
19346 @subsubheading Synopsis
19347
19348 @smallexample
19349 -exec-return
19350 @end smallexample
19351
19352 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19353 Displays the new current frame.
19354
19355 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19356
19357 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19358
19359 @subsubheading Example
19360
19361 @smallexample
19362 (gdb)
19363 200-break-insert callee4
19364 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19365 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19366 (gdb)
19367 000-exec-run
19368 000^running
19369 (gdb)
19370 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
19371 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19372 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19373 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19374 (gdb)
19375 205-break-delete
19376 205^done
19377 (gdb)
19378 111-exec-return
19379 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19380 args=[@{name="strarg",
19381 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19382 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19383 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19384 (gdb)
19385 @end smallexample
19386
19387
19388 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19389 @findex -exec-run
19390
19391 @subsubheading Synopsis
19392
19393 @smallexample
19394 -exec-run
19395 @end smallexample
19396
19397 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19398 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19399 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19400 the program has exited exceptionally.
19401
19402 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19403
19404 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19405
19406 @subsubheading Examples
19407
19408 @smallexample
19409 (gdb)
19410 -break-insert main
19411 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19412 (gdb)
19413 -exec-run
19414 ^running
19415 (gdb)
19416 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
19417 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19418 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19419 (gdb)
19420 @end smallexample
19421
19422 @noindent
19423 Program exited normally:
19424
19425 @smallexample
19426 (gdb)
19427 -exec-run
19428 ^running
19429 (gdb)
19430 x = 55
19431 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19432 (gdb)
19433 @end smallexample
19434
19435 @noindent
19436 Program exited exceptionally:
19437
19438 @smallexample
19439 (gdb)
19440 -exec-run
19441 ^running
19442 (gdb)
19443 x = 55
19444 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19445 (gdb)
19446 @end smallexample
19447
19448 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19449 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19450
19451 @smallexample
19452 (gdb)
19453 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19454 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19455 @end smallexample
19456
19457
19458 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19459
19460
19461 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19462 @findex -exec-step
19463
19464 @subsubheading Synopsis
19465
19466 @smallexample
19467 -exec-step
19468 @end smallexample
19469
19470 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19471 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19472 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19473 function.
19474
19475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19476
19477 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19478
19479 @subsubheading Example
19480
19481 Stepping into a function:
19482
19483 @smallexample
19484 -exec-step
19485 ^running
19486 (gdb)
19487 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19488 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19489 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19490 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19491 (gdb)
19492 @end smallexample
19493
19494 Regular stepping:
19495
19496 @smallexample
19497 -exec-step
19498 ^running
19499 (gdb)
19500 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19501 (gdb)
19502 @end smallexample
19503
19504
19505 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19506 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19507
19508 @subsubheading Synopsis
19509
19510 @smallexample
19511 -exec-step-instruction
19512 @end smallexample
19513
19514 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19515 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19516 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19517 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19518 well.
19519
19520 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19521
19522 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19523
19524 @subsubheading Example
19525
19526 @smallexample
19527 (gdb)
19528 -exec-step-instruction
19529 ^running
19530
19531 (gdb)
19532 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19533 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19534 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19535 (gdb)
19536 -exec-step-instruction
19537 ^running
19538
19539 (gdb)
19540 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19541 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19542 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19543 (gdb)
19544 @end smallexample
19545
19546
19547 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19548 @findex -exec-until
19549
19550 @subsubheading Synopsis
19551
19552 @smallexample
19553 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19554 @end smallexample
19555
19556 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19557 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19558 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19559 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19560
19561 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19562
19563 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19564
19565 @subsubheading Example
19566
19567 @smallexample
19568 (gdb)
19569 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19570 ^running
19571 (gdb)
19572 x = 55
19573 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19574 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19575 (gdb)
19576 @end smallexample
19577
19578 @ignore
19579 @subheading -file-clear
19580 Is this going away????
19581 @end ignore
19582
19583 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19584 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19585 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19586
19587
19588 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19589 @findex -stack-info-frame
19590
19591 @subsubheading Synopsis
19592
19593 @smallexample
19594 -stack-info-frame
19595 @end smallexample
19596
19597 Get info on the selected frame.
19598
19599 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19600
19601 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19602 (without arguments).
19603
19604 @subsubheading Example
19605
19606 @smallexample
19607 (gdb)
19608 -stack-info-frame
19609 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19610 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19611 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19612 (gdb)
19613 @end smallexample
19614
19615 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19616 @findex -stack-info-depth
19617
19618 @subsubheading Synopsis
19619
19620 @smallexample
19621 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19622 @end smallexample
19623
19624 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19625 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19626
19627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19628
19629 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19630
19631 @subsubheading Example
19632
19633 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19634
19635 @smallexample
19636 (gdb)
19637 -stack-info-depth
19638 ^done,depth="12"
19639 (gdb)
19640 -stack-info-depth 4
19641 ^done,depth="4"
19642 (gdb)
19643 -stack-info-depth 12
19644 ^done,depth="12"
19645 (gdb)
19646 -stack-info-depth 11
19647 ^done,depth="11"
19648 (gdb)
19649 -stack-info-depth 13
19650 ^done,depth="12"
19651 (gdb)
19652 @end smallexample
19653
19654 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19655 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19656
19657 @subsubheading Synopsis
19658
19659 @smallexample
19660 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19661 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19662 @end smallexample
19663
19664 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19665 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19666 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19667 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19668 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19669 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19670 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19671 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19672
19673 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19674 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19675 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19676
19677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19678
19679 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19680 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19681 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19682
19683 @subsubheading Example
19684
19685 @smallexample
19686 (gdb)
19687 -stack-list-frames
19688 ^done,
19689 stack=[
19690 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19691 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19692 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19693 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19694 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19695 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19696 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19697 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19698 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19699 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19700 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19701 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19702 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19703 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19704 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19705 (gdb)
19706 -stack-list-arguments 0
19707 ^done,
19708 stack-args=[
19709 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19710 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19711 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19712 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19713 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19714 (gdb)
19715 -stack-list-arguments 1
19716 ^done,
19717 stack-args=[
19718 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19719 frame=@{level="1",
19720 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19721 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19722 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19723 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19724 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19725 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19726 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19727 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19728 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19729 (gdb)
19730 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19731 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19732 (gdb)
19733 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19734 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19735 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19736 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19737 (gdb)
19738 @end smallexample
19739
19740 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19741
19742
19743 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19744 @findex -stack-list-frames
19745
19746 @subsubheading Synopsis
19747
19748 @smallexample
19749 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19750 @end smallexample
19751
19752 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19753 following info:
19754
19755 @table @samp
19756 @item @var{level}
19757 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19758 @item @var{addr}
19759 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19760 @item @var{func}
19761 Function name.
19762 @item @var{file}
19763 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19764 @item @var{line}
19765 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19766 @end table
19767
19768 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19769 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19770 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19771 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19772 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19773 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19774 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19775
19776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19777
19778 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19779
19780 @subsubheading Example
19781
19782 Full stack backtrace:
19783
19784 @smallexample
19785 (gdb)
19786 -stack-list-frames
19787 ^done,stack=
19788 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19789 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19790 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19791 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19792 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19793 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19794 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19795 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19796 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19797 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19798 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19799 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19800 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19801 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19802 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19803 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19804 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19805 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19806 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19807 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19808 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19809 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19810 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19811 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19812 (gdb)
19813 @end smallexample
19814
19815 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19816
19817 @smallexample
19818 (gdb)
19819 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19820 ^done,stack=
19821 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19822 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19823 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19824 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19825 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19826 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19827 (gdb)
19828 @end smallexample
19829
19830 Show a single frame:
19831
19832 @smallexample
19833 (gdb)
19834 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19835 ^done,stack=
19836 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19837 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19838 (gdb)
19839 @end smallexample
19840
19841
19842 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19843 @findex -stack-list-locals
19844
19845 @subsubheading Synopsis
19846
19847 @smallexample
19848 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19849 @end smallexample
19850
19851 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19852 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19853 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19854 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19855 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19856 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19857 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19858 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19859 more detail.
19860
19861 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19862
19863 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19864
19865 @subsubheading Example
19866
19867 @smallexample
19868 (gdb)
19869 -stack-list-locals 0
19870 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19871 (gdb)
19872 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19873 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19874 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19875 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19876 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19877 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19878 (gdb)
19879 @end smallexample
19880
19881
19882 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19883 @findex -stack-select-frame
19884
19885 @subsubheading Synopsis
19886
19887 @smallexample
19888 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19889 @end smallexample
19890
19891 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19892 the stack.
19893
19894 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19895
19896 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19897 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19898
19899 @subsubheading Example
19900
19901 @smallexample
19902 (gdb)
19903 -stack-select-frame 2
19904 ^done
19905 (gdb)
19906 @end smallexample
19907
19908 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19909 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19910 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19911
19912 @ignore
19913
19914 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19915
19916 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19917 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19918 used by @code{Insight}.
19919
19920 The two main reasons for that are:
19921
19922 @enumerate 1
19923 @item
19924 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19925
19926 @item
19927 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19928 now).
19929 @end enumerate
19930
19931 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19932 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19933 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19934 hints about their use.
19935
19936 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19937 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19938 least, the following operations:
19939
19940 @itemize @bullet
19941 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19942 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19943 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19944 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19945 @end itemize
19946
19947 @end ignore
19948
19949 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19950
19951 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19952
19953 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19954 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19955 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19956 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19957 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19958 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19959 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19960 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19961 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19962 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19963 object, or to change display format.
19964
19965 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19966 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19967 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19968 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19969 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19970 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19971 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19972 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19973 child will be created.
19974
19975 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19976 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19977 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19978 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19979 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19980
19981 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19982 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19983 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19984 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19985 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19986 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19987 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19988 variables that frontend has created.
19989
19990 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19991 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19992 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19993 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19994 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19995 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19996 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19997 implicitly updated.
19998
19999 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
20000 access this functionality:
20001
20002 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
20003 @item @strong{Operation}
20004 @tab @strong{Description}
20005
20006 @item @code{-var-create}
20007 @tab create a variable object
20008 @item @code{-var-delete}
20009 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
20010 @item @code{-var-set-format}
20011 @tab set the display format of this variable
20012 @item @code{-var-show-format}
20013 @tab show the display format of this variable
20014 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
20015 @tab tells how many children this object has
20016 @item @code{-var-list-children}
20017 @tab return a list of the object's children
20018 @item @code{-var-info-type}
20019 @tab show the type of this variable object
20020 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
20021 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
20022 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
20023 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
20024 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
20025 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
20026 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
20027 @tab get the value of this variable
20028 @item @code{-var-assign}
20029 @tab set the value of this variable
20030 @item @code{-var-update}
20031 @tab update the variable and its children
20032 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
20033 @tab set frozeness attribute
20034 @end multitable
20035
20036 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
20037 how it can be used.
20038
20039 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
20040
20041 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
20042 @findex -var-create
20043
20044 @subsubheading Synopsis
20045
20046 @smallexample
20047 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
20048 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
20049 @end smallexample
20050
20051 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
20052 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
20053 register.
20054
20055 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
20056 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
20057 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
20058 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
20059 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
20060
20061 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
20062 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
20063 frame should be used.
20064
20065 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
20066 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
20067
20068 @itemize @bullet
20069 @item
20070 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20071
20072 @item
20073 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20074
20075 @item
20076 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20077 @end itemize
20078
20079 @subsubheading Result
20080
20081 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20082 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20083 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20084
20085 @smallexample
20086 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20087 @end smallexample
20088
20089
20090 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20091 @findex -var-delete
20092
20093 @subsubheading Synopsis
20094
20095 @smallexample
20096 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
20097 @end smallexample
20098
20099 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20100 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
20101
20102 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20103
20104
20105 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20106 @findex -var-set-format
20107
20108 @subsubheading Synopsis
20109
20110 @smallexample
20111 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20112 @end smallexample
20113
20114 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20115 @var{format-spec}.
20116
20117 @anchor{-var-set-format}
20118 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20119
20120 @smallexample
20121 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20122 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20123 @end smallexample
20124
20125 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
20126 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20127 for pointers, etc.).
20128
20129 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
20130 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
20131
20132 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20133 @findex -var-show-format
20134
20135 @subsubheading Synopsis
20136
20137 @smallexample
20138 -var-show-format @var{name}
20139 @end smallexample
20140
20141 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20142
20143 @smallexample
20144 @var{format} @expansion{}
20145 @var{format-spec}
20146 @end smallexample
20147
20148
20149 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20150 @findex -var-info-num-children
20151
20152 @subsubheading Synopsis
20153
20154 @smallexample
20155 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20156 @end smallexample
20157
20158 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20159
20160 @smallexample
20161 numchild=@var{n}
20162 @end smallexample
20163
20164
20165 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20166 @findex -var-list-children
20167
20168 @subsubheading Synopsis
20169
20170 @smallexample
20171 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20172 @end smallexample
20173 @anchor{-var-list-children}
20174
20175 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20176 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20177 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20178 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20179 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20180 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20181 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20182 and unions.
20183
20184 @subsubheading Example
20185
20186 @smallexample
20187 (gdb)
20188 -var-list-children n
20189 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20190 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20191 (gdb)
20192 -var-list-children --all-values n
20193 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20194 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20195 @end smallexample
20196
20197
20198 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20199 @findex -var-info-type
20200
20201 @subsubheading Synopsis
20202
20203 @smallexample
20204 -var-info-type @var{name}
20205 @end smallexample
20206
20207 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20208 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20209 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20210
20211 @smallexample
20212 type=@var{typename}
20213 @end smallexample
20214
20215
20216 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20217 @findex -var-info-expression
20218
20219 @subsubheading Synopsis
20220
20221 @smallexample
20222 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20223 @end smallexample
20224
20225 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
20226 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
20227 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
20228
20229 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
20230 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
20231
20232 @smallexample
20233 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
20234 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
20235 @end smallexample
20236
20237 @noindent
20238 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20239
20240 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
20241 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
20242 is of limited use.
20243
20244 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
20245 @findex -var-info-path-expression
20246
20247 @subsubheading Synopsis
20248
20249 @smallexample
20250 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
20251 @end smallexample
20252
20253 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
20254 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
20255 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
20256 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
20257 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
20258 watchpoint from a variable object.
20259
20260 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
20261 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
20262 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
20263 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
20264 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
20265 @smallexample
20266 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
20267 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
20268 @end smallexample
20269
20270 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20271 @findex -var-show-attributes
20272
20273 @subsubheading Synopsis
20274
20275 @smallexample
20276 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20277 @end smallexample
20278
20279 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20280
20281 @smallexample
20282 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20283 @end smallexample
20284
20285 @noindent
20286 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20287
20288 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20289 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
20290
20291 @subsubheading Synopsis
20292
20293 @smallexample
20294 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
20295 @end smallexample
20296
20297 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20298 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
20299 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
20300 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
20301 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
20302 the current display format will be used. The current display format
20303 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20304
20305 @smallexample
20306 value=@var{value}
20307 @end smallexample
20308
20309 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20310 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20311
20312 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20313 @findex -var-assign
20314
20315 @subsubheading Synopsis
20316
20317 @smallexample
20318 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20319 @end smallexample
20320
20321 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20322 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20323 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20324 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20325
20326 @subsubheading Example
20327
20328 @smallexample
20329 (gdb)
20330 -var-assign var1 3
20331 ^done,value="3"
20332 (gdb)
20333 -var-update *
20334 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20335 (gdb)
20336 @end smallexample
20337
20338 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20339 @findex -var-update
20340
20341 @subsubheading Synopsis
20342
20343 @smallexample
20344 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20345 @end smallexample
20346
20347 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20348 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20349 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20350 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20351 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20352 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20353 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20354 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20355 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20356 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
20357 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20358 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20359 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20360
20361
20362 @subsubheading Example
20363
20364 @smallexample
20365 (gdb)
20366 -var-assign var1 3
20367 ^done,value="3"
20368 (gdb)
20369 -var-update --all-values var1
20370 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20371 type_changed="false"@}]
20372 (gdb)
20373 @end smallexample
20374
20375 @anchor{-var-update}
20376 The field in_scope may take three values:
20377
20378 @table @code
20379 @item "true"
20380 The variable object's current value is valid.
20381
20382 @item "false"
20383 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20384 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20385 scope.
20386
20387 @item "invalid"
20388 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20389 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20390 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20391 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20392 objects.
20393 @end table
20394
20395 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20396 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20397
20398 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20399 @findex -var-set-frozen
20400 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20401
20402 @subsubheading Synopsis
20403
20404 @smallexample
20405 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20406 @end smallexample
20407
20408 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20409 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20410 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20411 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20412 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20413 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20414 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20415 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20416 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20417 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20418 @code{-var-update} does.
20419
20420 @subsubheading Example
20421
20422 @smallexample
20423 (gdb)
20424 -var-set-frozen V 1
20425 ^done
20426 (gdb)
20427 @end smallexample
20428
20429
20430 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20431 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20432 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20433
20434 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20435 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20436 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20437 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20438
20439 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20440 @c @subheading -data-assign
20441 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20442 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
20443 @c set variable
20444 @c @subsubheading Example
20445 @c N.A.
20446
20447 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20448 @findex -data-disassemble
20449
20450 @subsubheading Synopsis
20451
20452 @smallexample
20453 -data-disassemble
20454 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20455 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20456 -- @var{mode}
20457 @end smallexample
20458
20459 @noindent
20460 Where:
20461
20462 @table @samp
20463 @item @var{start-addr}
20464 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20465 @item @var{end-addr}
20466 is the end address
20467 @item @var{filename}
20468 is the name of the file to disassemble
20469 @item @var{linenum}
20470 is the line number to disassemble around
20471 @item @var{lines}
20472 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20473 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20474 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20475 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20476 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20477 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20478 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20479 are displayed.
20480 @item @var{mode}
20481 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20482 disassembly).
20483 @end table
20484
20485 @subsubheading Result
20486
20487 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20488
20489 @itemize @bullet
20490 @item Address
20491 @item Func-name
20492 @item Offset
20493 @item Instruction
20494 @end itemize
20495
20496 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20497 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20498
20499 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20500
20501 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20502
20503 @subsubheading Example
20504
20505 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20506
20507 @smallexample
20508 (gdb)
20509 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20510 ^done,
20511 asm_insns=[
20512 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20513 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20514 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20515 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20516 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20517 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20518 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20519 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20520 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20521 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20522 (gdb)
20523 @end smallexample
20524
20525 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20526 @code{main}.
20527
20528 @smallexample
20529 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20530 ^done,asm_insns=[
20531 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20532 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20533 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20534 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20535 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20536 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20537 [@dots{}]
20538 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20539 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20540 (gdb)
20541 @end smallexample
20542
20543 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20544
20545 @smallexample
20546 (gdb)
20547 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20548 ^done,asm_insns=[
20549 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20550 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20551 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20552 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20553 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20554 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20555 (gdb)
20556 @end smallexample
20557
20558 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20559
20560 @smallexample
20561 (gdb)
20562 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20563 ^done,asm_insns=[
20564 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20565 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20566 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20567 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20568 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20569 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20570 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20571 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20572 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20573 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20574 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20575 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20576 (gdb)
20577 @end smallexample
20578
20579
20580 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20581 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20582
20583 @subsubheading Synopsis
20584
20585 @smallexample
20586 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20587 @end smallexample
20588
20589 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20590 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20591 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20592
20593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20594
20595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20596 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20597 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20598
20599 @subsubheading Example
20600
20601 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20602 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20603 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20604 output.
20605
20606 @smallexample
20607 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20608 211^done,value="1"
20609 (gdb)
20610 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20611 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20612 (gdb)
20613 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20614 411^done,value="4"
20615 (gdb)
20616 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20617 511^done,value="4"
20618 (gdb)
20619 @end smallexample
20620
20621
20622 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20623 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20624
20625 @subsubheading Synopsis
20626
20627 @smallexample
20628 -data-list-changed-registers
20629 @end smallexample
20630
20631 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20632
20633 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20634
20635 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20636 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20637
20638 @subsubheading Example
20639
20640 On a PPC MBX board:
20641
20642 @smallexample
20643 (gdb)
20644 -exec-continue
20645 ^running
20646
20647 (gdb)
20648 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
20649 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
20650 line="5"@}
20651 (gdb)
20652 -data-list-changed-registers
20653 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20654 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20655 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20656 (gdb)
20657 @end smallexample
20658
20659
20660 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20661 @findex -data-list-register-names
20662
20663 @subsubheading Synopsis
20664
20665 @smallexample
20666 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20667 @end smallexample
20668
20669 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20670 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20671 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20672 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20673 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20674 include empty register names.
20675
20676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20677
20678 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20679 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20680 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20681
20682 @subsubheading Example
20683
20684 For the PPC MBX board:
20685 @smallexample
20686 (gdb)
20687 -data-list-register-names
20688 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20689 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20690 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20691 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20692 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20693 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20694 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20695 (gdb)
20696 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20697 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20698 (gdb)
20699 @end smallexample
20700
20701 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20702 @findex -data-list-register-values
20703
20704 @subsubheading Synopsis
20705
20706 @smallexample
20707 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20708 @end smallexample
20709
20710 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20711 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20712 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20713 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20714
20715 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20716
20717 @table @code
20718 @item x
20719 Hexadecimal
20720 @item o
20721 Octal
20722 @item t
20723 Binary
20724 @item d
20725 Decimal
20726 @item r
20727 Raw
20728 @item N
20729 Natural
20730 @end table
20731
20732 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20733
20734 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20735 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20736
20737 @subsubheading Example
20738
20739 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20740 don't appear in the actual output):
20741
20742 @smallexample
20743 (gdb)
20744 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20745 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20746 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20747 (gdb)
20748 -data-list-register-values x
20749 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20750 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20751 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20752 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20753 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20754 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20755 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20756 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20757 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20758 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20759 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20760 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20761 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20762 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20763 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20764 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20765 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20766 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20767 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20768 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20769 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20770 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20771 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20772 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20773 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20774 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20775 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20776 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20777 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20778 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20779 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20780 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20781 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20782 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20783 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20784 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20785 (gdb)
20786 @end smallexample
20787
20788
20789 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20790 @findex -data-read-memory
20791
20792 @subsubheading Synopsis
20793
20794 @smallexample
20795 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20796 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20797 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20798 @end smallexample
20799
20800 @noindent
20801 where:
20802
20803 @table @samp
20804 @item @var{address}
20805 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20806 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20807 quoted using the C convention.
20808
20809 @item @var{word-format}
20810 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20811 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20812 ,Output Formats}).
20813
20814 @item @var{word-size}
20815 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20816
20817 @item @var{nr-rows}
20818 The number of rows in the output table.
20819
20820 @item @var{nr-cols}
20821 The number of columns in the output table.
20822
20823 @item @var{aschar}
20824 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20825 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20826 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20827 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20828
20829 @item @var{byte-offset}
20830 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20831 @end table
20832
20833 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20834 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20835 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20836 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20837 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20838 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20839 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20840 @samp{addr}.
20841
20842 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20843 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20844 @samp{prev-page}.
20845
20846 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20847
20848 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20849 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20850
20851 @subsubheading Example
20852
20853 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20854 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20855 word. Display each word in hex.
20856
20857 @smallexample
20858 (gdb)
20859 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20860 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20861 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20862 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20863 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20864 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20865 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20866 (gdb)
20867 @end smallexample
20868
20869 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20870 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20871
20872 @smallexample
20873 (gdb)
20874 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20875 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20876 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20877 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20878 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20879 (gdb)
20880 @end smallexample
20881
20882 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20883 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20884 used as the non-printable character.
20885
20886 @smallexample
20887 (gdb)
20888 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20889 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20890 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20891 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20892 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20893 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20894 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20895 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20896 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20897 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20898 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20899 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20900 (gdb)
20901 @end smallexample
20902
20903 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20904 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20905 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20906
20907 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20908
20909 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20910
20911 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20912
20913 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20914
20915 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20916
20917 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20918
20919 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20920
20921 @c @subheading -trace-find
20922
20923 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20924
20925 @c @subheading -trace-info
20926
20927 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20928
20929 @c @subheading -trace-list
20930
20931 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20932
20933 @c @subheading -trace-save
20934
20935 @c @subheading -trace-start
20936
20937 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20938
20939
20940 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20941 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20942 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20943
20944
20945 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20946 @findex -symbol-info-address
20947
20948 @subsubheading Synopsis
20949
20950 @smallexample
20951 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20952 @end smallexample
20953
20954 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20955
20956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20957
20958 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20959
20960 @subsubheading Example
20961 N.A.
20962
20963
20964 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20965 @findex -symbol-info-file
20966
20967 @subsubheading Synopsis
20968
20969 @smallexample
20970 -symbol-info-file
20971 @end smallexample
20972
20973 Show the file for the symbol.
20974
20975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20976
20977 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20978 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20979
20980 @subsubheading Example
20981 N.A.
20982
20983
20984 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20985 @findex -symbol-info-function
20986
20987 @subsubheading Synopsis
20988
20989 @smallexample
20990 -symbol-info-function
20991 @end smallexample
20992
20993 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20994
20995 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20996
20997 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20998
20999 @subsubheading Example
21000 N.A.
21001
21002
21003 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
21004 @findex -symbol-info-line
21005
21006 @subsubheading Synopsis
21007
21008 @smallexample
21009 -symbol-info-line
21010 @end smallexample
21011
21012 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
21013
21014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21015
21016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
21017 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
21018
21019 @subsubheading Example
21020 N.A.
21021
21022
21023 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
21024 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
21025
21026 @subsubheading Synopsis
21027
21028 @smallexample
21029 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
21030 @end smallexample
21031
21032 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
21033
21034 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21035
21036 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
21037
21038 @subsubheading Example
21039 N.A.
21040
21041
21042 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
21043 @findex -symbol-list-functions
21044
21045 @subsubheading Synopsis
21046
21047 @smallexample
21048 -symbol-list-functions
21049 @end smallexample
21050
21051 List the functions in the executable.
21052
21053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21054
21055 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
21056 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21057
21058 @subsubheading Example
21059 N.A.
21060
21061
21062 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
21063 @findex -symbol-list-lines
21064
21065 @subsubheading Synopsis
21066
21067 @smallexample
21068 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
21069 @end smallexample
21070
21071 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
21072 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
21073 ascending PC order.
21074
21075 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21076
21077 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
21078
21079 @subsubheading Example
21080 @smallexample
21081 (gdb)
21082 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
21083 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
21084 (gdb)
21085 @end smallexample
21086
21087
21088 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
21089 @findex -symbol-list-types
21090
21091 @subsubheading Synopsis
21092
21093 @smallexample
21094 -symbol-list-types
21095 @end smallexample
21096
21097 List all the type names.
21098
21099 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21100
21101 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
21102 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21103
21104 @subsubheading Example
21105 N.A.
21106
21107
21108 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
21109 @findex -symbol-list-variables
21110
21111 @subsubheading Synopsis
21112
21113 @smallexample
21114 -symbol-list-variables
21115 @end smallexample
21116
21117 List all the global and static variable names.
21118
21119 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21120
21121 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21122
21123 @subsubheading Example
21124 N.A.
21125
21126
21127 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
21128 @findex -symbol-locate
21129
21130 @subsubheading Synopsis
21131
21132 @smallexample
21133 -symbol-locate
21134 @end smallexample
21135
21136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21137
21138 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
21139
21140 @subsubheading Example
21141 N.A.
21142
21143
21144 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
21145 @findex -symbol-type
21146
21147 @subsubheading Synopsis
21148
21149 @smallexample
21150 -symbol-type @var{variable}
21151 @end smallexample
21152
21153 Show type of @var{variable}.
21154
21155 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21156
21157 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
21158 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
21159
21160 @subsubheading Example
21161 N.A.
21162
21163
21164 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21165 @node GDB/MI File Commands
21166 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
21167
21168 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
21169 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
21170
21171 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
21172 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
21173
21174 @subsubheading Synopsis
21175
21176 @smallexample
21177 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
21178 @end smallexample
21179
21180 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
21181 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
21182 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
21183 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
21184 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
21185 notification.
21186
21187 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21188
21189 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
21190
21191 @subsubheading Example
21192
21193 @smallexample
21194 (gdb)
21195 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21196 ^done
21197 (gdb)
21198 @end smallexample
21199
21200
21201 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
21202 @findex -file-exec-file
21203
21204 @subsubheading Synopsis
21205
21206 @smallexample
21207 -file-exec-file @var{file}
21208 @end smallexample
21209
21210 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
21211 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
21212 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
21213 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
21214 notification.
21215
21216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21217
21218 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
21219
21220 @subsubheading Example
21221
21222 @smallexample
21223 (gdb)
21224 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21225 ^done
21226 (gdb)
21227 @end smallexample
21228
21229
21230 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
21231 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
21232
21233 @subsubheading Synopsis
21234
21235 @smallexample
21236 -file-list-exec-sections
21237 @end smallexample
21238
21239 List the sections of the current executable file.
21240
21241 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21242
21243 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
21244 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
21245 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
21246
21247 @subsubheading Example
21248 N.A.
21249
21250
21251 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
21252 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
21253
21254 @subsubheading Synopsis
21255
21256 @smallexample
21257 -file-list-exec-source-file
21258 @end smallexample
21259
21260 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
21261 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
21262 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
21263 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
21264
21265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21266
21267 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
21268
21269 @subsubheading Example
21270
21271 @smallexample
21272 (gdb)
21273 123-file-list-exec-source-file
21274 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
21275 (gdb)
21276 @end smallexample
21277
21278
21279 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
21280 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
21281
21282 @subsubheading Synopsis
21283
21284 @smallexample
21285 -file-list-exec-source-files
21286 @end smallexample
21287
21288 List the source files for the current executable.
21289
21290 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
21291 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
21292
21293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21294
21295 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
21296 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
21297
21298 @subsubheading Example
21299 @smallexample
21300 (gdb)
21301 -file-list-exec-source-files
21302 ^done,files=[
21303 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21304 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21305 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21306 (gdb)
21307 @end smallexample
21308
21309 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21310 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21311
21312 @subsubheading Synopsis
21313
21314 @smallexample
21315 -file-list-shared-libraries
21316 @end smallexample
21317
21318 List the shared libraries in the program.
21319
21320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21321
21322 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21323
21324 @subsubheading Example
21325 N.A.
21326
21327
21328 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21329 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
21330
21331 @subsubheading Synopsis
21332
21333 @smallexample
21334 -file-list-symbol-files
21335 @end smallexample
21336
21337 List symbol files.
21338
21339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21340
21341 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21342
21343 @subsubheading Example
21344 N.A.
21345
21346
21347 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21348 @findex -file-symbol-file
21349
21350 @subsubheading Synopsis
21351
21352 @smallexample
21353 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21354 @end smallexample
21355
21356 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21357 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21358 produced, except for a completion notification.
21359
21360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21361
21362 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21363
21364 @subsubheading Example
21365
21366 @smallexample
21367 (gdb)
21368 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21369 ^done
21370 (gdb)
21371 @end smallexample
21372
21373 @ignore
21374 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21375 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21376 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21377
21378 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21379
21380 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
21381
21382 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21383
21384 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21385
21386 @c @subheading -overlay-map
21387
21388 @c @subheading -overlay-off
21389
21390 @c @subheading -overlay-on
21391
21392 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21393
21394 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21395 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21396 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21397
21398 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21399
21400 @c @subheading -signal-handle
21401
21402 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21403
21404 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21405 @end ignore
21406
21407
21408 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21409 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21410 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21411
21412
21413 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21414 @findex -target-attach
21415
21416 @subsubheading Synopsis
21417
21418 @smallexample
21419 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21420 @end smallexample
21421
21422 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21423
21424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21425
21426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21427
21428 @subsubheading Example
21429 N.A.
21430
21431
21432 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21433 @findex -target-compare-sections
21434
21435 @subsubheading Synopsis
21436
21437 @smallexample
21438 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21439 @end smallexample
21440
21441 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21442 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21443
21444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21445
21446 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21447
21448 @subsubheading Example
21449 N.A.
21450
21451
21452 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21453 @findex -target-detach
21454
21455 @subsubheading Synopsis
21456
21457 @smallexample
21458 -target-detach
21459 @end smallexample
21460
21461 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21462 There's no output.
21463
21464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21465
21466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21467
21468 @subsubheading Example
21469
21470 @smallexample
21471 (gdb)
21472 -target-detach
21473 ^done
21474 (gdb)
21475 @end smallexample
21476
21477
21478 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21479 @findex -target-disconnect
21480
21481 @subsubheading Synopsis
21482
21483 @smallexample
21484 -target-disconnect
21485 @end smallexample
21486
21487 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21488 generally not resumed.
21489
21490 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21491
21492 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21493
21494 @subsubheading Example
21495
21496 @smallexample
21497 (gdb)
21498 -target-disconnect
21499 ^done
21500 (gdb)
21501 @end smallexample
21502
21503
21504 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21505 @findex -target-download
21506
21507 @subsubheading Synopsis
21508
21509 @smallexample
21510 -target-download
21511 @end smallexample
21512
21513 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21514 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21515
21516 @table @samp
21517 @item section
21518 The name of the section.
21519 @item section-sent
21520 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21521 @item section-size
21522 The size of the section.
21523 @item total-sent
21524 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21525 @item total-size
21526 The size of the overall executable to download.
21527 @end table
21528
21529 @noindent
21530 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21531 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21532
21533 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21534 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21535
21536 @table @samp
21537 @item section
21538 The name of the section.
21539 @item section-size
21540 The size of the section.
21541 @item total-size
21542 The size of the overall executable to download.
21543 @end table
21544
21545 @noindent
21546 At the end, a summary is printed.
21547
21548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21549
21550 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21551
21552 @subsubheading Example
21553
21554 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21555 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21556
21557 @smallexample
21558 (gdb)
21559 -target-download
21560 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21561 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21562 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21563 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21564 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21565 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21566 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21567 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21568 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21569 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21570 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21571 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21572 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21573 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21574 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21575 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21576 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21577 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21578 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21579 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21580 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21581 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21582 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21583 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21584 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21585 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21586 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21587 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21588 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21589 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21590 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21591 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21592 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21593 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21594 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21595 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21596 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21597 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21598 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21599 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21600 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21601 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21602 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21603 write-rate="429"
21604 (gdb)
21605 @end smallexample
21606
21607
21608 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21609 @findex -target-exec-status
21610
21611 @subsubheading Synopsis
21612
21613 @smallexample
21614 -target-exec-status
21615 @end smallexample
21616
21617 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21618 not, for instance).
21619
21620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21621
21622 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21623
21624 @subsubheading Example
21625 N.A.
21626
21627
21628 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21629 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21630
21631 @subsubheading Synopsis
21632
21633 @smallexample
21634 -target-list-available-targets
21635 @end smallexample
21636
21637 List the possible targets to connect to.
21638
21639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21640
21641 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21642
21643 @subsubheading Example
21644 N.A.
21645
21646
21647 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21648 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21649
21650 @subsubheading Synopsis
21651
21652 @smallexample
21653 -target-list-current-targets
21654 @end smallexample
21655
21656 Describe the current target.
21657
21658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21659
21660 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21661 other things).
21662
21663 @subsubheading Example
21664 N.A.
21665
21666
21667 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21668 @findex -target-list-parameters
21669
21670 @subsubheading Synopsis
21671
21672 @smallexample
21673 -target-list-parameters
21674 @end smallexample
21675
21676 @c ????
21677
21678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21679
21680 No equivalent.
21681
21682 @subsubheading Example
21683 N.A.
21684
21685
21686 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21687 @findex -target-select
21688
21689 @subsubheading Synopsis
21690
21691 @smallexample
21692 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21693 @end smallexample
21694
21695 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21696
21697 @table @samp
21698 @item @var{type}
21699 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21700 @item @var{parameters}
21701 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21702 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21703 @end table
21704
21705 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21706 which the target program is, in the following form:
21707
21708 @smallexample
21709 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21710 args=[@var{arg list}]
21711 @end smallexample
21712
21713 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21714
21715 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21716
21717 @subsubheading Example
21718
21719 @smallexample
21720 (gdb)
21721 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21722 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21723 (gdb)
21724 @end smallexample
21725
21726 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21727 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
21728 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
21729
21730
21731 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21732 @findex -target-file-put
21733
21734 @subsubheading Synopsis
21735
21736 @smallexample
21737 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21738 @end smallexample
21739
21740 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21741 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21742
21743 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21744
21745 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
21746
21747 @subsubheading Example
21748
21749 @smallexample
21750 (gdb)
21751 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
21752 ^done
21753 (gdb)
21754 @end smallexample
21755
21756
21757 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21758 @findex -target-file-get
21759
21760 @subsubheading Synopsis
21761
21762 @smallexample
21763 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21764 @end smallexample
21765
21766 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21767 on the host system.
21768
21769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21770
21771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
21772
21773 @subsubheading Example
21774
21775 @smallexample
21776 (gdb)
21777 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
21778 ^done
21779 (gdb)
21780 @end smallexample
21781
21782
21783 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
21784 @findex -target-file-delete
21785
21786 @subsubheading Synopsis
21787
21788 @smallexample
21789 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
21790 @end smallexample
21791
21792 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21793
21794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21795
21796 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
21797
21798 @subsubheading Example
21799
21800 @smallexample
21801 (gdb)
21802 -target-file-delete remotefile
21803 ^done
21804 (gdb)
21805 @end smallexample
21806
21807
21808 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21809 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21810 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21811
21812 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21813
21814 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21815 @findex -gdb-exit
21816
21817 @subsubheading Synopsis
21818
21819 @smallexample
21820 -gdb-exit
21821 @end smallexample
21822
21823 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21824
21825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21826
21827 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21828
21829 @subsubheading Example
21830
21831 @smallexample
21832 (gdb)
21833 -gdb-exit
21834 ^exit
21835 @end smallexample
21836
21837
21838 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21839 @findex -exec-abort
21840
21841 @subsubheading Synopsis
21842
21843 @smallexample
21844 -exec-abort
21845 @end smallexample
21846
21847 Kill the inferior running program.
21848
21849 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21850
21851 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21852
21853 @subsubheading Example
21854 N.A.
21855
21856
21857 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21858 @findex -gdb-set
21859
21860 @subsubheading Synopsis
21861
21862 @smallexample
21863 -gdb-set
21864 @end smallexample
21865
21866 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21867 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21868
21869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21870
21871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21872
21873 @subsubheading Example
21874
21875 @smallexample
21876 (gdb)
21877 -gdb-set $foo=3
21878 ^done
21879 (gdb)
21880 @end smallexample
21881
21882
21883 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21884 @findex -gdb-show
21885
21886 @subsubheading Synopsis
21887
21888 @smallexample
21889 -gdb-show
21890 @end smallexample
21891
21892 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21893
21894 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21895
21896 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21897
21898 @subsubheading Example
21899
21900 @smallexample
21901 (gdb)
21902 -gdb-show annotate
21903 ^done,value="0"
21904 (gdb)
21905 @end smallexample
21906
21907 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21908
21909
21910 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21911 @findex -gdb-version
21912
21913 @subsubheading Synopsis
21914
21915 @smallexample
21916 -gdb-version
21917 @end smallexample
21918
21919 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21920
21921 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21922
21923 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21924 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21925
21926 @subsubheading Example
21927
21928 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21929 @c box in TeX.
21930 @smallexample
21931 (gdb)
21932 -gdb-version
21933 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21934 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21935 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21936 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21937 ~ certain conditions.
21938 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21939 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21940 ~ details.
21941 ~This GDB was configured as
21942 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21943 ^done
21944 (gdb)
21945 @end smallexample
21946
21947 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
21948 @findex -list-features
21949
21950 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
21951 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
21952 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
21953 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
21954 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
21955 startup.
21956
21957 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
21958 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
21959 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
21960 is given below.
21961
21962 Example output:
21963
21964 @smallexample
21965 (gdb) -list-features
21966 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
21967 @end smallexample
21968
21969 The current list of features is:
21970
21971 @itemize @minus
21972 @item
21973 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
21974 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
21975 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
21976 @item
21977 @samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
21978 option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
21979 @item
21980 @samp{thread-info}---indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
21981
21982 @end itemize
21983
21984 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21985 @findex -interpreter-exec
21986
21987 @subheading Synopsis
21988
21989 @smallexample
21990 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21991 @end smallexample
21992 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21993
21994 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21995
21996 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21997
21998 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21999
22000 @subheading Example
22001
22002 @smallexample
22003 (gdb)
22004 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
22005 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
22006 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
22007 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
22008 ^done
22009 (gdb)
22010 @end smallexample
22011
22012 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
22013 @findex -inferior-tty-set
22014
22015 @subheading Synopsis
22016
22017 @smallexample
22018 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22019 @end smallexample
22020
22021 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
22022
22023 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22024
22025 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
22026
22027 @subheading Example
22028
22029 @smallexample
22030 (gdb)
22031 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22032 ^done
22033 (gdb)
22034 @end smallexample
22035
22036 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
22037 @findex -inferior-tty-show
22038
22039 @subheading Synopsis
22040
22041 @smallexample
22042 -inferior-tty-show
22043 @end smallexample
22044
22045 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
22046
22047 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22048
22049 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
22050
22051 @subheading Example
22052
22053 @smallexample
22054 (gdb)
22055 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22056 ^done
22057 (gdb)
22058 -inferior-tty-show
22059 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
22060 (gdb)
22061 @end smallexample
22062
22063 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
22064 @findex -enable-timings
22065
22066 @subheading Synopsis
22067
22068 @smallexample
22069 -enable-timings [yes | no]
22070 @end smallexample
22071
22072 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
22073 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
22074 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
22075 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
22076
22077 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22078
22079 No equivalent.
22080
22081 @subheading Example
22082
22083 @smallexample
22084 (gdb)
22085 -enable-timings
22086 ^done
22087 (gdb)
22088 -break-insert main
22089 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22090 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
22091 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
22092 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
22093 (gdb)
22094 -enable-timings no
22095 ^done
22096 (gdb)
22097 -exec-run
22098 ^running
22099 (gdb)
22100 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
22101 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
22102 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
22103 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
22104 (gdb)
22105 @end smallexample
22106
22107 @node Annotations
22108 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
22109
22110 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
22111 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
22112 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
22113 relatively high level.
22114
22115 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
22116 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
22117
22118 @ignore
22119 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
22120 @end ignore
22121
22122 @menu
22123 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
22124 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
22125 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
22126 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
22127 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
22128 * Annotations for Running::
22129 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
22130 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
22131 @end menu
22132
22133 @node Annotations Overview
22134 @section What is an Annotation?
22135 @cindex annotations
22136
22137 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
22138 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
22139 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
22140 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
22141 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
22142 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
22143 cannot contain newline characters.
22144
22145 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
22146 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
22147 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
22148 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
22149 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
22150 means those three characters as output.
22151
22152 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
22153 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
22154 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
22155 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
22156 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
22157 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
22158 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
22159 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
22160 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
22161
22162 @table @code
22163 @kindex set annotate
22164 @item set annotate @var{level}
22165 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
22166 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
22167
22168 @item show annotate
22169 @kindex show annotate
22170 Show the current annotation level.
22171 @end table
22172
22173 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
22174
22175 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
22176
22177 @smallexample
22178 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
22179 GNU gdb 6.0
22180 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22181 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
22182 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
22183 under certain conditions.
22184 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22185 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
22186 for details.
22187 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
22188
22189 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22190 (@value{GDBP})
22191 ^Z^Zprompt
22192 @kbd{quit}
22193
22194 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22195 $
22196 @end smallexample
22197
22198 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
22199 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
22200 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
22201 output from @value{GDBN}.
22202
22203 @node Server Prefix
22204 @section The Server Prefix
22205 @cindex server prefix
22206
22207 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
22208 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
22209 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
22210 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
22211 a transparent manner.
22212
22213 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22214 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22215 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22216
22217 @node Prompting
22218 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
22219
22220 @cindex annotations for prompts
22221 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
22222 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
22223 over, etc.
22224
22225 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
22226 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
22227 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
22228 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
22229 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
22230 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
22231 features the following annotations:
22232
22233 @smallexample
22234 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22235 ^Z^Zprompt
22236 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22237 @end smallexample
22238
22239 The input types are
22240
22241 @table @code
22242 @findex pre-prompt annotation
22243 @findex prompt annotation
22244 @findex post-prompt annotation
22245 @item prompt
22246 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
22247
22248 @findex pre-commands annotation
22249 @findex commands annotation
22250 @findex post-commands annotation
22251 @item commands
22252 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
22253 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
22254
22255 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
22256 @findex overload-choice annotation
22257 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
22258 @item overload-choice
22259 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
22260
22261 @findex pre-query annotation
22262 @findex query annotation
22263 @findex post-query annotation
22264 @item query
22265 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
22266
22267 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
22268 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
22269 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
22270 @item prompt-for-continue
22271 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
22272 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
22273 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
22274 presence of annotations.
22275 @end table
22276
22277 @node Errors
22278 @section Errors
22279 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
22280
22281 @findex quit annotation
22282 @smallexample
22283 ^Z^Zquit
22284 @end smallexample
22285
22286 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
22287
22288 @findex error annotation
22289 @smallexample
22290 ^Z^Zerror
22291 @end smallexample
22292
22293 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
22294
22295 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
22296 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
22297 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
22298 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
22299 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
22300 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
22301 to the top level.
22302
22303 @findex error-begin annotation
22304 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22305
22306 @smallexample
22307 ^Z^Zerror-begin
22308 @end smallexample
22309
22310 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22311 message.
22312
22313 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22314 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22315 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22316
22317 @node Invalidation
22318 @section Invalidation Notices
22319
22320 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22321 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22322 changed.
22323
22324 @table @code
22325 @findex frames-invalid annotation
22326 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22327
22328 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22329 have changed.
22330
22331 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22332 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22333
22334 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22335 deleted a breakpoint.
22336 @end table
22337
22338 @node Annotations for Running
22339 @section Running the Program
22340 @cindex annotations for running programs
22341
22342 @findex starting annotation
22343 @findex stopping annotation
22344 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
22345 @code{step} or @code{continue},
22346
22347 @smallexample
22348 ^Z^Zstarting
22349 @end smallexample
22350
22351 is output. When the program stops,
22352
22353 @smallexample
22354 ^Z^Zstopped
22355 @end smallexample
22356
22357 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22358 annotations describe how the program stopped.
22359
22360 @table @code
22361 @findex exited annotation
22362 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22363 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22364 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22365
22366 @findex signalled annotation
22367 @findex signal-name annotation
22368 @findex signal-name-end annotation
22369 @findex signal-string annotation
22370 @findex signal-string-end annotation
22371 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
22372 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22373 annotation continues:
22374
22375 @smallexample
22376 @var{intro-text}
22377 ^Z^Zsignal-name
22378 @var{name}
22379 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22380 @var{middle-text}
22381 ^Z^Zsignal-string
22382 @var{string}
22383 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22384 @var{end-text}
22385 @end smallexample
22386
22387 @noindent
22388 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22389 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22390 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22391 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22392 user's benefit and have no particular format.
22393
22394 @findex signal annotation
22395 @item ^Z^Zsignal
22396 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22397 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22398 terminated with it.
22399
22400 @findex breakpoint annotation
22401 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22402 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22403
22404 @findex watchpoint annotation
22405 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22406 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22407 @end table
22408
22409 @node Source Annotations
22410 @section Displaying Source
22411 @cindex annotations for source display
22412
22413 @findex source annotation
22414 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22415
22416 @smallexample
22417 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22418 @end smallexample
22419
22420 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22421 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22422 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22423 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22424 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22425 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22426 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22427 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22428 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22429 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22430 depend on the language).
22431
22432 @node GDB Bugs
22433 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22434 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22435 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22436
22437 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22438
22439 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22440 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22441 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22442 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22443
22444 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22445 information that enables us to fix the bug.
22446
22447 @menu
22448 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22449 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22450 @end menu
22451
22452 @node Bug Criteria
22453 @section Have You Found a Bug?
22454 @cindex bug criteria
22455
22456 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22457
22458 @itemize @bullet
22459 @cindex fatal signal
22460 @cindex debugger crash
22461 @cindex crash of debugger
22462 @item
22463 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22464 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22465
22466 @cindex error on valid input
22467 @item
22468 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22469 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22470 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22471
22472 @cindex invalid input
22473 @item
22474 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22475 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22476 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22477 for traditional practice''.
22478
22479 @item
22480 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22481 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22482 @end itemize
22483
22484 @node Bug Reporting
22485 @section How to Report Bugs
22486 @cindex bug reports
22487 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22488
22489 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22490 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22491 contact that organization first.
22492
22493 You can find contact information for many support companies and
22494 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22495 distribution.
22496 @c should add a web page ref...
22497
22498 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22499 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22500 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22501 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22502 be used.
22503
22504 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22505 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22506 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22507 @samp{bug-gdb}.
22508
22509 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22510 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22511 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22512 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22513 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22514 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22515 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22516 bug reports to the mailing list.
22517
22518 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22519 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22520 fact or leave it out, state it!
22521
22522 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22523 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22524 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22525 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22526 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22527 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22528 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22529 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22530 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22531
22532 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22533 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22534 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22535 self-contained.
22536
22537 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22538 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22539 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22540 bugs properly.
22541
22542 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22543
22544 @itemize @bullet
22545 @item
22546 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22547 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22548 version}.
22549
22550 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22551 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22552
22553 @item
22554 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22555 version number.
22556
22557 @item
22558 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22559 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22560
22561 @item
22562 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22563 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22564 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22565 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22566 those compilers.
22567
22568 @item
22569 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22570 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22571 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22572 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22573
22574 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22575 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22576
22577 @item
22578 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22579 reproduce the bug.
22580
22581 @item
22582 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22583 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22584
22585 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22586 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22587 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22588 a chance to make a mistake.
22589
22590 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22591 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22592 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22593 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22594 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22595 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22596 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22597 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22598
22599 @pindex script
22600 @cindex recording a session script
22601 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22602 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22603 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22604 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22605
22606 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22607 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22608
22609 @item
22610 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22611 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22612 it by context, not by line number.
22613
22614 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22615 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22616
22617 @end itemize
22618
22619 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22620
22621 @itemize @bullet
22622 @item
22623 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22624
22625 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22626 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22627 changes will not affect it.
22628
22629 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22630 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22631 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22632 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22633
22634 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22635 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22636 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22637 less time, and so on.
22638
22639 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22640 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22641
22642 @item
22643 A patch for the bug.
22644
22645 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22646 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22647 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22648 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22649
22650 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22651 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22652 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22653 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22654
22655 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22656 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22657 help us to understand.
22658
22659 @item
22660 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22661
22662 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22663 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22664 @end itemize
22665
22666 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22667 @c and consists of the two following files:
22668 @c rluser.texinfo
22669 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22670 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22671 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22672 @include rluser.texi
22673 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22674
22675
22676 @node Formatting Documentation
22677 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22678
22679 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22680 @cindex reference card
22681 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22682 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22683 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22684 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22685 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22686 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22687
22688 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22689 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22690
22691 @smallexample
22692 make refcard.dvi
22693 @end smallexample
22694
22695 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22696 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22697 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22698 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22699 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22700
22701 @cindex documentation
22702
22703 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22704 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22705 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22706 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22707 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22708 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22709
22710 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22711 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22712 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22713 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22714 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22715 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22716 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22717 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22718
22719 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22720 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22721 @code{makeinfo}.
22722
22723 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22724 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22725 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22726
22727 @smallexample
22728 cd gdb
22729 make gdb.info
22730 @end smallexample
22731
22732 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22733 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22734 Texinfo definitions file.
22735
22736 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22737 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22738 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22739 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22740 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22741 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22742 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22743
22744 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22745 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22746 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22747 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22748 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22749 directory.
22750
22751 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22752 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22753 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22754 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22755
22756 @smallexample
22757 make gdb.dvi
22758 @end smallexample
22759
22760 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22761
22762 @node Installing GDB
22763 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22764 @cindex installation
22765
22766 @menu
22767 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22768 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22769 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22770 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22771 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22772 @end menu
22773
22774 @node Requirements
22775 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22776 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22777
22778 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22779 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22780
22781 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22782 @table @asis
22783 @item ISO C90 compiler
22784 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22785 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22786
22787 @end table
22788
22789 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22790 @table @asis
22791 @item Expat
22792 @anchor{Expat}
22793 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22794 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22795 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22796 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22797 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22798 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22799
22800 Expat is used for:
22801
22802 @itemize @bullet
22803 @item
22804 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22805 @item
22806 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22807 @item
22808 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22809 @item
22810 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22811 @end itemize
22812
22813 @item zlib
22814 @cindex compressed debug sections
22815 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
22816 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
22817 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
22818 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
22819 information in such binaries.
22820
22821 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
22822 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
22823 @url{http://zlib.net}.
22824
22825 @end table
22826
22827 @node Running Configure
22828 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22829 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22830 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22831 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22832 build the @code{gdb} program.
22833 @iftex
22834 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22835 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22836 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22837 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22838 @end iftex
22839
22840 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22841 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22842 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22843
22844 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22845 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22846
22847 @table @code
22848 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22849 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22850
22851 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22852 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22853
22854 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22855 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22856
22857 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22858 @sc{gnu} include files
22859
22860 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22861 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22862
22863 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22864 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22865
22866 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22867 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22868
22869 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22870 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22871
22872 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22873 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22874 @end table
22875
22876 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22877 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22878 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22879
22880 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22881 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22882 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22883 argument.
22884
22885 For example:
22886
22887 @smallexample
22888 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22889 ./configure @var{host}
22890 make
22891 @end smallexample
22892
22893 @noindent
22894 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22895 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22896 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22897 correct value by examining your system.)
22898
22899 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22900 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22901 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22902 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22903
22904 @need 750
22905 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22906 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22907 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22908
22909 @smallexample
22910 sh configure @var{host}
22911 @end smallexample
22912
22913 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22914 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22915 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22916 @file{configure}
22917 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22918 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22919
22920 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22921 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22922 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22923 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22924 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22925 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22926 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22927 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22928 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22929
22930 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22931 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22932 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22933 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22934 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22935
22936 @node Separate Objdir
22937 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22938
22939 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22940 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22941 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22942 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22943 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22944 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22945 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22946 program specified there.
22947
22948 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22949 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22950 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22951 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22952 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22953 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22954
22955 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22956 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22957
22958 @smallexample
22959 @group
22960 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22961 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22962 cd ../gdb-sun4
22963 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22964 make
22965 @end group
22966 @end smallexample
22967
22968 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22969 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22970 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22971 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22972 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22973 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22974
22975 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22976 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22977 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22978 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22979 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22980
22981 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22982 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22983 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22984 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22985 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22986 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22987
22988 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22989 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22990 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22991
22992 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22993 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22994 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22995 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22996 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22997
22998 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22999 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
23000 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
23001 with each other.
23002
23003 @node Config Names
23004 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
23005
23006 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
23007 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
23008 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
23009 of information in the following pattern:
23010
23011 @smallexample
23012 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
23013 @end smallexample
23014
23015 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
23016 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
23017 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
23018
23019 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
23020 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
23021 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
23022 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
23023 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
23024 abbreviations---for example:
23025
23026 @smallexample
23027 % sh config.sub i386-linux
23028 i386-pc-linux-gnu
23029 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
23030 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
23031 % sh config.sub hp9k700
23032 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
23033 % sh config.sub sun4
23034 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
23035 % sh config.sub sun3
23036 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
23037 % sh config.sub i986v
23038 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
23039 @end smallexample
23040
23041 @noindent
23042 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
23043 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
23044
23045 @node Configure Options
23046 @section @file{configure} Options
23047
23048 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
23049 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
23050 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
23051 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
23052
23053 @smallexample
23054 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
23055 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23056 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23057 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
23058 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
23059 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
23060 @var{host}
23061 @end smallexample
23062
23063 @noindent
23064 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
23065 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
23066 @samp{--}.
23067
23068 @table @code
23069 @item --help
23070 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
23071
23072 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
23073 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
23074 @file{@var{dir}}.
23075
23076 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
23077 Configure the source to install programs under directory
23078 @file{@var{dir}}.
23079
23080 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
23081 @need 2000
23082 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
23083 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
23084 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
23085 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
23086 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
23087 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
23088 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
23089 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
23090 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
23091 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
23092 @var{dirname}.
23093
23094 @item --norecursion
23095 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
23096 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
23097
23098 @item --target=@var{target}
23099 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
23100 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
23101 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
23102
23103 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
23104
23105 @item @var{host} @dots{}
23106 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
23107
23108 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
23109 @end table
23110
23111 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
23112 needed for special purposes only.
23113
23114 @node Maintenance Commands
23115 @appendix Maintenance Commands
23116 @cindex maintenance commands
23117 @cindex internal commands
23118
23119 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
23120 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
23121 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
23122 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
23123 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
23124
23125 @table @code
23126 @kindex maint agent
23127 @item maint agent @var{expression}
23128 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
23129 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
23130 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
23131
23132 @kindex maint info breakpoints
23133 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
23134 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
23135 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
23136 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
23137 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
23138 is shown:
23139
23140 @table @code
23141 @item breakpoint
23142 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
23143
23144 @item watchpoint
23145 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
23146
23147 @item longjmp
23148 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
23149 @code{longjmp} calls.
23150
23151 @item longjmp resume
23152 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
23153
23154 @item until
23155 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
23156
23157 @item finish
23158 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
23159
23160 @item shlib events
23161 Shared library events.
23162
23163 @end table
23164
23165 @kindex maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23166 @kindex maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23167 @cindex displaced stepping support
23168 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
23169 @item maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23170 @itemx maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23171 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
23172 if the target supports it. The default is on. Displaced stepping is
23173 a way to single-step over breakpoints without removing them from the
23174 inferior, by executing an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was
23175 originally at the breakpoint location. It is also known as
23176 out-of-line single-stepping.
23177
23178 @kindex maint check-symtabs
23179 @item maint check-symtabs
23180 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
23181
23182 @kindex maint cplus first_component
23183 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
23184 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
23185
23186 @kindex maint cplus namespace
23187 @item maint cplus namespace
23188 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
23189
23190 @kindex maint demangle
23191 @item maint demangle @var{name}
23192 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
23193
23194 @kindex maint deprecate
23195 @kindex maint undeprecate
23196 @cindex deprecated commands
23197 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
23198 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
23199 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
23200 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
23201 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
23202 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
23203 the replacement as part of the warning.
23204
23205 @kindex maint dump-me
23206 @item maint dump-me
23207 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
23208 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
23209 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
23210 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
23211
23212 @kindex maint internal-error
23213 @kindex maint internal-warning
23214 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23215 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23216 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
23217 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
23218 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
23219 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
23220 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
23221 @value{GDBN} session.
23222
23223 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
23224 used as the text of the error or warning message.
23225
23226 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
23227
23228 @smallexample
23229 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
23230 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
23231 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
23232 debugging may prove unreliable.
23233 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23234 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23235 (@value{GDBP})
23236 @end smallexample
23237
23238 @kindex maint packet
23239 @item maint packet @var{text}
23240 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
23241 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
23242 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
23243 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
23244 checksum.
23245
23246 @kindex maint print architecture
23247 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23248 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
23249 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
23250
23251 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
23252 @item maint print c-tdesc
23253 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
23254 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
23255 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
23256
23257 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
23258 @item maint print dummy-frames
23259 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
23260
23261 @smallexample
23262 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
23263 @dots{}
23264 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
23265 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
23266 58 return (a + b);
23267 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
23268 @dots{}
23269 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
23270 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
23271 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
23272 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
23273 (@value{GDBP})
23274 @end smallexample
23275
23276 Takes an optional file parameter.
23277
23278 @kindex maint print registers
23279 @kindex maint print raw-registers
23280 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
23281 @kindex maint print register-groups
23282 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23283 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23284 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23285 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23286 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
23287
23288 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
23289 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
23290 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
23291 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
23292 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
23293 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
23294
23295 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
23296 write the information.
23297
23298 @kindex maint print reggroups
23299 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23300 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
23301 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
23302 information.
23303
23304 The register groups info looks like this:
23305
23306 @smallexample
23307 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
23308 Group Type
23309 general user
23310 float user
23311 all user
23312 vector user
23313 system user
23314 save internal
23315 restore internal
23316 @end smallexample
23317
23318 @kindex flushregs
23319 @item flushregs
23320 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
23321
23322 @kindex maint print objfiles
23323 @cindex info for known object files
23324 @item maint print objfiles
23325 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
23326 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
23327 and symtabs.
23328
23329 @kindex maint print statistics
23330 @cindex bcache statistics
23331 @item maint print statistics
23332 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23333 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23334 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23335 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
23336 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
23337 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
23338 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
23339 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
23340 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
23341 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
23342 lengths.
23343
23344 @kindex maint print target-stack
23345 @cindex target stack description
23346 @item maint print target-stack
23347 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
23348 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
23349 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
23350 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
23351 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
23352 address.
23353
23354 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
23355 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
23356
23357 @kindex maint print type
23358 @cindex type chain of a data type
23359 @item maint print type @var{expr}
23360 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
23361 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
23362 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
23363 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
23364 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
23365
23366 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23367 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23368 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23369 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23370 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
23371
23372 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23373 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23374 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23375 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23376 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23377 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23378 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23379 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23380 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23381
23382 @kindex maint set profile
23383 @kindex maint show profile
23384 @cindex profiling GDB
23385 @item maint set profile
23386 @itemx maint show profile
23387 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23388
23389 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23390 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23391 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23392 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23393 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23394 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23395 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23396
23397 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23398 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23399
23400 @kindex maint set linux-async
23401 @kindex maint show linux-async
23402 @cindex asynchronous support
23403 @item maint set linux-async
23404 @itemx maint show linux-async
23405 Control the GNU/Linux native asynchronous support of @value{GDBN}.
23406
23407 GNU/Linux native asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
23408 the @samp{maint set linux-async} command to enable it.
23409
23410 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
23411 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23412 @item maint show-debug-regs
23413 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23414 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23415 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23416 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23417 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23418
23419 @kindex maint space
23420 @cindex memory used by commands
23421 @item maint space
23422 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23423 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23424 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23425 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23426 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23427
23428 @kindex maint time
23429 @cindex time of command execution
23430 @item maint time
23431 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23432 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23433 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23434 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23435 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23436
23437 @kindex maint translate-address
23438 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23439 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23440 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23441 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23442 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23443 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23444 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23445
23446 @end table
23447
23448 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23449 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23450
23451 @table @code
23452 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23453 @kindex set watchdog
23454 @cindex watchdog timer
23455 @cindex timeout for commands
23456 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23457 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23458 reports and error and the command is aborted.
23459
23460 @item show watchdog
23461 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23462 @end table
23463
23464 @node Remote Protocol
23465 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23466
23467 @menu
23468 * Overview::
23469 * Packets::
23470 * Stop Reply Packets::
23471 * General Query Packets::
23472 * Register Packet Format::
23473 * Tracepoint Packets::
23474 * Host I/O Packets::
23475 * Interrupts::
23476 * Examples::
23477 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23478 * Library List Format::
23479 * Memory Map Format::
23480 @end menu
23481
23482 @node Overview
23483 @section Overview
23484
23485 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23486 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23487 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23488 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23489
23490 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23491 transmitted and received data, respectively.
23492
23493 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23494 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23495 @cindex remote serial protocol
23496 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23497 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23498 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23499 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23500
23501 @smallexample
23502 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23503 @end smallexample
23504 @noindent
23505
23506 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23507 @noindent
23508 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23509 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23510 eight bit unsigned checksum).
23511
23512 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23513 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23514
23515 @smallexample
23516 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23517 @end smallexample
23518
23519 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23520 @noindent
23521 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23522 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23523 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23524
23525 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23526 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23527 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23528 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23529 retransmission):
23530
23531 @smallexample
23532 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23533 <- @code{+}
23534 @end smallexample
23535 @noindent
23536
23537 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23538 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23539 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23540 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23541
23542 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23543 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23544 exceptions).
23545
23546 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
23547 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23548 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23549 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23550
23551 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23552 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23553 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23554
23555 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
23556 @anchor{Binary Data}
23557 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23558 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23559 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23560 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23561 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23562 binary data.
23563
23564 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23565 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23566 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23567 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23568 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23569 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23570 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23571 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23572 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23573 (described next).
23574
23575 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23576 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23577 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23578 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23579 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23580 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23581 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23582 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23583 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23584 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23585 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
23586 3}} more times.
23587
23588 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23589 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23590 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23591 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23592 @samp{0*"00}.
23593
23594 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23595 error number. That number is not well defined.
23596
23597 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23598 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23599 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23600 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23601 on that response.
23602
23603 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23604 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23605 optional.
23606
23607 @node Packets
23608 @section Packets
23609
23610 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23611 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23612 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23613 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23614
23615 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23616 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23617 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23618 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23619 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23620 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23621 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23622 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23623 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23624 @var{baz}.
23625
23626 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23627 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23628
23629 Here are the packet descriptions.
23630
23631 @table @samp
23632
23633 @item !
23634 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23635 @anchor{extended mode}
23636 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23637 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23638 debugged.
23639
23640 Reply:
23641 @table @samp
23642 @item OK
23643 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23644 @end table
23645
23646 @item ?
23647 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23648 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23649 step and continue.
23650
23651 Reply:
23652 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23653
23654 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23655 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23656 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23657 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23658 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23659
23660 Reply:
23661 @table @samp
23662 @item OK
23663 The arguments were set.
23664 @item E @var{NN}
23665 An error occurred.
23666 @end table
23667
23668 @item b @var{baud}
23669 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23670 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23671 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23672
23673 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23674 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23675 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23676
23677 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23678 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23679 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23680 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23681 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23682
23683 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23684 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23685 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23686 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23687
23688 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23689 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23690
23691 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23692 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23693 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23694 resume at current address.
23695
23696 Reply:
23697 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23698
23699 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23700 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23701 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23702 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23703
23704 Reply:
23705 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23706
23707 @item d
23708 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23709 Toggle debug flag.
23710
23711 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23712 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23713
23714 @item D
23715 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23716 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23717 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23718
23719 Reply:
23720 @table @samp
23721 @item OK
23722 for success
23723 @item E @var{NN}
23724 for an error
23725 @end table
23726
23727 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23728 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23729 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23730 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23731 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23732
23733 @item g
23734 @anchor{read registers packet}
23735 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23736 Read general registers.
23737
23738 Reply:
23739 @table @samp
23740 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23741 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23742 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23743 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23744 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23745 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23746 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23747 @item E @var{NN}
23748 for an error.
23749 @end table
23750
23751 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23752 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23753 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23754 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23755
23756 Reply:
23757 @table @samp
23758 @item OK
23759 for success
23760 @item E @var{NN}
23761 for an error
23762 @end table
23763
23764 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23765 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23766 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23767 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23768 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23769 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23770 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23771
23772 Reply:
23773 @table @samp
23774 @item OK
23775 for success
23776 @item E @var{NN}
23777 for an error
23778 @end table
23779
23780 @c FIXME: JTC:
23781 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23782 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23783 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23784 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23785 @c described. For example:
23786 @c
23787 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23788 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23789 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23790 @c
23791 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23792 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23793 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23794
23795 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23796 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23797 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23798 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23799 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23800 step starting at that address.
23801
23802 @item I
23803 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23804 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23805 step packet}.
23806
23807 @item k
23808 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23809 Kill request.
23810
23811 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23812 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23813 thread?)}.
23814
23815 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23816 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23817 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23818 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23819
23820 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23821 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23822 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23823 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23824 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23825 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23826 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23827 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23828
23829 Reply:
23830 @table @samp
23831 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23832 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23833 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23834 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23835 @item E @var{NN}
23836 @var{NN} is errno
23837 @end table
23838
23839 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23840 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23841 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23842 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23843 hexadecimal number.
23844
23845 Reply:
23846 @table @samp
23847 @item OK
23848 for success
23849 @item E @var{NN}
23850 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23851 written).
23852 @end table
23853
23854 @item p @var{n}
23855 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23856 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23857 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23858 register value is encoded.
23859
23860 Reply:
23861 @table @samp
23862 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23863 the register's value
23864 @item E @var{NN}
23865 for an error
23866 @item
23867 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23868 @end table
23869
23870 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23871 @anchor{write register packet}
23872 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23873 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23874 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23875 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23876
23877 Reply:
23878 @table @samp
23879 @item OK
23880 for success
23881 @item E @var{NN}
23882 for an error
23883 @end table
23884
23885 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23886 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23887 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23888 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23889 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23890 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23891
23892 @item r
23893 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23894 Reset the entire system.
23895
23896 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23897
23898 @item R @var{XX}
23899 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23900 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23901 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23902
23903 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23904
23905 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23906 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23907 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23908 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23909
23910 Reply:
23911 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23912
23913 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23914 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23915 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23916 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23917 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23918
23919 Reply:
23920 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23921
23922 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23923 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23924 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23925 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23926 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23927
23928 @item T @var{XX}
23929 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23930 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23931
23932 Reply:
23933 @table @samp
23934 @item OK
23935 thread is still alive
23936 @item E @var{NN}
23937 thread is dead
23938 @end table
23939
23940 @item v
23941 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23942 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23943
23944 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
23945 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
23946 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
23947 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. If the stub is currently
23948 controlling a process, it is killed. The attached process is stopped.
23949
23950 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23951
23952 Reply:
23953 @table @samp
23954 @item E @var{nn}
23955 for an error
23956 @item @r{Any stop packet}
23957 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
23958 @end table
23959
23960 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23961 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23962 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23963 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23964 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23965 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23966 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23967 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23968
23969 @table @samp
23970 @item c
23971 Continue.
23972 @item C @var{sig}
23973 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23974 @item s
23975 Step.
23976 @item S @var{sig}
23977 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23978 @end table
23979
23980 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23981 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23982
23983 Reply:
23984 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23985
23986 @item vCont?
23987 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23988 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23989
23990 Reply:
23991 @table @samp
23992 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23993 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23994 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23995 @item
23996 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23997 @end table
23998
23999 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
24000 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
24001 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
24002 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
24003
24004 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
24005 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
24006 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
24007 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
24008 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
24009 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
24010 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
24011 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
24012 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24013 packet is received.
24014
24015 Reply:
24016 @table @samp
24017 @item OK
24018 for success
24019 @item E @var{NN}
24020 for an error
24021 @end table
24022
24023 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24024 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
24025 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
24026 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
24027 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
24028 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
24029 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
24030 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
24031 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
24032 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
24033 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
24034 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
24035
24036
24037 Reply:
24038 @table @samp
24039 @item OK
24040 for success
24041 @item E.memtype
24042 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
24043 @item E @var{NN}
24044 for an error
24045 @end table
24046
24047 @item vFlashDone
24048 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
24049 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
24050 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
24051 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
24052 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
24053 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24054 request is completed.
24055
24056 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
24057 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
24058 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
24059 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
24060 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
24061 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
24062 state. If the stub is currently controlling a process, it is killed.
24063
24064 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24065
24066 Reply:
24067 @table @samp
24068 @item E @var{nn}
24069 for an error
24070 @item @r{Any stop packet}
24071 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24072 @end table
24073
24074 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24075 @anchor{X packet}
24076 @cindex @samp{X} packet
24077 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
24078 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
24079 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24080
24081 Reply:
24082 @table @samp
24083 @item OK
24084 for success
24085 @item E @var{NN}
24086 for an error
24087 @end table
24088
24089 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24090 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24091 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
24092 @cindex @samp{z} packet
24093 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
24094 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
24095 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
24096 @var{length} bytes.
24097
24098 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
24099 separately.
24100
24101 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
24102 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
24103 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
24104 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
24105 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
24106 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
24107
24108 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24109 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24110 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
24111 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
24112 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
24113 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24114
24115 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
24116 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
24117 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
24118 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
24119 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
24120
24121 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
24122 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
24123 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
24124 target, is not defined.}
24125
24126 Reply:
24127 @table @samp
24128 @item OK
24129 success
24130 @item
24131 not supported
24132 @item E @var{NN}
24133 for an error
24134 @end table
24135
24136 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24137 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24138 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
24139 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
24140 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
24141 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24142
24143 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
24144 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
24145
24146 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
24147 movement.}
24148
24149 Reply:
24150 @table @samp
24151 @item OK
24152 success
24153 @item
24154 not supported
24155 @item E @var{NN}
24156 for an error
24157 @end table
24158
24159 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24160 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24161 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
24162 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
24163 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
24164
24165 Reply:
24166 @table @samp
24167 @item OK
24168 success
24169 @item
24170 not supported
24171 @item E @var{NN}
24172 for an error
24173 @end table
24174
24175 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24176 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24177 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
24178 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
24179 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
24180
24181 Reply:
24182 @table @samp
24183 @item OK
24184 success
24185 @item
24186 not supported
24187 @item E @var{NN}
24188 for an error
24189 @end table
24190
24191 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24192 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24193 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
24194 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
24195 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
24196
24197 Reply:
24198 @table @samp
24199 @item OK
24200 success
24201 @item
24202 not supported
24203 @item E @var{NN}
24204 for an error
24205 @end table
24206
24207 @end table
24208
24209 @node Stop Reply Packets
24210 @section Stop Reply Packets
24211 @cindex stop reply packets
24212
24213 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
24214 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
24215 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
24216 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
24217 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
24218 @value{GDBN} source code.
24219
24220 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
24221 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
24222 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
24223 components.
24224
24225 @table @samp
24226
24227 @item S @var{AA}
24228 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24229 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
24230 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
24231
24232 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
24233 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
24234 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24235 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
24236 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
24237 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
24238 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
24239 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
24240
24241 @itemize @bullet
24242 @item
24243 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
24244 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
24245 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
24246 two-digit hex number.
24247
24248 @item
24249 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
24250 hex.
24251
24252 @item
24253 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
24254 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
24255 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
24256 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
24257
24258 @item
24259 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
24260 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
24261 future.
24262 @end itemize
24263
24264 The currently defined stop reasons are:
24265
24266 @table @samp
24267 @item watch
24268 @itemx rwatch
24269 @itemx awatch
24270 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
24271 hex.
24272
24273 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
24274 @item library
24275 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
24276 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
24277 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
24278 @end table
24279
24280 @item W @var{AA}
24281 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
24282 applicable to certain targets.
24283
24284 @item X @var{AA}
24285 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
24286
24287 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
24288 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
24289 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
24290 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
24291 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
24292
24293 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
24294 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
24295 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
24296 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
24297 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
24298 system calls.
24299
24300 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
24301 this very system call.
24302
24303 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
24304 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
24305 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
24306 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24307 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
24308 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
24309
24310 @end table
24311
24312 @node General Query Packets
24313 @section General Query Packets
24314 @cindex remote query requests
24315
24316 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
24317 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
24318 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
24319 sending information to and from the stub.
24320
24321 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
24322 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
24323 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
24324 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
24325 conventions:
24326
24327 @itemize @bullet
24328 @item
24329 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
24330 @item
24331 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
24332 letter.
24333 @item
24334 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
24335 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
24336 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
24337 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
24338 @end itemize
24339
24340 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
24341 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
24342 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
24343 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
24344 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
24345 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
24346 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
24347 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
24348 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
24349 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
24350 packet.}.
24351
24352 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
24353 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
24354 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
24355 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
24356 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
24357
24358 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
24359
24360 @table @samp
24361
24362 @item qC
24363 @cindex current thread, remote request
24364 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
24365 Return the current thread id.
24366
24367 Reply:
24368 @table @samp
24369 @item QC @var{pid}
24370 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
24371 @item @r{(anything else)}
24372 Any other reply implies the old pid.
24373 @end table
24374
24375 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
24376 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
24377 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
24378 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
24379 Reply:
24380 @table @samp
24381 @item E @var{NN}
24382 An error (such as memory fault)
24383 @item C @var{crc32}
24384 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
24385 @end table
24386
24387 @item qfThreadInfo
24388 @itemx qsThreadInfo
24389 @cindex list active threads, remote request
24390 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
24391 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
24392 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
24393 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
24394 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
24395 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
24396 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
24397 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
24398
24399 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
24400
24401 Reply:
24402 @table @samp
24403 @item m @var{id}
24404 A single thread id
24405 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
24406 a comma-separated list of thread ids
24407 @item l
24408 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
24409 @end table
24410
24411 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
24412 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
24413 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
24414 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
24415 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
24416
24417 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24418 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24419 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24420 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24421 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24422
24423 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24424 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24425
24426 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24427 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24428 information associated with the variable.)
24429
24430 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24431 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24432 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24433 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24434 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24435 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24436
24437 Reply:
24438 @table @samp
24439 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24440 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24441 local storage requested.
24442
24443 @item E @var{nn}
24444 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24445
24446 @item
24447 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24448 @end table
24449
24450 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24451 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24452 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24453 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24454 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24455 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24456 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24457
24458 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24459
24460 Reply:
24461 @table @samp
24462 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24463 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24464 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24465 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24466 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24467 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24468 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24469 @end table
24470
24471 @item qOffsets
24472 @cindex section offsets, remote request
24473 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24474 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24475 image.
24476
24477 Reply:
24478 @table @samp
24479 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24480 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24481 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24482 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24483 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24484 segments by the supplied offsets.
24485
24486 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24487 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24488 to the @code{Bss} section.}
24489
24490 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24491 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24492 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24493 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24494 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24495 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24496 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24497 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24498 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24499 @end table
24500
24501 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24502 @cindex thread information, remote request
24503 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
24504 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24505 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24506
24507 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24508 (see below).
24509
24510 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24511
24512 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24513 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24514 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24515 @anchor{QPassSignals}
24516 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24517 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24518 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24519 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24520 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24521 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24522 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24523 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24524 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24525
24526 Reply:
24527 @table @samp
24528 @item OK
24529 The request succeeded.
24530
24531 @item E @var{nn}
24532 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24533
24534 @item
24535 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24536 the stub.
24537 @end table
24538
24539 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24540 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24541 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24542 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24543
24544 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
24545 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
24546 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24547 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24548 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24549 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24550 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24551 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24552 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24553
24554 Reply:
24555 @table @samp
24556 @item OK
24557 A command response with no output.
24558 @item @var{OUTPUT}
24559 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24560 @item E @var{NN}
24561 Indicate a badly formed request.
24562 @item
24563 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24564 @end table
24565
24566 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24567 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24568 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24569 packets.)
24570
24571 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24572 @cindex supported packets, remote query
24573 @cindex features of the remote protocol
24574 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24575 @anchor{qSupported}
24576 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24577 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24578 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24579 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24580 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24581 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24582 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24583 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24584 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24585 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24586 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24587 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24588 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24589 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24590
24591 Reply:
24592 @table @samp
24593 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24594 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24595 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24596 possible forms).
24597 @item
24598 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24599 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24600 @end table
24601
24602 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24603 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24604 are:
24605
24606 @table @samp
24607 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
24608 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24609 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24610 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24611 @item @var{name}+
24612 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24613 need an associated value.
24614 @item @var{name}-
24615 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24616 @item @var{name}?
24617 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24618 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24619 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24620 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24621 @end table
24622
24623 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24624 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24625 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24626 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24627 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24628
24629 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24630 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24631 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24632 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24633 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24634 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24635 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24636 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24637 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24638 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24639 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24640 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24641 all the features it supports.
24642
24643 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24644 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24645
24646 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24647 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24648 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24649 form response.
24650
24651 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24652 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24653 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24654 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24655
24656 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24657 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24658 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24659 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24660 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24661
24662 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24663
24664 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24665 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24666 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24667 @item Feature Name
24668 @tab Value Required
24669 @tab Default
24670 @tab Probe Allowed
24671
24672 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24673 @tab Yes
24674 @tab @samp{-}
24675 @tab No
24676
24677 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24678 @tab No
24679 @tab @samp{-}
24680 @tab Yes
24681
24682 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24683 @tab No
24684 @tab @samp{-}
24685 @tab Yes
24686
24687 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24688 @tab No
24689 @tab @samp{-}
24690 @tab Yes
24691
24692 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24693 @tab No
24694 @tab @samp{-}
24695 @tab Yes
24696
24697 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24698 @tab No
24699 @tab @samp{-}
24700 @tab Yes
24701
24702 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24703 @tab No
24704 @tab @samp{-}
24705 @tab Yes
24706
24707 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
24708 @tab No
24709 @tab @samp{-}
24710 @tab Yes
24711
24712 @end multitable
24713
24714 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24715
24716 @table @samp
24717 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24718 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24719 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24720 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24721 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24722 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24723 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24724 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24725 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24726 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24727
24728 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24729 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24730 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24731
24732 @item qXfer:features:read
24733 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24734 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24735
24736 @item qXfer:libraries:read
24737 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24738 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24739
24740 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24741 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24742 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24743
24744 @item qXfer:spu:read
24745 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24746 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24747
24748 @item qXfer:spu:write
24749 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24750 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24751
24752 @item QPassSignals
24753 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24754 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24755
24756 @end table
24757
24758 @item qSymbol::
24759 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24760 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24761 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24762 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24763
24764 Reply:
24765 @table @samp
24766 @item OK
24767 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24768 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24769 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24770 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24771 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24772 below.
24773 @end table
24774
24775 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24776 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24777
24778 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24779 target has previously requested.
24780
24781 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24782 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24783 will be empty.
24784
24785 Reply:
24786 @table @samp
24787 @item OK
24788 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24789 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24790 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24791 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24792 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24793 @end table
24794
24795 @item QTDP
24796 @itemx QTFrame
24797 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24798
24799 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24800 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24801 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24802 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24803 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24804 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24805 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24806 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24807 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24808 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24809
24810 Reply:
24811 @table @samp
24812 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24813 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24814 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24815 the thread's attributes.
24816 @end table
24817
24818 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24819 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24820 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24821 packets.)
24822
24823 @item QTStart
24824 @itemx QTStop
24825 @itemx QTinit
24826 @itemx QTro
24827 @itemx qTStatus
24828 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24829
24830 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24831 @cindex read special object, remote request
24832 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24833 @anchor{qXfer read}
24834 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24835 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24836 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24837 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
24838 additional details about what data to access.
24839
24840 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24841 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24842 formats, listed below.
24843
24844 @table @samp
24845 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24846 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24847 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24848 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24849
24850 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24851 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24852
24853 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24854 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24855 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24856 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24857 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24858
24859 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24860 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24861
24862 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24863 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
24864 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
24865 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24866 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24867
24868 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
24869 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
24870 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
24871
24872 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24873 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24874
24875 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24876 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24877 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
24878 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24879 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24880
24881 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24882 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24883
24884 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24885 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
24886 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24887 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
24888 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24889 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24890 in that context to be accessed.
24891
24892 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24893 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24894 @end table
24895
24896 Reply:
24897 @table @samp
24898 @item m @var{data}
24899 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24900 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24901 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24902 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24903 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24904 request.
24905
24906 @item l @var{data}
24907 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24908 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24909 than the @var{length} in the request.
24910
24911 @item l
24912 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24913 There is no more data to be read.
24914
24915 @item E00
24916 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24917
24918 @item E @var{nn}
24919 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24920 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24921
24922 @item
24923 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24924 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24925 @end table
24926
24927 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24928 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24929 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24930 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24931 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24932 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24933 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24934 to access.
24935
24936 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24937 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24938 formats, listed below.
24939
24940 @table @samp
24941 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24942 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
24943 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24944 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24945 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24946 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24947 in that context to be accessed.
24948
24949 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24950 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24951 @end table
24952
24953 Reply:
24954 @table @samp
24955 @item @var{nn}
24956 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24957 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24958
24959 @item E00
24960 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24961
24962 @item E @var{nn}
24963 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24964 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24965
24966 @item
24967 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24968 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24969 @end table
24970
24971 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24972 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24973 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24974 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24975 must respond with an empty packet.
24976
24977 @end table
24978
24979 @node Register Packet Format
24980 @section Register Packet Format
24981
24982 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24983 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24984 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24985 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24986 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24987 most-significant - least-significant.
24988
24989 @table @r
24990
24991 @item MIPS32
24992
24993 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24994 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24995 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24996
24997 @item MIPS64
24998
24999 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
25000 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
25001 as @code{MIPS32}.
25002
25003 @end table
25004
25005 @node Tracepoint Packets
25006 @section Tracepoint Packets
25007 @cindex tracepoint packets
25008 @cindex packets, tracepoint
25009
25010 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
25011 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
25012
25013 @table @samp
25014
25015 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
25016 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
25017 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
25018 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
25019 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
25020 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
25021 tracepoint's actions.
25022
25023 Replies:
25024 @table @samp
25025 @item OK
25026 The packet was understood and carried out.
25027 @item
25028 The packet was not recognized.
25029 @end table
25030
25031 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
25032 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
25033 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
25034 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
25035 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
25036 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
25037 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
25038
25039 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
25040 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
25041 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
25042 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
25043 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
25044 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
25045 tracepoint actions.
25046
25047 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
25048 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
25049 following forms:
25050
25051 @table @samp
25052
25053 @item R @var{mask}
25054 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
25055 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
25056 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
25057 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
25058 not fit in a 32-bit word.
25059
25060 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
25061 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
25062 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
25063 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
25064 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
25065 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
25066 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
25067
25068 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
25069 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
25070 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
25071 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
25072 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
25073 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
25074 packet).
25075
25076 @end table
25077
25078 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
25079 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
25080 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
25081 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
25082 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
25083 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
25084 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
25085 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
25086
25087 Replies:
25088 @table @samp
25089 @item OK
25090 The packet was understood and carried out.
25091 @item
25092 The packet was not recognized.
25093 @end table
25094
25095 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
25096 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
25097 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
25098 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
25099
25100 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
25101 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
25102 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
25103 one of the following forms:
25104
25105 @table @samp
25106 @item F @var{f}
25107 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
25108 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
25109 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
25110
25111 @item T @var{t}
25112 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
25113 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
25114
25115 @end table
25116
25117 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
25118 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25119 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
25120 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
25121
25122 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
25123 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25124 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
25125 is a hexadecimal number.
25126
25127 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
25128 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25129 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
25130 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
25131 numbers.
25132
25133 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
25134 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
25135 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
25136
25137 @item QTStart
25138 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
25139 hits in the trace frame buffer.
25140
25141 @item QTStop
25142 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
25143
25144 @item QTinit
25145 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
25146
25147 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
25148 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
25149 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
25150 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
25151
25152 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
25153 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
25154 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
25155 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
25156
25157 @item qTStatus
25158 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
25159
25160 Replies:
25161 @table @samp
25162 @item T0
25163 There is no trace experiment running.
25164 @item T1
25165 There is a trace experiment running.
25166 @end table
25167
25168 @end table
25169
25170
25171 @node Host I/O Packets
25172 @section Host I/O Packets
25173 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
25174 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
25175
25176 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
25177 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
25178 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
25179 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
25180 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
25181 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
25182 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
25183 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
25184 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
25185 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
25186
25187 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
25188 its arguments. They have this format:
25189
25190 @table @samp
25191
25192 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
25193 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
25194 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
25195 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
25196 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
25197 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
25198 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
25199 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
25200 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
25201
25202 @end table
25203
25204 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
25205
25206 @table @samp
25207
25208 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
25209 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
25210 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
25211 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
25212 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
25213 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
25214 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
25215 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
25216 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
25217 @var{attachment}.
25218
25219 @item
25220 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
25221
25222 @end table
25223
25224 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
25225
25226 @table @samp
25227 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
25228 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
25229 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
25230 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
25231 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
25232 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
25233 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
25234
25235 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
25236 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
25237 -1 if an error occurs.
25238
25239 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
25240 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
25241 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
25242 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
25243 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
25244 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
25245 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
25246 @var{count} was zero.
25247
25248 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
25249 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
25250 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
25251 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
25252 some characters were escaped.
25253
25254 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
25255 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
25256 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
25257 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
25258 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
25259 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
25260 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
25261 error occurred.
25262
25263 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
25264 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
25265 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
25266
25267 @end table
25268
25269 @node Interrupts
25270 @section Interrupts
25271 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
25272
25273 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
25274 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
25275 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
25276 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
25277
25278 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
25279 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
25280 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
25281 interfaces.
25282
25283 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
25284 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
25285 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
25286 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
25287 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
25288 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
25289 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
25290 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
25291
25292 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
25293 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
25294 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
25295 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
25296 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
25297 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
25298 program is stopped will be discarded.
25299
25300 @node Examples
25301 @section Examples
25302
25303 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
25304 does not get any direct output:
25305
25306 @smallexample
25307 -> @code{R00}
25308 <- @code{+}
25309 @emph{target restarts}
25310 -> @code{?}
25311 <- @code{+}
25312 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25313 -> @code{+}
25314 @end smallexample
25315
25316 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
25317
25318 @smallexample
25319 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
25320 <- @code{+}
25321 -> @code{s}
25322 <- @code{+}
25323 @emph{time passes}
25324 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25325 -> @code{+}
25326 -> @code{g}
25327 <- @code{+}
25328 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
25329 -> @code{+}
25330 @end smallexample
25331
25332 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25333 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25334 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
25335
25336 @menu
25337 * File-I/O Overview::
25338 * Protocol Basics::
25339 * The F Request Packet::
25340 * The F Reply Packet::
25341 * The Ctrl-C Message::
25342 * Console I/O::
25343 * List of Supported Calls::
25344 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
25345 * Constants::
25346 * File-I/O Examples::
25347 @end menu
25348
25349 @node File-I/O Overview
25350 @subsection File-I/O Overview
25351 @cindex file-i/o overview
25352
25353 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
25354 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
25355 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
25356 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
25357 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
25358 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
25359
25360 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
25361 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
25362 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
25363 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
25364 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
25365
25366 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
25367 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
25368 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
25369 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
25370 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
25371 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
25372 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
25373
25374 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
25375 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
25376 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
25377 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
25378 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
25379
25380 @smallexample
25381 (@value{GDBP}) continue
25382 <- target requests 'system call X'
25383 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
25384 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
25385 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
25386 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
25387 @end smallexample
25388
25389 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
25390 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
25391 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
25392 system are not supported by this protocol.
25393
25394 @node Protocol Basics
25395 @subsection Protocol Basics
25396 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
25397
25398 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
25399 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
25400 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
25401 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
25402 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
25403 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
25404 to call the appropriate host system call:
25405
25406 @itemize @bullet
25407 @item
25408 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
25409
25410 @item
25411 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
25412 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
25413 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
25414 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
25415
25416 @end itemize
25417
25418 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25419
25420 @itemize @bullet
25421 @item
25422 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25423 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25424 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25425 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25426 packet.
25427
25428 @item
25429 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25430 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25431
25432 @item
25433 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25434
25435 @item
25436 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25437
25438 @item
25439 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25440 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25441 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25442 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25443 packet.
25444
25445 @end itemize
25446
25447 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25448 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25449
25450 @itemize @bullet
25451 @item
25452 Return value.
25453
25454 @item
25455 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25456
25457 @item
25458 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25459
25460 @end itemize
25461
25462 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25463 the latest continue or step action.
25464
25465 @node The F Request Packet
25466 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25467 @cindex file-i/o request packet
25468 @cindex @code{F} request packet
25469
25470 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25471
25472 @table @samp
25473 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25474
25475 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25476 This is just the name of the function.
25477
25478 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25479 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25480 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25481 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25482 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25483 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25484 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25485
25486 @end table
25487
25488
25489
25490 @node The F Reply Packet
25491 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25492 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
25493 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
25494
25495 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25496
25497 @table @samp
25498
25499 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25500
25501 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25502
25503 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25504 representation.
25505 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25506
25507 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25508 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25509 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25510
25511 @smallexample
25512 F0,0,C
25513 @end smallexample
25514
25515 @noindent
25516 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25517
25518 @smallexample
25519 F-1,4,C
25520 @end smallexample
25521
25522 @noindent
25523 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25524
25525 @end table
25526
25527
25528 @node The Ctrl-C Message
25529 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25530 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25531
25532 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25533 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25534 the target should behave as if it had
25535 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25536 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25537 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25538 packet.
25539
25540 It's important for the target to know in which
25541 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25542
25543 @itemize @bullet
25544 @item
25545 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25546
25547 @item
25548 The system call on the host has been finished.
25549
25550 @end itemize
25551
25552 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25553 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25554 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25555 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25556 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25557 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25558
25559 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25560 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25561 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25562 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25563 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25564 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25565 or the full action has been completed.
25566
25567 @node Console I/O
25568 @subsection Console I/O
25569 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25570
25571 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25572 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25573 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25574 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25575 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
25576 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25577 conditions is met:
25578
25579 @itemize @bullet
25580 @item
25581 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25582 @code{read}
25583 system call is treated as finished.
25584
25585 @item
25586 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25587 newline.
25588
25589 @item
25590 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25591 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25592
25593 @end itemize
25594
25595 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25596 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25597 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25598 is stopped at the user's request.
25599
25600
25601 @node List of Supported Calls
25602 @subsection List of Supported Calls
25603 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25604
25605 @menu
25606 * open::
25607 * close::
25608 * read::
25609 * write::
25610 * lseek::
25611 * rename::
25612 * unlink::
25613 * stat/fstat::
25614 * gettimeofday::
25615 * isatty::
25616 * system::
25617 @end menu
25618
25619 @node open
25620 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
25621 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
25622
25623 @table @asis
25624 @item Synopsis:
25625 @smallexample
25626 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25627 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25628 @end smallexample
25629
25630 @item Request:
25631 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25632
25633 @noindent
25634 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25635
25636 @table @code
25637 @item O_CREAT
25638 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25639 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25640 are concerned.
25641
25642 @item O_EXCL
25643 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25644 an error and open() fails.
25645
25646 @item O_TRUNC
25647 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25648 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25649 truncated to zero length.
25650
25651 @item O_APPEND
25652 The file is opened in append mode.
25653
25654 @item O_RDONLY
25655 The file is opened for reading only.
25656
25657 @item O_WRONLY
25658 The file is opened for writing only.
25659
25660 @item O_RDWR
25661 The file is opened for reading and writing.
25662 @end table
25663
25664 @noindent
25665 Other bits are silently ignored.
25666
25667
25668 @noindent
25669 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25670
25671 @table @code
25672 @item S_IRUSR
25673 User has read permission.
25674
25675 @item S_IWUSR
25676 User has write permission.
25677
25678 @item S_IRGRP
25679 Group has read permission.
25680
25681 @item S_IWGRP
25682 Group has write permission.
25683
25684 @item S_IROTH
25685 Others have read permission.
25686
25687 @item S_IWOTH
25688 Others have write permission.
25689 @end table
25690
25691 @noindent
25692 Other bits are silently ignored.
25693
25694
25695 @item Return value:
25696 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25697 occurred.
25698
25699 @item Errors:
25700
25701 @table @code
25702 @item EEXIST
25703 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25704
25705 @item EISDIR
25706 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25707
25708 @item EACCES
25709 The requested access is not allowed.
25710
25711 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25712 @var{pathname} was too long.
25713
25714 @item ENOENT
25715 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25716
25717 @item ENODEV
25718 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25719
25720 @item EROFS
25721 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25722 write access was requested.
25723
25724 @item EFAULT
25725 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25726
25727 @item ENOSPC
25728 No space on device to create the file.
25729
25730 @item EMFILE
25731 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25732
25733 @item ENFILE
25734 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25735 has been reached.
25736
25737 @item EINTR
25738 The call was interrupted by the user.
25739 @end table
25740
25741 @end table
25742
25743 @node close
25744 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
25745 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
25746
25747 @table @asis
25748 @item Synopsis:
25749 @smallexample
25750 int close(int fd);
25751 @end smallexample
25752
25753 @item Request:
25754 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25755
25756 @item Return value:
25757 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25758
25759 @item Errors:
25760
25761 @table @code
25762 @item EBADF
25763 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25764
25765 @item EINTR
25766 The call was interrupted by the user.
25767 @end table
25768
25769 @end table
25770
25771 @node read
25772 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
25773 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
25774
25775 @table @asis
25776 @item Synopsis:
25777 @smallexample
25778 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25779 @end smallexample
25780
25781 @item Request:
25782 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25783
25784 @item Return value:
25785 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25786 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25787 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25788
25789 @item Errors:
25790
25791 @table @code
25792 @item EBADF
25793 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25794 reading.
25795
25796 @item EFAULT
25797 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25798
25799 @item EINTR
25800 The call was interrupted by the user.
25801 @end table
25802
25803 @end table
25804
25805 @node write
25806 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
25807 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
25808
25809 @table @asis
25810 @item Synopsis:
25811 @smallexample
25812 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25813 @end smallexample
25814
25815 @item Request:
25816 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25817
25818 @item Return value:
25819 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25820 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25821 is returned.
25822
25823 @item Errors:
25824
25825 @table @code
25826 @item EBADF
25827 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25828 writing.
25829
25830 @item EFAULT
25831 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25832
25833 @item EFBIG
25834 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25835 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25836
25837 @item ENOSPC
25838 No space on device to write the data.
25839
25840 @item EINTR
25841 The call was interrupted by the user.
25842 @end table
25843
25844 @end table
25845
25846 @node lseek
25847 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25848 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25849
25850 @table @asis
25851 @item Synopsis:
25852 @smallexample
25853 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25854 @end smallexample
25855
25856 @item Request:
25857 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25858
25859 @var{flag} is one of:
25860
25861 @table @code
25862 @item SEEK_SET
25863 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25864
25865 @item SEEK_CUR
25866 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25867 bytes.
25868
25869 @item SEEK_END
25870 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25871 bytes.
25872 @end table
25873
25874 @item Return value:
25875 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25876 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25877 value of -1 is returned.
25878
25879 @item Errors:
25880
25881 @table @code
25882 @item EBADF
25883 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25884
25885 @item ESPIPE
25886 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25887
25888 @item EINVAL
25889 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
25890
25891 @item EINTR
25892 The call was interrupted by the user.
25893 @end table
25894
25895 @end table
25896
25897 @node rename
25898 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25899 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25900
25901 @table @asis
25902 @item Synopsis:
25903 @smallexample
25904 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25905 @end smallexample
25906
25907 @item Request:
25908 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25909
25910 @item Return value:
25911 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25912
25913 @item Errors:
25914
25915 @table @code
25916 @item EISDIR
25917 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25918 directory.
25919
25920 @item EEXIST
25921 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25922
25923 @item EBUSY
25924 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25925 process.
25926
25927 @item EINVAL
25928 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25929 of itself.
25930
25931 @item ENOTDIR
25932 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25933 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25934 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25935
25936 @item EFAULT
25937 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25938
25939 @item EACCES
25940 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25941
25942 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25943
25944 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25945
25946 @item ENOENT
25947 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25948
25949 @item EROFS
25950 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25951
25952 @item ENOSPC
25953 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25954 directory entry.
25955
25956 @item EINTR
25957 The call was interrupted by the user.
25958 @end table
25959
25960 @end table
25961
25962 @node unlink
25963 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25964 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25965
25966 @table @asis
25967 @item Synopsis:
25968 @smallexample
25969 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25970 @end smallexample
25971
25972 @item Request:
25973 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25974
25975 @item Return value:
25976 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25977
25978 @item Errors:
25979
25980 @table @code
25981 @item EACCES
25982 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25983
25984 @item EPERM
25985 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25986
25987 @item EBUSY
25988 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25989 being used by another process.
25990
25991 @item EFAULT
25992 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25993
25994 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25995 @var{pathname} was too long.
25996
25997 @item ENOENT
25998 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25999
26000 @item ENOTDIR
26001 A component of the path is not a directory.
26002
26003 @item EROFS
26004 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26005
26006 @item EINTR
26007 The call was interrupted by the user.
26008 @end table
26009
26010 @end table
26011
26012 @node stat/fstat
26013 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
26014 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
26015 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
26016
26017 @table @asis
26018 @item Synopsis:
26019 @smallexample
26020 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
26021 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
26022 @end smallexample
26023
26024 @item Request:
26025 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
26026 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
26027
26028 @item Return value:
26029 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26030
26031 @item Errors:
26032
26033 @table @code
26034 @item EBADF
26035 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
26036
26037 @item ENOENT
26038 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
26039 path is an empty string.
26040
26041 @item ENOTDIR
26042 A component of the path is not a directory.
26043
26044 @item EFAULT
26045 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26046
26047 @item EACCES
26048 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26049
26050 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26051 @var{pathname} was too long.
26052
26053 @item EINTR
26054 The call was interrupted by the user.
26055 @end table
26056
26057 @end table
26058
26059 @node gettimeofday
26060 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
26061 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
26062
26063 @table @asis
26064 @item Synopsis:
26065 @smallexample
26066 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
26067 @end smallexample
26068
26069 @item Request:
26070 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
26071
26072 @item Return value:
26073 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
26074
26075 @item Errors:
26076
26077 @table @code
26078 @item EINVAL
26079 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
26080
26081 @item EFAULT
26082 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26083 @end table
26084
26085 @end table
26086
26087 @node isatty
26088 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
26089 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
26090
26091 @table @asis
26092 @item Synopsis:
26093 @smallexample
26094 int isatty(int fd);
26095 @end smallexample
26096
26097 @item Request:
26098 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
26099
26100 @item Return value:
26101 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
26102
26103 @item Errors:
26104
26105 @table @code
26106 @item EINTR
26107 The call was interrupted by the user.
26108 @end table
26109
26110 @end table
26111
26112 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
26113 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
26114 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
26115 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
26116 needed.
26117
26118
26119 @node system
26120 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
26121 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
26122
26123 @table @asis
26124 @item Synopsis:
26125 @smallexample
26126 int system(const char *command);
26127 @end smallexample
26128
26129 @item Request:
26130 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
26131
26132 @item Return value:
26133 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
26134 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
26135 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
26136 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
26137 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
26138 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
26139 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
26140
26141 @item Errors:
26142
26143 @table @code
26144 @item EINTR
26145 The call was interrupted by the user.
26146 @end table
26147
26148 @end table
26149
26150 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
26151 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
26152 the host is simplified before it's returned
26153 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
26154 is discarded, and the return value consists
26155 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
26156
26157 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
26158 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
26159 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
26160
26161 @table @code
26162 @item set remote system-call-allowed
26163 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
26164 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
26165 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
26166
26167 @item show remote system-call-allowed
26168 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
26169 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
26170 protocol.
26171 @end table
26172
26173 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26174 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26175 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26176
26177 @menu
26178 * Integral Datatypes::
26179 * Pointer Values::
26180 * Memory Transfer::
26181 * struct stat::
26182 * struct timeval::
26183 @end menu
26184
26185 @node Integral Datatypes
26186 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
26187 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26188
26189 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
26190 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
26191 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
26192
26193 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
26194 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
26195
26196 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
26197
26198 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
26199 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
26200
26201 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
26202
26203 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
26204 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
26205 byte order.
26206
26207 @node Pointer Values
26208 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
26209 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
26210
26211 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
26212 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
26213 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
26214 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
26215
26216 @smallexample
26217 @code{1aaf/12}
26218 @end smallexample
26219
26220 @noindent
26221 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
26222 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
26223 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
26224 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
26225
26226 @smallexample
26227 @code{123456/d}
26228 @end smallexample
26229
26230 @node Memory Transfer
26231 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
26232 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
26233
26234 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
26235 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
26236 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
26237 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
26238 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
26239 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
26240 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
26241
26242
26243 @node struct stat
26244 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
26245 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
26246
26247 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
26248 is defined as follows:
26249
26250 @smallexample
26251 struct stat @{
26252 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
26253 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
26254 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
26255 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
26256 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
26257 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
26258 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
26259 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
26260 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
26261 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
26262 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
26263 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
26264 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
26265 @};
26266 @end smallexample
26267
26268 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26269 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26270 structure is of size 64 bytes.
26271
26272 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
26273 range of values.
26274
26275 @table @code
26276
26277 @item st_dev
26278 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
26279
26280 @item st_ino
26281 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26282
26283 @item st_mode
26284 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
26285 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
26286
26287 @item st_uid
26288 @itemx st_gid
26289 @itemx st_rdev
26290 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26291
26292 @item st_atime
26293 @itemx st_mtime
26294 @itemx st_ctime
26295 These values have a host and file system dependent
26296 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
26297 support exact timing values.
26298 @end table
26299
26300 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
26301 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
26302 continuing.
26303
26304 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
26305 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
26306 get truncated on the target.
26307
26308 @node struct timeval
26309 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
26310 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
26311
26312 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
26313 is defined as follows:
26314
26315 @smallexample
26316 struct timeval @{
26317 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
26318 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
26319 @};
26320 @end smallexample
26321
26322 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26323 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26324 structure is of size 8 bytes.
26325
26326 @node Constants
26327 @subsection Constants
26328 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
26329
26330 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
26331 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
26332 values before and after the call as needed.
26333
26334 @menu
26335 * Open Flags::
26336 * mode_t Values::
26337 * Errno Values::
26338 * Lseek Flags::
26339 * Limits::
26340 @end menu
26341
26342 @node Open Flags
26343 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
26344 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
26345
26346 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
26347
26348 @smallexample
26349 O_RDONLY 0x0
26350 O_WRONLY 0x1
26351 O_RDWR 0x2
26352 O_APPEND 0x8
26353 O_CREAT 0x200
26354 O_TRUNC 0x400
26355 O_EXCL 0x800
26356 @end smallexample
26357
26358 @node mode_t Values
26359 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
26360 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
26361
26362 All values are given in octal representation.
26363
26364 @smallexample
26365 S_IFREG 0100000
26366 S_IFDIR 040000
26367 S_IRUSR 0400
26368 S_IWUSR 0200
26369 S_IXUSR 0100
26370 S_IRGRP 040
26371 S_IWGRP 020
26372 S_IXGRP 010
26373 S_IROTH 04
26374 S_IWOTH 02
26375 S_IXOTH 01
26376 @end smallexample
26377
26378 @node Errno Values
26379 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
26380 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
26381
26382 All values are given in decimal representation.
26383
26384 @smallexample
26385 EPERM 1
26386 ENOENT 2
26387 EINTR 4
26388 EBADF 9
26389 EACCES 13
26390 EFAULT 14
26391 EBUSY 16
26392 EEXIST 17
26393 ENODEV 19
26394 ENOTDIR 20
26395 EISDIR 21
26396 EINVAL 22
26397 ENFILE 23
26398 EMFILE 24
26399 EFBIG 27
26400 ENOSPC 28
26401 ESPIPE 29
26402 EROFS 30
26403 ENAMETOOLONG 91
26404 EUNKNOWN 9999
26405 @end smallexample
26406
26407 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
26408 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
26409
26410 @node Lseek Flags
26411 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
26412 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
26413
26414 @smallexample
26415 SEEK_SET 0
26416 SEEK_CUR 1
26417 SEEK_END 2
26418 @end smallexample
26419
26420 @node Limits
26421 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26422 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26423
26424 All values are given in decimal representation.
26425
26426 @smallexample
26427 INT_MIN -2147483648
26428 INT_MAX 2147483647
26429 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26430 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26431 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26432 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26433 @end smallexample
26434
26435 @node File-I/O Examples
26436 @subsection File-I/O Examples
26437 @cindex file-i/o examples
26438
26439 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26440 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26441
26442 @smallexample
26443 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26444 @emph{request memory read from target}
26445 -> @code{m1234,6}
26446 <- XXXXXX
26447 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26448 -> @code{F6}
26449 @end smallexample
26450
26451 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26452 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26453
26454 @smallexample
26455 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26456 @emph{request memory write to target}
26457 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26458 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26459 -> @code{F6}
26460 @end smallexample
26461
26462 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26463 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26464
26465 @smallexample
26466 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26467 -> @code{F-1,9}
26468 @end smallexample
26469
26470 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26471 host is called:
26472
26473 @smallexample
26474 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26475 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
26476 <- @code{T02}
26477 @end smallexample
26478
26479 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26480 host is called:
26481
26482 @smallexample
26483 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26484 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26485 <- @code{T02}
26486 @end smallexample
26487
26488 @node Library List Format
26489 @section Library List Format
26490 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
26491
26492 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26493 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26494 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26495 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26496 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26497 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26498 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26499 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26500 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26501 are loaded.
26502
26503 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26504 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26505 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
26506 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
26507
26508 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
26509 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
26510 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
26511 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
26512 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
26513 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
26514
26515 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26516 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26517
26518 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26519 offset, looks like this:
26520
26521 @smallexample
26522 <library-list>
26523 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26524 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26525 </library>
26526 </library-list>
26527 @end smallexample
26528
26529 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
26530 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
26531
26532 @smallexample
26533 <library-list>
26534 <library name="sharedlib.o">
26535 <section address="0x10000000"/>
26536 <section address="0x20000000"/>
26537 <section address="0x30000000"/>
26538 </library>
26539 </library-list>
26540 @end smallexample
26541
26542 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26543
26544 @smallexample
26545 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26546 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26547 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26548 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
26549 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26550 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26551 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26552 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
26553 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26554 @end smallexample
26555
26556 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
26557 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
26558 section for each library.
26559
26560 @node Memory Map Format
26561 @section Memory Map Format
26562 @cindex memory map format
26563
26564 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26565 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26566 memory map.
26567
26568 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26569 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26570 lists memory regions.
26571
26572 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26573 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26574
26575 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26576
26577 @smallexample
26578 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26579 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
26580 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26581 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26582 <memory-map>
26583 region...
26584 </memory-map>
26585 @end smallexample
26586
26587 Each region can be either:
26588
26589 @itemize
26590
26591 @item
26592 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26593 bytes from there:
26594
26595 @smallexample
26596 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26597 @end smallexample
26598
26599
26600 @item
26601 A region of read-only memory:
26602
26603 @smallexample
26604 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26605 @end smallexample
26606
26607
26608 @item
26609 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26610 bytes in length:
26611
26612 @smallexample
26613 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26614 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26615 </memory>
26616 @end smallexample
26617
26618 @end itemize
26619
26620 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26621 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26622 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26623
26624 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26625
26626 @smallexample
26627 <!-- ................................................... -->
26628 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26629 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26630 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
26631 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26632 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26633 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26634 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26635 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26636 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26637 and its type, or device. -->
26638 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26639 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26640 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26641 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26642 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26643 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26644 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26645 @end smallexample
26646
26647 @include agentexpr.texi
26648
26649 @node Target Descriptions
26650 @appendix Target Descriptions
26651 @cindex target descriptions
26652
26653 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26654 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26655 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26656
26657 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26658 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26659 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26660 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26661 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26662 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26663 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26664
26665 @itemize @bullet
26666 @item
26667 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26668 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26669 @item
26670 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26671 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26672 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26673 @item
26674 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26675 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26676 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26677 @end itemize
26678
26679 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26680 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26681 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26682 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
26683 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
26684
26685 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26686 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
26687
26688 @menu
26689 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
26690 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
26691 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
26692 descriptions.
26693 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
26694 @end menu
26695
26696 @node Retrieving Descriptions
26697 @section Retrieving Descriptions
26698
26699 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
26700 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
26701 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
26702 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
26703 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
26704 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
26705 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
26706 Format}.
26707
26708 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
26709 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
26710 specify a file are:
26711
26712 @table @code
26713 @cindex set tdesc filename
26714 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
26715 Read the target description from @var{path}.
26716
26717 @cindex unset tdesc filename
26718 @item unset tdesc filename
26719 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26720 will use the description supplied by the current target.
26721
26722 @cindex show tdesc filename
26723 @item show tdesc filename
26724 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26725 @end table
26726
26727
26728 @node Target Description Format
26729 @section Target Description Format
26730 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
26731
26732 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26733 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26734 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26735 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26736 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26737 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26738 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26739
26740 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26741 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26742 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26743 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26744
26745 Here is a simple target description:
26746
26747 @smallexample
26748 <target version="1.0">
26749 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26750 </target>
26751 @end smallexample
26752
26753 @noindent
26754 This minimal description only says that the target uses
26755 the x86-64 architecture.
26756
26757 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26758 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26759 are explained further below.
26760
26761 @smallexample
26762 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26763 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26764 <target version="1.0">
26765 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26766 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26767 </target>
26768 @end smallexample
26769
26770 @noindent
26771 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26772 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26773 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26774 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26775 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26776 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26777 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26778 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26779 the version mismatch.
26780
26781 @subsection Inclusion
26782 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26783 @cindex XInclude
26784 @ifnotinfo
26785 @cindex <xi:include>
26786 @end ifnotinfo
26787
26788 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26789 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26790 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26791 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26792 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26793
26794 @smallexample
26795 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26796 @end smallexample
26797
26798 @noindent
26799 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26800 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26801 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26802 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26803 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26804 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26805 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26806 original description.
26807
26808 @subsection Architecture
26809 @cindex <architecture>
26810
26811 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26812
26813 @smallexample
26814 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26815 @end smallexample
26816
26817 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26818 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26819 Debugging Target}).
26820
26821 @subsection Features
26822 @cindex <feature>
26823
26824 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26825 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26826 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26827 has this form:
26828
26829 @smallexample
26830 <feature name="@var{name}">
26831 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26832 @var{reg}@dots{}
26833 </feature>
26834 @end smallexample
26835
26836 @noindent
26837 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
26838 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
26839 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
26840 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
26841
26842 @subsection Types
26843
26844 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
26845 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
26846 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
26847 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
26848 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
26849
26850 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
26851 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
26852 Types must be defined before they are used.
26853
26854 @cindex <vector>
26855 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
26856 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
26857 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
26858 @var{count}:
26859
26860 @smallexample
26861 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
26862 @end smallexample
26863
26864 @cindex <union>
26865 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
26866 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
26867 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
26868 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
26869
26870 @smallexample
26871 <union id="@var{id}">
26872 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
26873 @dots{}
26874 </union>
26875 @end smallexample
26876
26877 @subsection Registers
26878 @cindex <reg>
26879
26880 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
26881
26882 @smallexample
26883 <reg name="@var{name}"
26884 bitsize="@var{size}"
26885 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
26886 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
26887 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
26888 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
26889 @end smallexample
26890
26891 @noindent
26892 The components are as follows:
26893
26894 @table @var
26895
26896 @item name
26897 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
26898
26899 @item bitsize
26900 The register's size, in bits.
26901
26902 @item regnum
26903 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
26904 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
26905 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
26906 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26907 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26908 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26909 in order of increasing register number.
26910
26911 @item save-restore
26912 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26913 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26914 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26915 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26916 ABI.
26917
26918 @item type
26919 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26920 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26921 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26922 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26923 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26924 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26925
26926 @item group
26927 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26928 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26929 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26930 in @code{info registers}.
26931
26932 @end table
26933
26934 @node Predefined Target Types
26935 @section Predefined Target Types
26936 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26937
26938 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26939 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26940 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26941 types. The currently supported types are:
26942
26943 @table @code
26944
26945 @item int8
26946 @itemx int16
26947 @itemx int32
26948 @itemx int64
26949 @itemx int128
26950 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26951
26952 @item uint8
26953 @itemx uint16
26954 @itemx uint32
26955 @itemx uint64
26956 @itemx uint128
26957 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26958
26959 @item code_ptr
26960 @itemx data_ptr
26961 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26962 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26963 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26964 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26965 may be marked as data pointers.
26966
26967 @item ieee_single
26968 Single precision IEEE floating point.
26969
26970 @item ieee_double
26971 Double precision IEEE floating point.
26972
26973 @item arm_fpa_ext
26974 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26975
26976 @end table
26977
26978 @node Standard Target Features
26979 @section Standard Target Features
26980 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
26981
26982 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26983 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26984 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26985 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26986 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26987 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26988 can recognize them.
26989
26990 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26991 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26992 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26993 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26994 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26995 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26996 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26997 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26998
26999 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
27000 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
27001 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
27002
27003 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
27004 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
27005 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
27006 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
27007
27008 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
27009 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
27010 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
27011
27012 @menu
27013 * ARM Features::
27014 * MIPS Features::
27015 * M68K Features::
27016 * PowerPC Features::
27017 @end menu
27018
27019
27020 @node ARM Features
27021 @subsection ARM Features
27022 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
27023
27024 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
27025 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
27026 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
27027
27028 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
27029 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
27030
27031 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
27032 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
27033 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
27034 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
27035
27036 @node MIPS Features
27037 @subsection MIPS Features
27038 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
27039
27040 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
27041 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
27042 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
27043 on the target.
27044
27045 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
27046 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
27047 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27048
27049 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
27050 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
27051 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
27052 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27053
27054 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
27055 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
27056 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
27057
27058 @node M68K Features
27059 @subsection M68K Features
27060 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
27061
27062 @table @code
27063 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
27064 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
27065 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
27066 One of those features must be always present.
27067 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
27068 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
27069 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
27070 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
27071
27072 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
27073 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
27074 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
27075 @samp{fpiaddr}.
27076 @end table
27077
27078 @node PowerPC Features
27079 @subsection PowerPC Features
27080 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
27081
27082 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
27083 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
27084 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
27085 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27086
27087 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
27088 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
27089
27090 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
27091 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
27092 and @samp{vrsave}.
27093
27094 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
27095 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
27096 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
27097 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
27098 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
27099 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
27100 user.
27101
27102 @include gpl.texi
27103
27104 @raisesections
27105 @include fdl.texi
27106 @lowersections
27107
27108 @node Index
27109 @unnumbered Index
27110
27111 @printindex cp
27112
27113 @tex
27114 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
27115 % meantime:
27116 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
27117 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
27118 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
27119 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
27120 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
27121 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
27122 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
27123 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
27124 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
27125 \page\colophon
27126 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
27127 @end tex
27128
27129 @bye
This page took 0.792712 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.